S3 Family 8-Bit Microcontrollers
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Copyright ©2013 Zilog®, Inc. All rights reserved.
www.zilog.com
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
ii
Warning: DO NOT USE THIS PRODUCT IN LIFE SUPPORT SYSTEMS.
LIFE SUPPORT POLICY
ZILOG’S PRODUCTS ARE NOT AUTHORIZED FOR USE AS CRITICAL COMPONENTS IN LIFE
SUPPORT DEVICES OR SYSTEMS WITHOUT THE EXPRESS PRIOR WRITTEN APPROVAL OF
THE PRESIDENT AND GENERAL COUNSEL OF ZILOG CORPORATION.
As used herein
Life support devices or systems are devices which (a) are intended for surgical implant into the body, or (b)
support or sustain life and whose failure to perform when properly used in accordance with instructions for
use provided in the labeling can be reasonably expected to result in a significant injury to the user. A critical component is any component in a life support device or system whose failure to perform can be reasonably expected to cause the failure of the life support device or system or to affect its safety or effectiveness.
Document Disclaimer
©2013 Zilog, Inc. All rights reserved. Information in this publication concerning the devices, applications,
or technology described is intended to suggest possible uses and may be superseded. ZILOG, INC. DOES
NOT ASSUME LIABILITY FOR OR PROVIDE A REPRESENTATION OF ACCURACY OF THE
INFORMATION, DEVICES, OR TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED IN THIS DOCUMENT. ZILOG ALSO
DOES NOT ASSUME LIABILITY FOR INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY INFRINGEMENT RELATED
IN ANY MANNER TO USE OF INFORMATION, DEVICES, OR TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED
HEREIN OR OTHERWISE. The information contained within this document has been verified according
to the general principles of electrical and mechanical engineering.
S3 and Z8 are trademarks or registered trademarks of Zilog, Inc. All other product or service names are the
property of their respective owners.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
iii
Revision History
Each instance in this document’s revision history reflects a change from its previous edition. For more details, refer to the corresponding page(s) or appropriate links furnished in
the table below.
Date
Aug
2013
Revision
Level
Description
01
PS031201-0813
Page
Original Zilog issue. A table of contents and PDF bookmarks will appear in the All
next edition, due to be published on or before Winter 2013.
PRELIMINARY
Revision History
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
1
1
Product Overview
1.1 S3C8-Series Microcontrollers
SAM8RC family of Samsung of 8-bit single-chip Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor (CMOS)
microcontrollers offers a fast and efficient CPU, a wide range of integrated peripherals, and various maskprogrammable ROM sizes. Address/data bus architecture and a large number of bit-configurable Input/Output
(I/O) ports provide a flexible programming environment for applications with varied memory and I/O requirements.
It includes timer/counters with selectable operating modes to support real-time operations.
1.2 S3F8S19/F8S15 Microcontroller
It fabricates the S3F8S19/F8S15 single-chip CMOS microcontrollers by using the highly advanced CMOS process
technology based on the latest CPU architecture of Samsung.
The S3F8S19/F8S15 is a microcontroller with an embedded 32/16 Kbyte full-flash ROM.
By using a proven modular design approach, Samsung engineers have successfully developed the
S3F8S19/F8S15 by integrating these peripheral modules with the powerful SAM8 RC core:
x
Five configurable I/O ports (40 pin)
x
Twenty-six interrupt sources and Eight interrupt levels
x
Eight bit-programmable pins for external interrupts
x
One stop wake up timer function
x
One 8-bit basic timer for oscillation stabilization
x
One 8-bit timer/counter and Four 16-bit timer/counters with selectable operating modes
x
Watch timer for real time
x
LCD Controller/driver
x
Two asynchronous UART modules
x
One Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module
x
One Inter Integrated Circuit (IIC) module
x
Analog to digital converter with 10 input channels and 10-bit resolution
x
One Buzzer (BUZ) for programmable frequency output
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller is ideal for use in a wide range of home applications that requires simple
timer/counter, Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC), LCD, and so on. They are currently available in 48-pin QFP
package.
PS031201-0813
Comparison
S3F8S19
S3F8S15
Flash Size (Bytes)
32K
16K
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
2
1.3 Features
1.3.1 CPU
x
SAM88RC CPU core
1.3.2 Memory
Features of internal multi-time program Full-Flash memory are:
x
32K u 8 bits program memory (S3F8S19)
16K u 8 bits program memory (S3F8S15)
o
Sector size: 128 bytes
o
User programmable by "LDC" instruction
o
Sector erase available
o
Fast programming time
o
External serial programming support
o
Endurance: 10,000 erase/program cycles
o
10 Years data retention
Data Memory (RAM)
Including LCD display data memory
2,086 × 8 bits data memory
1.3.3 Instruction Set
x
Seventy eight instructions
x
Idle and Stop instructions
1.3.4 40 I/O Pins
x
Forty normal I/O pins for 48 pin
1.3.5 Interrupts
x
Eight interrupt levels and 26 interrupt sources
x
Fast interrupt processing feature
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
3
1.3.6 Timers and Timer/Counters
x
One programmable 8-bit basic timer (BT) for oscillation stabilization control or watchdog timer function.
x
One 8-bit timer/counter (Timer A) with three operating modes:
Interval mode
capture mode
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) mode
x
One 16-bit timer/counter (Timer 0) with Interval mode and PWM mode.
x
Two 16-bit timer/counter (Timer 1/2) with three operating modes:
Interval mode
Capture mode
PWM mode
x
One 16-bit timer/counter (Timer B) with one-shot pulse mode and repeating output mode. It can be triggered
by external input or software.
x
One STOP Wake-up Timer with Ring oscillator as its clock source.
1.3.7 Watch Timer
x
Interval time: 1.995 ms, 0.125s, 0.25s, and 0.5s at 32.768 kHz
x
0.5/1/2/4 kHz buzzer output selectable
1.3.8 Analog to Digital Converter
x
10-channel analog input
x
10-bit conversion resolution
1.3.9 Two Channels Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART)
x
Full-duplex serial I/O interface
x
Four programmable operating modes
x
Auto generating parity bit
1.3.10 Multi-Master IIC-Bus
x
Serial Peripheral Interface
x
Serial, 8-bit Data Transfers
x
Programmable Clock Pre-scale
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
4
1.3.11 SPI
x
Support Master and Slave Mode
x
Programmable Clock Pre-scale
1.3.12 LCD Controller/Driver
x
Sixteen segments and 8 common terminals
x
1/2, 1/3, 1/4, and 1/8 duty selectable
x
Resistor or capacitor bias selectable
x
Regulator and booster circuit for LCD bias
1.3.13 Two Power-Down Modes
x
Idle mode: Only CPU clock stops
x
Stop mode: System clock and CPU clock stop
1.3.14 Oscillation Sources
x
Main clock frequency: 0.4 MHz to 12.0 MHz
x
External RC for main clock
x
32 kHz external crystal or ceramic sub oscillator
x
Internal RC: 8 MHz (typ.), 4 MHz (typ.), 1 MHz (typ.), 0.5 MHz (typ.)
x
On-chip free running Ring oscillator with 32 kHz frequency for 16-bit Timer 1.
1.3.15 Instruction Execution Time
x
333 ns at fx = 12 MHz (minimum, main clock)
x
122 Ps at fxt = 32.768 kHz (sub clock)
1.3.16 Built-In RESET Circuit (LVR)
x
Low-Voltage check to reset system
x
VLVR = 1.9/2.3/3.0/3.9 V (by smart option)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
5
1.3.17 Low Voltage Detect Circuit (LVD)
x
Flag or Interrupt for Voltage drop detection
x
Programmable detect voltage: 2.1/2.5/3.2/4.1 V
x
Enable/Disable selected by software
1.3.18 Operating Voltage Range
x
1.8 V to 5.5 V at 4 MHz (main clock)
x
2.7 to 5.5 V at 12 MHz (main clock)
x
1.8 V to 5.5 V at 32.768 kHz (sub clock)
1.3.19 Package Type
x
48-pin QFP
1.3.20 Operating Temperature Range
x
– 40 qC to + 85 qC
1.3.21 Smart Option
x
ISP-related option selectable (ROM address 3EH)
x
Oscillator selection, LVR selection (ROM address 3FH)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
6
1.4 Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 illustrates the block diagram of S3F8S19/F8S15.
XIN
XOUT
XTIN XTOUT
Main OSC
Sub OSC
Stop Wakeup Timer
LCD Driver/
Controller
COM0-COM7
SEG0-SEG21
Basic Timer
I/O Port and Interrupt
Control
TACK
TACAP
TAOUT
Watch Timer
I/O Port 0
8-bit Timer/
Counter A
I/O Port 1
TBOUT
16-bit Timer/
Counter B
T0OUT
16-bit
Timer/Counter
0
T1CK
T1CAP
T1OUT
SAM88 RC
Core
16-bit
Timer/Counter
1
32/16K Byte
ROM
2086 Byte
RAM
P3.0-P3.7
I/O Port 4
P4.0-P4.7
UART0
TXD0
RXD0
UART1
TXD1
RXD1
SPI
10-bit ADC
Low Voltage
Reset
IIC
Figure 1-1
VSS
S3F8S19/F8S15 Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
P1.0-P1.7
I/O Port 3
SCK
MISO
MOSI
NSS
VDD
P0.0-P0.7
P2.0-P2.7
16-bit
Timer/Counter
2
TEST nRESET
BUZ
I/O Port 2
T2CK
T2OUT
T2CAP
PS031201-0813
Free
running
OSC
AD0-AD9
SDA
SCL
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
7
1.5 Pin Assignments
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
P4.6/TXD0/SEG20
P4.5/RXD1/SEG19
P4.4/SEG18/TXD1
P4.3/SEG17/TAOUT/TACAP
P4.2/SEG16/TACLK
P4.1/SEG15/TBOUT
P4.0/SEG14/T0OUT
P3.7/SEG13/INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP
P3.6/SEG12/INT6/T1CLK/SCL
P3.5/SEG11/INT5/T2CLK/SDA
P3.4/SEG10/INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP
P3.3/SEG9/NSS
Figure 1-2 illustrates the S3F8S19/F8S15 Pin Assignments.
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
S3F8S19/F8S15
(48-QFP)
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
P3.2/SEG8/SCK
P3.1/SEG7/MOSI
P3.0/SEG6/MISO
P2.7/COM7/SEG5
P2.6/COM6/SEG4
P2.5/COM5/SEG3
P2.4/COM4/SEG2
P2.3/COM3/SEG1
P2.2/COM2/SEG0
P2.1/COM1
P2.0/COM0
nRESET
ADC4/P0.4
INT3/ADC3/P0.3
INT2/ADC2/P0.2
INT1/ADC1/((SDAT)/P0.1
INT0/BUZ/ADC0/((SCLK)/P0.0
VDD
VSS
XOUT
XIN
(V
VPP)TEST
XTIN
XTOUT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
RXD0/SEG21/P4.7
CA/P1.0
CB/P1.1
VLC0/P1.2
VLC1/P1.3
VLC2/P1.4
VLC3/P1.5
ADC8/P1.6
ADC9/P1.7
ADC7/P0.7
ADC6/P0.6
ADC5/P0.5
Figure 1-2
PS031201-0813
S3F8S19/F8S15 Pin Assignments (48-QFP)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
8
1.6 Pin Descriptions
Table 1-1 describes the Pin Descriptions of 48-QFP.
Table 1-1
Pin Name
Pin
Type
Pin Descriptions of 48-QFP
Pin Description
Circuit
Type
Pin No.
5
P0.0
4–2
P0.1 – P0.3
P0.4
I/O port with bit-programmable pins
I/O
P0.5
Input or push-pull output and software
assignable pull-ups.
P1.1
I/O port with bit-programmable pins
P1.2 – P1.5
Input or push-pull output and software
assignable pull-ups.
ADC1 – ADC3
1
ADC4
48
ADC5
47 – 46
I/O
ADC0/INT0/BUZ/
/INT0 – INT3
F-16
P0.6 – P0.7
P1.0
Shared Functions
F-17
ADC6 – ADC7
38
CA
39
CB
40 – 43
VLC0 – VLC3
44 – 45
ADC8 – ADC9
14 – 15
COM0 – COM1
16 – 21
COM2 – COM7/
SEG0 – SEG5
Bit programmable output pins
P1.6 – P1.7
I/O
P2.0 – P2.1
Input or push-pull output and software
assignable pull-ups.
F-16
I/O port with bit-programmable pins
I/O
P2.2 – P2.7
Input or push-pull output and software
assignable pull-ups.
H-44
P3.0
22
SEG6/MISO
P3.1
23
MOSI/SEG7
24
SCK/SEG8
25
NSS/SEG9
26
INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP/SEG10
P3.5
27
INT5/SDA/SEG11
P3.6
28
INT6/T1CLK/SEG12/SCL
P3.7
29
INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP/SEG13
P4.0
30
T0OUT/SEG14
P4.1
31
TBOUT/SEG15
32
TACLK/SEG16
33
TAOUT/TACAP/SEG17
34
TXD1/SEG18
P4.5
35
TXD1/SEG19
P4.6
36
TXD0/SEG20
P4.7
37
RXD0/SEG21
P3.2
I/O port with bit-programmable pins
P3.3
I/O
P3.4
Schmitt trigger input or push-pull, open-drain
output and software assignable pull-ups.
H-41
P4.2
I/O port with bit-programmable pins
P4.3
I/O
P4.4
Input or push-pull, open-drain output and
software assignable pull-ups
H-42
COM0 – COM1
I/O
LCD common signal output.
COM2 – COM7
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
14 – 15
P2.0 – P2.1
16 – 21
P2.2 – P2.7/SEG0 – SEG5
H-44
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Pin Name
Pin
Type
Pin Description
Circuit
Type
9
Pin No.
Shared Functions
SEG6
22
P3.0/MISO
SEG7
23
P3.1/MOSI
SEG8
24
P3.2/SCK
25
P3.3/NSS
SEG10
26
P3.4/INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP
SEG11
27
P3.5/INT5/T2CLK/SDA
SEG12
28
P3.6/INT6/T1CLK/SCL
SEG13
29
P3.7/INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP
SEG14
30
P4.0/T0OUT
SEG15
31
P4.1/TBOUT
SEG16
32
P4.2/TACLK
33
P4.3/TAOUT/TACAP
SEG18
34
P4.4/TXD1
SEG19
35
P4.5/RXD1
SEG20
36
P4.6/TXD0
SEG21
37
P4.7/RXD0
SEG9
I/O
LCD segment signal output.
H-41
SEG17
I/O
LCD segment signal output.
H-42
CA
–
Capacitor terminal for voltage booster.
F-17
38
P1.0
CB
–
Capacitor terminal for voltage booster.
F-17
39
P1.1
VLC0 – VLC3
–
LCD power supply pins.
F-17
40 – 43
P1.2 – P1.5
ADC0
5
P0.0/INT0/BUZ/(SCLK)
ADC1
4
P0.1/INT1(SDAT)
3
P0.2/INT2
2
P0.3/INT3
ADC4
1
P0.4
ADC5 – ADC7
48 – 46
P0.5 – P0.7
44 – 45
P1.6 – P1.7
36
P4.6/SEG20
37
P4.7/SEG21
TXD1
34
P4.4/SEG18
RXD1
35
P4.5/SEG19
27
P3.5/SEG11/INT5/T2CLK
28
P3.6/SEG12/INT6/T1CLK
ADC2
F-16
ADC3
I/O
A/D converter analog input channels.
ADC8 – ADC9
F-16
TXD0
RXD0
I/O
UART data output, input
H-42
SDA
I/O
IIC data output, input
H-41
SCL
TAOUT
I/O
Timer A clock output and PWM output.
H-42
33
P4.3/SEG17/TACAP
TACAP
I/O
Timer A capture input.
H-42
33
P4.3/SEG17/TAOUT
TACLK
I/O
Timer A external clock input.
H-42
32
P4.2/SEG16
TBOUT
I/O
Timer B carrier frequency output
H-42
31
P4.1/SEG15
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
10
Pin Name
Pin
Type
T1CAP
I/O
Timer 1 capture input.
H-41
29
P3.7/SEG13/INT7/T1OUT/
T1CLK
I/O
Timer 1 external clock input.
H-41
28
P3.6/SEG12/INT6/SCL
T2OUT
I/O
Timer 2 clock output and PWM output.
H-41
26
P3.4/SEG10/INT4/T2CAP
T2CAP
I/O
Timer 2 capture input.
H-41
26
P3.4/SEG10/INT4/T2OUT
T2CLK
I/O
Timer 2 external clock input.
H-41
27
P3.5/SEG11/INT5/SDA
BUZ
I/O
Output pin for buzzer signal.
H-41
5
P0.0/ADC0/INT0/(SCLK)
SCK
I/O
SPI interface clock
H-41
24
P3.2/SEG8
MISO
I/O
SPl Master input slave output
H-41
22
P3.0/SEG6
MOSI
I/O
SPI Master output slave input
H-41
23
P3.1/SEG7
NSS
I
Slave selection
-
25
P3.3/SEG9
INT0 – INT3
I
External interrupt input pins
F-16
5–2
INT4 – INT7
I
External interrupt input pins
H-41
26 – 29
nRESET
I
System reset pin
B
13
–
Main oscillator pins.
–
–
Crystal oscillator pins for sub clock.
–
TEST
I
Test input: It should be connected 100nF
cap to GND.
–
10
–
VDD
–
Power supply input pin
–
6
–
VSS
–
Ground pins
–
7
–
XIN
XOUT
XTIN
XTOUT
PS031201-0813
Pin Description
PRELIMINARY
Circuit
Type
Pin No.
9
9
11
12
Shared Functions
P0.0 – P0.3/ADC0 – ADC3
P3.4 – P3.7/SEG10 –
SEG13
–
–
–
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
11
1.7 Pin Circuits
Figure 1-3 illustrates the pin circuit type A.
VDD
P-Channel
In
N-Channel
Figure 1-3
Pin Circuit Type A
Figure 1-4 illustrates the pin circuit type B.
VDD
Pull-Up
Resistor
In
Schmitt Trigger
Figure 1-4
Pin Circuit Type B
Figure 1-5 illustrates the pin circuit type C.
VDD
P-Channel
Data
N-Channel
Output
DIsable
Figure 1-5
PS031201-0813
Pin Circuit Type C
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
12
Figure 1-6 illustrates the pin circuit type F-16 (P0).
VDD
Pull-up
Enable
Data
Output
Disable
Circuit
Type C
I/O
ADCEN
ADC Select
Data
TO ADC
Figure 1-6
Pin Circuit Type F-16 (P0)
Figure 1-7 illustrates the pin circuit type H-39.
VLC0
VLC1/2
COM/
SEG
Out
Output
Disable
V LC2/3
Figure 1-7
PS031201-0813
Pin Circuit Type H-39
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
13
Figure 1-8 illustrates the pin circuit type H-44 (P2).
VDD
Pull-up
Enable
COM/
SEG
Output
Disable
Circuit
Type H-39
I/O
Data
Figure 1-8
Pin Circuit Type H-44 (P2)
Figure 1-9 illustrates the pin circuit type F-17 (P1).
VDD
Pull-up
Enable
Data
Output
Disable
Circuit
Type C
VLC/CA/CB
Select
Data
To LCD
Block
Figure 1-9
PS031201-0813
Pin Circuit Type F-17(P1)
PRELIMINARY
I/O
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
14
Figure 1-10 illustrates the pin circuit type H-41 (P3).
VDD
Pull-up
Enable
VDD
OPENDRAIN
Data
I/O
Output
Disable1
COM/
SEG
Output
Disable2
Circuit
Type H-39
Data
Figure 1-10
Pin Circuit Type H-41 (P3)
Figure 1-11 illustrates the pin circuit type H-42 (P4).
VDD
Pull-up
Enable
VDD
OPENDRAIN
Data
I/O
Output
Disable1
COM/
SEG
Output
Disable2
Circuit
Type H-39
Data
Figure 1-11
PS031201-0813
Pin Circuit Type H-42 (P4)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
15
2
Address Spaces
2.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller consists of kinds of address spaces, namely:
x
Internal program memory (Read only memory (ROM))
x
Internal register file
A 16-bit address bus supports program memory operations. A separate 8-bit register bus transmits addresses and
data between the CPU and the internal register file.
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller includes:
x
32/16 KB of on-chip program memory which is configured as the internal ROM mode.
x
2086 general-purpose registers in its internal register file. It maps 93 bytes in the register file for system and
peripheral control functions.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
16
2.2 Program Memory
Program memory (ROM) stores program codes or table data. S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller consists of 32/16
KB of internal multi-time programmable (MTP) program memory (Refer to Figure 2-1 for more information.).
The first 256 bytes of the ROM (0H–0FFH) are reserved for interrupt vector addresses. Unused locations (except
3CH, 3DH, 3EH, 3FH) in this address range can be used as normal program memory. If you use the vector
address area to store a program code, ensure not to overwrite the vector addresses stored in these locations.
3CH, 3DH, 3EH, 3FH is used as smart option ROM cell.
The default program reset address in the ROM is 0100H.
Figure 2-1 illustrates the address space of program memory.
(Hex)
7FFFH
32767
(Decimal)
16383
(Hex)
3FFFH
32K-bytes
Internal
Program
Memory Area
255
16K-bytes
Internal
Program
Memory Area
8FFH
Available
ISP Sector Area
Interrupt Vector Area
Smart Option
FFH
255
Available
ISP Sector Area
Interrupt Vector Area
3FH
Smart Option
3CH
00H
0
PS031201-0813
FFH
3FH
3CH
00H
0
Byte
S3F8S19
Figure 2-1
8FFH
Byte
S3F8S15
Program Memory Address Space
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
17
2.3 Smart Option
Figure 2-2 illustrates the smart option.
ROM Address: 003CH
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
.1
.0
LSB
.1
.0
LSB
Not used.
ROM Address: 003DH
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
Not used.
ROM Address: 003EH
MSB
.7
ISP Reset Vector Change Selection Bit:
0 = OBP Reset vector address
1 = Normal vector (address 100H)
.6
.5
(1)
.4
.3
.2
ISP Protection Size
Selection Bits: (4)
00 = 256 bytes
01 = 512 bytes
10 = 1024 bytes
11 = 2048 bytes
Not used
ISP Reset Vector Address Selection Bits:
00 = 200H (ISP Area size: 256 bytes)
01 = 300H (ISP Area size: 512 bytes)
10 = 500H (ISP Area size: 1024 bytes)
11 = 900H (ISP Area size: 2048 bytes)
(2)
ISP Protection Enable/Disable Bit:
0 = Enable (Not erasable)
1 = Disable (Erasable)
(3)
ROM Address: 003FH
MSB
LVR enable/disable
0 = disable
1 = enable
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
LVR level selection
Not used
00 = 1.9 V
01 = 2.3 V
10 = 3.0 V
11 = 3.9 V
.0
LSB
Oscillator selection bits:
000 = External crystal/ceramic oscillator
001 = External RC
100 = Internal RC (0.5 MHz in VDD = 5 V)
101 = Internal RC (1 MHz in VDD = 5 V)
110 = Internal RC (4 MHz in VDD = 5 V)
111 = Internal RC (8 MHz in VDD = 5 V)
NOTES:
1. By setting ISP Reset Vector Change Selection Bit (3EH.7) to ‘0’, user can have the available ISP area.
If ISP Reset Vector Change Selection Bit (3EH.7) is ‘1’, 3EH.6 and 3EH.5 are meaningless.
2. If ISP Reset Vector Change Selection Bit (3EH.7) is ‘0’, user must change ISP reset vector address from 0100H
to some address which user want to set reset address (0200H, 0300H, 0500H or 0900H).
If the reset vector address is 0200H, the ISP area can be assigned from 0100H to 01FFH (256bytes).
If 0300H, the ISP area can be assigned from 0100H to 02FFH (512bytes). If 0500H, the ISP area can be
assigned from 0100H to 04FFH (1024bytes). If 0900H, the ISP area can be assigned from 0100H to 08FFH (2048bytes).
3. If ISP Protection Enable/Disable Bit is ‘0’, user can’t erase or program the ISP area selected by 3EH.1 and
3EH.0 in flash memory.
4. User can select suitable ISP protection size by 3EH.1 and 3EH.0. If ISP Protection Enable/Disable Bit(3EH.2)
is ‘1’, 3EH.1 and 3EH.0 are meaningless.
5. The unused bits of 3EH, 3FH must be set to ‘1’.
Figure 2-2
PS031201-0813
Smart Option
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Smart Option is the ROM option for the start condition of the chip. The ROM address that Smart Option uses is 18
from 003EH to 003FH. 003CH and 003DH are not used in S3F8S19/F8S15.
When any values that LDC instruction writes in the Smart Option area (003CH–003FH), it changes the data of the
area. However, it does not affect the Smart Option. OTP/MTP programmer (Writer tools) should write the data for
Smart Option in the Smart Option area.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
19
2.4 Register Architecture
In the implementation of S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, the upper 64 byte area of register files is expanded two
64 byte areas called set 1 and set 2. The upper 32 byte area of set 1 is further expanded two 32 byte register
banks (bank 0 and bank 1), and the lower 32 byte area is a single 32 byte common area.
In case of S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, the total number of addressable 8-bit registers is 2183.
Out of these 2183 registers:
x
13 bytes are for CPU and system control registers
x
84 bytes are for peripheral control and data registers
x
16 bytes are for shared working registers
x
2070 registers are for general-purpose use, page 0-page 8 (including 22 bytes for LCD display registers).
You can always address set 1 register locations, regardless of which of the two register pages is currently
selected. However, you can address set 1 location by using register addressing modes.
Various addressing mode restrictions, the select bank instructions, SB0 and SB1, and the register page pointer
(PP) support the extension of register space into separately addressable areas (sets, banks, and pages).
Table 2-1 describes the specific register types and the area (in bytes) that they occupy in the register file.
Table 2-1
S3F8S19/F8S15 Register Type Summary
Register Type
System and peripheral registers
Number of Bytes
93
General-purpose registers
(including the 16-bit common working register area and LCD data register)
2086
Total addressable bytes
2183
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
20
Figure 2-3 illustrates internal register file organization (S3F8S19/F8S15).
FFH
Set 1
FFH
FFH
FFH
FFH
Bank 1
FFH
Bank 0
System and
Peripheral Control
System and
Registers
Peripheral Control
Registers
(Register Addressing Mode)
32
Bytes
DFH
Set 2
Registers
(Indirect Register,
Indexed Mode,
and Stack Operations)
System Registers
(Register Addressing Mode)
D0H
CFH
256
Bytes
Working Registers
(Working Register
Addressing Only)
C0H
Page 1
Page 0
E0H
64
Bytes
Page 7
C0H
BFH
Page 0
~
~
~
45H
22
Byte
192
Bytes
Page 8
~
Prime
Data Registers
(All Addressing Modes)
LCD Display Register
~
Prime
Data Registers
(All Addressing Modes)
~
~
~
~
00H
30H
2FH
48
Byte
Peripheral control
(All Addressing Mode)
00H
Figure 2-3
PS031201-0813
Internal Register File Organization (S3F8S19/F8S15)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
21
2.5 Register Page Pointer
By using an 8-bit data bus, the S3F8-series architecture supports the logical expansion of the physical 256 byte
internal register file into 16 separately addressable register pages. The register page pointer (PP, DFH) controls
the page addressing
After a reset, the source value of PP (lower nibble) and the destination value (upper nibble) are always "0000",
automatically selecting page 0 as the source and destination page for register addressing.
Figure 2-4 illustrates the register PP.
Register Page Pointer (PP)
DFH ,Set 1, R/W
MS
B
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Destination register page selection bits:
Source register page selection bits:
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
NOTE:
Destination: Page 0
Destination: Page 1
Destination: Page 2
Destination: Page 3
Destination: Page 4
Destination: Page 5
Destination: Page 6
Destination: Page 7
Destination: Page 8
Source: Page 6
Source: Page 7
Source: Page 8
A hardware reset operation writes the 4-bit destination and source values shown
above to the register page pointer(00H). These values should be modified to
other pages
Figure 2-4
PS031201-0813
Source: Page 0
Source: Page 1
Source: Page 2
Source: Page 3
Source: Page 4
Source: Page 5
Register PP
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
22
2.6 Register Set 1
The term set 1 refers to the upper 64 bytes of the register file, located at C0H–FFH.
The upper 32 byte area of this 64 byte space (E0H–FFH) is expanded two 32 byte register banks, bank 0 and
bank 1. The set register bank instructions, SB0 or SB1, are used to address one bank or the other. A hardware
reset operation always selects bank 0 addressing.
The upper two 32 byte areas (bank 0 and bank 1) of set 1 (E0H–FFH) contains 46 mapped system and peripheral
control registers.
The lower 32 byte area contains 14 system registers (D0H–DFH) and a 16 byte common working register area
(C0H–CFH).
You can use the common working register area as a "scratch" area for data operations being performed in other
areas of the register file.
You can access the registers in set 1 location directly at any time by using register addressing mode. You can
access the 16 byte working register area by using working register addressing only (Refer to Chapter 3
"Addressing Modes" for more information about working register addressing).
2.7 Register Set 2
The same 64 byte physical space that is used for set 1 location C0H to FFH is logically duplicated to add another
64 bytes of register space. This expanded area of the register file is called set 2. For S3F8S19/F8S15
microcontroller, you can access the set 2 address range (C0H–FFH) on RAM page 0-page 7.
Addressing mode restriction maintains the logical division of set 1 and set 2. You can use only addressing mode
register to access set 1 location. To access registers in set 2, use indirect addressing mode or Indexed addressing
mode register.
The set 2 register area is commonly used for stack operations.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
23
2.8 Prime Register Space
The lower 192 bytes (00H–BFH) of the S3F8S19/F8S15's 256 byte register pages is called prime register area.
You can access prime registers by using any of the seven addressing modes. Refer to Chapter 3 "Addressing
Modes" for more information.
It addresses the prime register area on page 0 immediately after a reset. To address prime registers on pages 0,
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7, you should set the register PP to the appropriate source and destination values.
Figure 2-5 illustrates the set 1, set 2, prime area register map, and LCD data register map.
Set 1
Bank 0
Bank 1
FFH
FFH
Page 7
FFH
Page
FFH
Page 1
1
Page 0
FFH
Set 2
FCH
E0H
D0H
C0H
C0H
BFH
Prime Space
CPU and system control
~
General-purpose
~
Peripheral and I/O
LCD data register
Figure 2-5
PS031201-0813
~
~
~
~
~45H
LCD Display
Register
30H
00H
Set 1, Set 2, Prime Area Register Map and LCD Data Register Map
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
24
2.9 Working Registers
Instructions can access specific 8-bit registers or 16-bit register pairs by using either 4-bit or 8-bit address fields.
When it uses 4-bit working register addressing, the programmer can see the 256 byte register file that consists of
thirty-two 8 byte register groups or "slices." Each slice consists of eight 8-bit registers.
Using the two 8-bit register pointers, RP1 and RP0, you can select the two working register slices at any time to
form a 16 byte working register block. By using the register pointers, you can move this 16 byte register block
anywhere in the addressable register file, except the set 2 area.
The terms "slice" and "block" helps to visualize the size and relative locations of selected working register spaces:
x
One working register slice is 8 bytes (eight 8-bit working registers, R0–R7 or R8–R15)
x
One working register block is 16 bytes (sixteen 8-bit working registers, R0–R15)
All the registers in an 8 byte working register slice have similar binary values for their five most significant address
bits. This makes it possible for each register pointer to point to one of the 24 slices in the register file. The base
addresses for the two selected 8-byte register slices are contained in register pointers RP0 and RP1.
After a reset, RP0 and RP1 always point to the 16 byte common area in set 1 (C0H–CFH).
Figure 2-6 illustrates 8 byte working register areas (slices)
FFH
F8H
F7H
F0H
Slice 32
Slice 31
1 1 1 1 1 X X X
Set 1
Only
RP1 (Registers R8-R15)
Each register pointer points to
one 8-by te slice of the register
space, selecting a total 16-by te
working register block.
CFH
C0H
~
~
0 0 0 0 0 X X X
RP0 (Registers R0-R7)
Slice 2
Slice 1
Figure 2-6
PS031201-0813
10H
FH
8H
7H
0H
8 Byte Working Register Areas (Slices)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
25
2.10 Using the Register Points
It uses register pointers RP0 and RP1 that it maps to address D6H and D7H in set 1 to select two movable 8-byte
working register slices in the register file. After a reset, they point to the working register common area: RP0
points to addresses C0H–C7H, and RP1 points to addresses C8H–CFH.
To change a register pointer value, load a new value to RP0 and/or RP1 by using an SRP or LD instruction.
(Refer to Figure 2-7 and Figure 2-8 for more information).
With working register addressing, you can only access those two 8-bit slices of the register file that are currently
pointed to by RP0 and RP1. However, you cannot use the register pointers to select a working register space in
set 2, C0H–FFH because you can access these locations only by using the indirect register or indexed addressing
modes.
The selected 16-byte working register block usually consists of two contiguous 8 byte slices. As a general
programming guideline, RP0 should point to the "lower" slice and RP1 should point to the "upper" slice (Refer to
Figure 2-8 for more information). In some cases, it may be necessary to define working register areas in different
(non-contiguous) areas of the register file. In Figure 2-8, RP0 points to the "upper" slice and RP1 to the "lower"
slice.
With the register pointer pointing to either of the two 8 byte slices in the working register block, you can flexibly
define the working register area to support program requirements.
Example 2-1 shows register pointer setting.
Example 2-1
SRP
Setting the Register Pointers
; RP0 m 70H, RP1 m 78H
#70H
SRP1
#48H
; RP0 m no change, RP1 m 48H
SRP0
#0A0H
; RP0 m A0H, RP1 m no change
CLR
RP0
; RP0 m 00H, RP1 m no change
LD
RP1, #0F8H
; RP0 m no change, RP1 m 0F8H
Figure 2-7 illustrates contiguous 16 byte working register block.
yGmG
jGZYG
_Ti G
z
WGGWGGWGGWGGXGGGGGG
_Ti G
z
ywX
WGGWGGWGGWGGWGGGGGG
_Ti G
z
ywW
Figure 2-7
PS031201-0813
moG
OyX\P
_o
^o
WoGOyWP
X]Ti G
jG
~G
yG
Contiguous 16 Byte Working Register Block
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
26
Figure 2-8 illustrates the non-contiguous 16 byte working register block.
8-By te Slice
F7H (R7)
F0H (R0)
1 1 1 1 0
X X X
Register File
Contains 32
8-By te Slices
X X X
8-By te Slice
16-By te
Contiguous
working
Register block
RP0
0 0 0 0 0
7H (R15)
0H (R0)
RP1
Figure 2-8
Non-Contiguous 16 Byte Working Register Block
Example 2-2 shows how to use the RPs to calculate the sum of a series of registers.
Example 2-2
Using the RPs to Calculate the Sum of a Series of Registers
Calculate the sum of registers 80H-85H by using the register pointer. The register addresses from 80H through 85H contain
the values 10H, 11H, 12H, 13H, 14H, and 15 H, respectively:
SRP0
#80H
; RP0 m 80H
ADD
R0, R1
; R0 m R0 + R1
ADC
R0, R2
; R0 m R0 + R2 + C
ADC
R0, R3
; R0 m R0 + R3 + C
ADC
R0, R4
; R0 m R0 + R4 + C
ADC
R0, R5
; R0 m R0 + R5 + C
The sum of these six registers, 6FH, is located in the register R0 (80H). The instruction string that it uses in this example
takes 12 bytes of instruction code and its execution time is 36 cycles. If the register pointer is not used to calculate the sum
of these registers, the following instruction sequence would have to be used:
ADD
80H, 81H
; 80H m (80H) + (81H)
ADC
80H, 82H
; 80H m (80H) + (82H) + C
ADC
80H, 83H
; 80H m (80H) + (83H) + C
ADC
80H, 84H
; 80H m (80H) + (84H) + C
ADC
80H, 85H
; 80H m (80H) + (85H) + C
Now, the sum of the six registers is also located in register 80H. However, this instruction string takes 15 bytes of instruction
code rather than 12 bytes and its execution time is 50 cycles rather than 36 cycles.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
27
2.11 Register Addressing
The S3C8-series register architecture provides an efficient method of working register addressing. This takes full
advantage of shorter instruction formats to reduce execution time.
With Register (R) addressing mode, in which the operand value is the content of a specific register or register pair,
you can access any location in the register file except for set 2. With working register addressing, you use:
x
A register pointer to specify an 8 byte working register space in the register file
x
An 8-bit register within that space
You can address the registers either as a single 8-bit register or as a paired 16-bit register space. In a 16-bit
register pair, the address of the first 8-bit register is always an even number and the address of the next register is
always an odd number. The most significant byte of the 16-bit data is always stored in the even-numbered
register, and the least significant byte is always stored in the next (+ 1) odd-numbered register.
Working register addressing is different from register addressing as it uses a register pointer to identify a specific 8
byte working register space in the internal register file and a specific 8-bit register within that space.
Figure 2-9 illustrates the 16-bit register pair.
MSB
LSB
Rn
Rn+1
Figure 2-9
PS031201-0813
n = Ev en address
16-Bit Register Pair
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
28
Figure 2-10 illustrates the register file addressing.
Special-Purpose Registers
Bank 1
General-Purpose Register
Bank 0
FFH
FFH
Control
Registers
E0H
Set 2
System
Registers
D0H
CFH
C0H
C0H
BFH
RP1
Register
Pointers
RP0
Each register pointer (RP) can independently point
to one of the 24 8-byte "slices" of the register file
(other than set 2). After a reset, RP0 points to
locations C0H-C7H and RP1 to locations C8H-CFH
(that is, to the common working register area).
NOTE:
Prime
Registers
In the S3F8S19 microcontroller,
page 0-8 are implemented.
00H
Register Addressing Only
Page 0
Page 0
All
Addressing
Modes
Indirect Register,
Indexed
Addressing
Modes
Can be Pointed by Register Pointer
Figure 2-10
PS031201-0813
Register File Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
29
2.12 Common Working Register Area (C0H–CFH)
After a reset, register pointers, RP0 and RP1 automatically select two 8 byte register slices in set 1; locations
C0H–CFH, as the active 16 byte working register block. These register slices are:
x
RP0 o C0H–C7H
x
RP1 o C8H–CFH
This 16 byte address range is called common area. That is, you can use locations in this area as working
registers. This occurs by operating that address any location on any page in the register file. Generally, these
working registers serve as temporary buffers for data operations between different pages.
Figure 2-11 illustrates the common working register area.
Set 1
FFH
Page 7
FFH
Page 1
1
FFH
Page
Page 0
FFH
Set 2
FFH
FCH
E0H
D0H
C0H
Following a hardware reset, register
pointers RP0 and RP1 point to the
common working register area,
locations C0H-CFH.
RP0 =
1100
0000
RP1 =
1100
1000
Figure 2-11
PS031201-0813
C0H
BFH
Prime Space
~
~
00H
Common Working Register Area
PRELIMINARY
~
~
~
~
~
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Example 2-3 shows addressing the common working register area.
Example 2-3
Addressing the Common Working Register Area
As shown in this example, you should access working registers in the common area, locations C0H–CFH, by
using working register addressing mode only.
Examples 1:
LD
0C2H, 40H
; Invalid addressing mode!
Use working register addressing instead:
SRP
#0C0H
LD
R2, 40H
; R2 (C2H) m the value in location 40H
0C3H, #45H
; Invalid addressing mode!
Examples 2:
ADD
Use working register addressing instead:
SRP
#0C0H
ADD
R3, #45H
PS031201-0813
; R3 (C3H) m
R3 + 45H
PRELIMINARY
30
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
31
2.13 4-Bit Working Register Addressing
Each register pointer defines a movable 8 byte slice of working register space. The address information stored in
a register pointer serves as an addressing "window." This makes it possible for instructions to access working
registers efficiently by using short 4-bit addresses. When an instruction addresses a location in the selected
working register area, it concatenates the address bits in this manner to form a complete 8-bit address:
x
The high-order bit of the 4-bit address selects one of the register pointers ("0" selects RP0, "1" selects RP1).
x
The five high-order bits in the register pointer select an 8 byte slice of the register space.
x
The three low-order bits of the 4-bit address select one of the eight registers in the slice.
As illustrated in Figure 2-12, it concatenates the result of this operation is that the five high-order bits from the
register pointer with the three low-order bits from the instruction address to form the complete address. As long as
the address that it stores in the register pointer remains unchanged, the three bits from the address always points
to an address in the same 8-byte register slice.
Figure 2-13 illustrates a typical example of 4-bit working register addressing. The high-order bit of the instruction
"INC R6" is "0", which selects RP0. It concatenates the five high-order bits that it stores in RP0 (01110B) with the
three low-order bits of the instruction's 4-bit address (110B) to produce the register address 76H (01110110B).
Figure 2-12 illustrates the 4-bit working register addressing.
RP0
RP1
Selects
RP0 or RP1
Address
OPCODE
4-bit address
prov ides three
low-order bits
Register pointer
prov ides f iv e
high-order bits
Together they create an
8-bit register address
Figure 2-12
PS031201-0813
4-Bit Working Register Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
32
Figure 2-13 illustrates the 4-bit working register addressing example.
RP1
RP0
0 1 1 1 0
0 0 0
0 1 1 1 1
0 0 0
Selects RP0
0 1 1 1 0
1 1 0
Figure 2-13
PS031201-0813
Register
address
(76H)
R6
OPCODE
0 1 1 0
1 1 1 0
Instruction
'INC R6'
4-Bit Working Register Addressing Example
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
33
2.14 8-Bit Working Register Addressing
You can also use 8-bit working register addressing to access registers in a selected working register area. To
initiate 8-bit working register addressing, the upper four bits of the instruction address should contain the 4-bit
value, "1100B." This value indicates that the remaining four bits have the same effect as 4-bit working register
addressing.
As Figure 2-14 illustrates, it concatenates the lower nibble of the 8-bit address in similar manner as for 4-bit
addressing: Bit 3 selects either RP0 or RP1, which then supplies the five high-order bits of the final address.
original instruction provides the three low-order bits of the complete address.
The
Figure 2-15 illustrates an example of 8-bit working register addressing. The four high-order bits of the instruction
address (1100B) specify 8-bit working register addressing. Bit 4 ("1") selects RP1 and the five high-order bits in
RP1 (10101B) turn into the five high-order bits of the register address.
The three low-order bits of the 8-bit instruction address provide the three low-order bits of the register address
(011) It concatenates the five address bits from RP1 and the three address bits from the instruction to form the
complete register address, 0ABH (10101011B).
Figure 2-14 illustrates the 8-bit working register addressing.
RP0
RP1
Selects
RP0 or RP1
Address
These address
bits indicate 8-bit
working register
addressing
1
1
0
0
Register pointer
prov ides f iv e
high-order bits
8-bit logical
address
Three low-order bits
8-bit phy sical address
Figure 2-14
PS031201-0813
8-Bit Working Register Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
34
Figure 2-15 illustrates the 8-Bit working register addressing example.
RP0
0 1 1 0 0
RP1
0 0 0
1 0 1 0 1
0 0 0
1 0 1 0 1
0 1 1
Selects RP1
R11
1 1 0 0
1
8-bit address
0 1 1 f orm instruction
'LD R11, R2'
Register
address
(0ABH)
Specif ies working
register addressing
Figure 2-15
PS031201-0813
8-Bit Working Register Addressing Example
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
35
2.15 System and User Stack
The S3C8-series microcontrollers use the system stack for data storage, subroutine calls, and returns. The PUSH
and POP instructions are used to control system stack operations. The S3F8S19/F8S15 architecture supports
stack operations in the internal register file.
2.15.1 Stack Operations
It stores return addresses for procedure calls, interrupts, and data on the stack. A CALL instruction saves the
contents of the PC to stack and RET instruction restores it. When an interrupt occurs, it pushes the contents of the
PC and the FLAGS register to the stack. The IRET instruction then pops these values back to their original
locations. It always decreases the stack address value by one before a push operation and increases by one after
a pop operation. The stack pointer (SP) always points to the stack frame that it stores on the top of the stack, as
illustrated in Figure 2-16.
Figure 2-16 illustrates the stack operations.
High Address
PCL
PCL
PCH
Top of
stack
PCH
Top of
stack
Stack contents
af ter a call
instruction
Flags
Stack contents
af ter an
interrupt
Low Address
Figure 2-16
Stack Operations
2.15.2 User-Defined Stacks
You can define stacks in the internal register file as data storage locations. The instructions PUSHUI, PUSHUD,
POPUI, and POPUD support user-defined stack operations.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
36
2.15.3 Stack Pointers (SPL, SPH)
Register locations D8H and D9H contain the 16-bit SP that it uses for system stack operations. The most
significant byte of the SP address, SP15–SP8, is stored in the SPH register (D8H), and the least significant byte,
SP7–SP0, is stored in the SPL register (D9H). After a reset, the SP value is undetermined.
Because it only implements internal memory space in the S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, it must initialize the
SPL to an 8-bit value in the range 00H–FFH. The SPH register is not needed and it can use it as a generalpurpose register, if necessary.
When the SPL register contains only the SP value (that is, when it points to a system stack in the register file), you
can use the SPH register as a general-purpose data register.
However, if an overflow or underflow condition occurs as a result of increasing or decreasing the stack address
value in the SPL register during normal stack operations, the value in the SPL register overflows (or underflows) to
the SPH register. This occurs by overwriting any other data that is currently stored there. To avoid overwriting data
in the SPH register, you can initialize the SPL value to "FFH" instead of "00H".
Example 2-4 shows how to perform stack operations in the internal register file by using PUSH and POP
instructions:
Example 2-4
LD
SPL, #0FFH
Standard Stack Operations Using PUSH and POP
; SPL m FFH
; (Normally, the SPL is set to 0FFH by the initialization routine)
•
•
•
PUSH
PP
; Stack address 0FEH m PP
PUSH
RP0
; Stack address 0FDH m RP0
PUSH
RP1
; Stack address 0FCH m RP1
PUSH
R3
; Stack address 0FBH m R3
POP
R3
; R3 m Stack address 0FBH
POP
RP1
; RP1 m Stack address 0FCH
•
•
•
POP
RP0
; RP0 m Stack address 0FDH
POP
PP
; PP m Stack address 0FEH
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
37
3
Addressing Modes
3.1 Overview
Instructions are stored in program memory are fetched for execution by using the program counter. Instructions
indicate the operation to be performed and the data to be operated on. Addressing mode is the method used to
determine the location of the data operand. The operands specified in SAM8RC instructions may be condition
codes, immediate data, or a location in the register file, program memory, or data memory.
The S3C-series instruction set supports seven explicit addressing modes.
Not all of these addressing modes are available for each instruction.
The seven addressing modes and their symbols are:
x
Register (R)
x
Indirect Register (IR)
x
Indexed (X)
x
Direct Address (DA)
x
Indirect Address (IA)
x
Relative Address (RA)
x
Immediate (IM)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
38
3.2 Register Addressing Mode
In Register addressing mode (R), the operand value is the content of a specified register or register pair
(Refer to Figure 3-1 for more information).
Working register addressing differs from Register addressing. In this, it uses a register pointer to specify an 8-byte
working register space in the register file and an 8-bit register within that space (Refer to Figure 3-2 for more
information).
Figure 3-1 illustrates the register addressing.
Program Memory
8-bit Register
File Address
dst
OPCODE
Register File
OPERAND
Point to One
Register in Register
File
One-Operand
Instruction
(Example)
Value used in
Instruction Execution
Sample Instruction:
DEC
CNTR
;
Where CNTR is the label of an 8-bit register address
Figure 3-1
Register Addressing
Figure 3-2 illustrates the working register addressing.
Register File
MSB Point to
RP0 ot RP1
RP0 or RP1
Selected
RP points
to start
of working
register
block
Program Memory
4-bit
Working Register
dst
3 LSBs
src
Point to the
Working Register
(1 of 8)
OPCODE
Two-Operand
Instruction
(Example)
OPERAND
Sample Instruction:
ADD
R1, R2
;
Figure 3-2
PS031201-0813
Where R1 and R2 are registers in the currently
selected working register area.
Working Register Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
39
3.3 Indirect Register Addressing Mode
In Indirect Register (IR) addressing mode, the content of the specified register or register pair is the address of the
operand. Depending on the instruction used, the actual address may point to a register in the register file to
program memory (ROM), or to an external memory space (Refer to Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-6 for more
information).
You can use any 8-bit register to indirectly address another register. Any 16-bit register pair can be used to
indirectly address another memory location. Please note, however, that you cannot access locations C0H–FFH in
set 1 using the Indirect Register addressing mode.
Figure 3-3 illustrates the indirect register addressing to register file.
Program Memory
8-bit Register
File Address
dst
OPCODE
One-Operand
Instruction
(Example)
Register File
Point to One
Register in Register
File
ADDRESS
Address of Operand
used by Instruction
Value used in
Instruction Execution
OPERAND
Sample Instruction:
RL
@SHIFT
Figure 3-3
PS031201-0813
;
Where SHIFT is the label of an 8-bit register address
Indirect Register Addressing to Register File
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
40
Figure 3-4 illustrates the indirect register addressing to program memory.
Register File
Program Memory
REGISTER
Example
Instruction
References
Program
Memory
dst
PAIR
Points to
Register Pair
OPCODE
Program Memory
Sample Instructions:
CALL
JP
Value used in
Instruction
@RR2
@RR2
Figure 3-4
16-Bit
Address
Points to
Program
Memory
OPERAND
Indirect Register Addressing to Program Memory
Figure 3-5 illustrates the indirect working register addressing to register file.
Register File
MSB Points to
RP0 or RP1
RP0 or RP1
Program Memory
4-bit
Working
Register
Address
dst
src
OPCODE
~
~
3 LSBs
Point to the
Working Register
(1 of 8)
ADDRESS
~
Sample Instruction:
OR
R3, @R6
Figure 3-5
PS031201-0813
Selected
RP points
to start f o
working register
block
Value used in
Instruction
~
OPERAND
Indirect Working Register Addressing to Register File
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
41
Figure 3-6 illustrates the indirect working register addressing to program or data memory.
Register File
MSB Points to
RP0 or RP1
RP0 or RP1
Selected
RP points
to start of
working
register
block
Program Memory
4-bit Working
Register Address
Example Instruction
Ref erences either
Program Memory or
Data Memory
dst
src
OPCODE
Next 2-bit Point
to Working
Register Pair
(1 of 4)
LSB Selects
Value used in
Instruction
Register
Pair
Program Memory
or
Data Memory
16-Bit
address
points to
program
memory
or data
memory
OPERAND
Sample Instructions:
LCD
LDE
LDE
Figure 3-6
PS031201-0813
R5,@RR6
R3,@RR14
@RR4, R8
;
;
;
Program memory access
External data memory access
External data memory access
Indirect Working Register Addressing to Program or Data Memory
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
42
3.4 Indexed Addressing Mode
Indexed (X) addressing mode adds an offset value to a base address during instruction execution to calculate the
effective operand address (Refer to Figure 3-7 for more information). You can use Indexed addressing mode to
access locations in the internal register file or in external memory. Please note, however, that you cannot access
locations C0H–FFH in set 1 using Indexed addressing mode.
In short offset Indexed addressing mode, the 8-bit displacement is treated as a signed integer in the range – 128
to + 127. This applies to external memory accesses only (Refer to Figure 3-8 for more information).
For register file addressing, the instruction that provides an 8-bit base address is added to an 8-bit offset
contained in a working register. For external memory accesses, the base address is stored in the working register
pair designated in the instruction. The 8-bit or 16-bit offset given in the instruction is then added to that base
address (Refer to Figure 3-9 for more information.).
The only instruction that supports Indexed addressing mode for the internal register file is the Load instruction
(LD). The LDC and LDE instructions support Indexed addressing mode for internal program memory and external
data memory, when implemented.
Figure 3-7 illustrates the indexed addressing to register file.
Register File
RP0 or RP1
¥
¥
Selected RP
points to
start of
working
register
block
Value used in
Instruction
OPERAND
+
Program Memory
Two-Operand
Instruction
Example
Base Address
dst/src
x
OPCODE
3 LSBs
¥
¥
INDEX
Point to One of the
Woking Register
(1 of 8)
Sample Instruction:
LD
R0, #BASE[R1]
Figure 3-7
PS031201-0813
;
Where BASE is an 8-bit immediate value
Indexed Addressing to Register File
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
43
Figure 3-8 illustrates the indexed addressing to program or data memory with short offset.
Register File
MSB Points to
RP0 or RP1
RP0 or RP1
~
~
Program Memory
4-bit Working
Register Address
OFFSET
dst/src
x
OPCODE
Selected
RP points
to start of
working
register
block
NEXT 2 Bits
Point to Working
Register Pair
(1 of 4)
LSB Selects
+
8-Bits
Register
Pair
Program Memory
or
Data Memory
16-Bit
address
added to
of f set
16-Bits
16-Bits
OPERAND
Value used in
Instruction
Sample Instructions:
LDC
R4, #04H[RR2]
;
LDE
R4,#04H[RR2]
;
Figure 3-8
PS031201-0813
The v alues in the program address (RR2 + 04H)
are loaded into register R4.
Identical operation to LDC example, except that
external program memory is accessed.
Indexed Addressing to Program or Data Memory with Short Offset
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
44
Figure 3-9 illustrates the indexed addressing to program or data memory.
Register File
MSB Points to
RP0 or RP1
RP0 or RP1
Program Memory
~
~
OFFSET
4-bit Working
Register Address
OFFSET
src
dst/src
Selected
RP points
to start of
working
register
block
NEXT 2 Bits
Point to Working
Register Pair
OPCODE
LSB Selects
+
8-Bits
Register
Pair
Program Memory
or
Data Memory
16-Bit
address
added to
of f set
16-Bits
16-Bits
OPERAND
Value used in
Instruction
Sample Instructions:
LDC
R4, #1000H[RR2]
;
LDE
R4,#1000H[RR2]
;
Figure 3-9
PS031201-0813
The v alues in the program address (RR2 + 1000H)
are loaded into register R4.
Identical operation to LDC example, except that
external program memory is accessed.
Indexed Addressing to Program or Data Memory
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
45
3.5 Direct Address Mode
In Direct Address (DA) mode, the instruction provides the operand's 16-bit memory address. Jump (JP) and Call
(CALL) instructions use this addressing mode to specify the 16-bit destination address that is loaded into the PC
whenever a JP or CALL instruction is executed.
The LDC and LDE instructions can use Direct Address mode to specify the source or destination address for Load
operations to program memory (LDC) or to external data memory (LDE), if it implements them.
Figure 3-10 illustrates the direct addressing for load instructions.
Program or
Data Memory
Program Memory
Upper Address By te
Lower Address By te
dst/src "0" or "1"
OPCODE
Memory
Address
Used
LSB Selects Program
Memory or Data Memory :
"0" = Program Memory
"1" = Data Memory
Sample Instructions:
LDC
R5,1234H
;
LDE
R5,1234H
;
Figure 3-10
PS031201-0813
The v alues in the program address (1234H)
are loaded into register R5.
Identical operation to LDC example, except that
external program memory is accessed.
Direct Addressing for Load Instructions
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Figure 3-11 illustrates the direct addressing for call and jump instructions.
Program Memory
Next OPCODE
Memory
Address
Used
Upper Address Byte
Lower Address Byte
OPCODE
Sample Instructions:
JP
CALL
C,JOB1
DISPLAY
Figure 3-11
PS031201-0813
;
;
Where JOB1 is a 16-bit immediate address
Where DISPLAY is a 16-bit immediate address
Direct Addressing for Call and Jump Instructions
PRELIMINARY
46
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
47
3.6 Indirect Address Mode
In Indirect Address (IA) mode, the instruction specifies an address located in the lowest 256 bytes of the program
memory. The selected pair of memory locations contains the actual address of the next instruction to be executed.
Only the CALL instruction can use the Indirect Address mode.
As the Indirect Address mode assumes that the operand is located in the lowest 256 bytes of program memory. It
supplies only 8-bit address in the instruction. It assumes that all the upper bytes of the destination are zeroes.
Figure 3-12 illustrates the indirect addressing.
Program Memory
Next Instruction
LSB Must be Zero
dst
Current
Instruction
OPCODE
Lower Address By te
Upper Address By te
Program Memory
Locations 0-255
Sample Instruction:
CALL
#40H
;
The 16-bit v alue in program memory addresses 40H
and 41H is the subroutine start address.
Figure 3-12
PS031201-0813
Indirect Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
48
3.7 Relative Address Mode
In Relative Address (RA) mode, a two-complement signed displacement between – 128 and + 127 is specified in
the instruction. Then it adds the displacement value to the current PC value. The result is the address of the next
instruction to execute. Before this addition occurs, the PC contains the address of the instruction immediately next
to the current instruction.
Several program control instructions use the Relative Address mode to perform conditional jumps.
The instructions that support RA addressing are:
x
BTJRF
x
BTJRT
x
DJNZ
x
CPIJE
x
CPIJNE
x
JR
Figure 3-13 illustrates the relative addressing.
Program Memory
Next OPCODE
Program Memory
Address Used
Displacement
OPCODE
Current Instruction
Current
PC Value
+
Signed
Displacement Value
Sample Instructions:
JR
ULT,$+OFFSET
;
Where OFFSET is a v alue in the range +127 to -128
Figure 3-13
PS031201-0813
Relative Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
49
3.8 Immediate Mode
In Immediate (IM) addressing mode, the operand value used in the instruction is the value supplied in the operand
field itself. The operand may be 1 byte or one word in length, depending on the instruction used. Immediate
addressing mode is useful for loading constant values into registers.
Figure 3-14 illustrates the immediate addressing.
Program Memory
OPERAND
OPCODE
(The Operand v alue is in the instruction)
Sample Instruction:
LD
Figure 3-14
PS031201-0813
R0,#0AAH
Immediate Addressing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
50
4
Control Registers
4.1 Overview
This chapter describes S3F8S19/F8S15 control registers in an easy-to-read format. The descriptions of
S3F8S19/F8S15 control registers help you to get familiar with the mapped locations in the register file. You can
also use them as a quick-reference source when writing application programs.
Table 4-1, Table 4-2, Table 4-3 and Table 4-4 describe system and peripheral registers. Figure 4-1 illustrates the
important features of the standard register description format.
Control register descriptions are alphabetically arranged according to register mnemonic. Part II of this manual
provides more information about control registers descriptions.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
51
Table 4-1 describes the system and peripheral control registers set 1.
Table 4-1
System and Peripheral Control Registers Set 1
Register Name
Mnemonic
A/D Converter Data register (high byte)
A/D Converter Data register (low byte)
Address
Decimal
Hex
ADDATAH
208
D0H
ADDATAL
209
A/D Converter Control register
ADCON
Basic Timer Control register
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
D1H
R
–
–
–
–
–
–
x
x
210
D2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BTCON
211
D3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLKCON
212
D4H
R/W
0
–
–
0
0
–
–
–
FLAGS
213
D5H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
0
Register pointer 0
RP0
214
D6H
R/W
1
1
0
0
0
–
–
–
Register pointer 1
RP1
215
D7H
R/W
1
1
0
0
1
–
–
–
Stack pointer (high byte)
SPH
216
D8H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Stack pointer (low byte)
SPL
217
D9H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Instruction pointer (high byte)
IPH
218
DAH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Instruction pointer (low byte)
IPL
219
DBH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Interrupt Request register
IRQ
220
DCH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Interrupt Mask register
IMR
221
DDH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
System Mode register
SYM
222
DEH
R/W
–
–
–
x
x
x
0
0
Register Page pointer
PP
223
DFH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
System Clock Control register
System Flags register
NOTE:
1.
An "x" means that the bit value is undefined following reset.
2.
Dash ("-") refers to the bit that is neither used nor mapped. However, it reads this bit as "0".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
52
Table 4-2 describes the system and peripheral control registers set 1 bank 0.
Table 4-2
System and Peripheral Control Registers Set 1 Bank 0
Register Name
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
TACNT
224
E0H
Timer A Data register
TADATA
225
Timer A Control register
TACON
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
226
E2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAPS
227
E3H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Counter register (high byte)
T0CNTH
232
E8H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Counter register (Low Byte)
T0CNTL
233
E9H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Data register (high byte)
T0DATAH
234
EAH
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 0 Data Register (low byte)
T0DATAL
235
EBH
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T0CON
236
ECH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T0PS
237
EDH
R/W
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Counter register (high byte)
T1CNTH
238
EEH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Counter register (low byte)
T1CNTL
239
EFH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Data register (High byte)
T1DATAH
240
F0H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 1 Data register (low byte)
T1DATAL
241
F1H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T1CON
242
F2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1PS
243
F3H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Counter register (high byte)
T2CNTH
244
F4H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Counter register (low byte)
T2CNTL
245
F5H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Data register (High Byte)
T2DATAH
246
F6H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 2 Data register (Low Byte)
T2DATAL
247
F7H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T2CON
248
F8H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T2PS
249
F9H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
WTCON
250
FAH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OSCCON
251
FBH
R/W
–
–
–
–
0
0
–
0
BTCNT
253
FDH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IPR
255
FFH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Timer A Counter register
Timer A pre-scalar
Location E4H to E7H is Not Mapped.
Timer 0 control register
Timer 0 pre-scalar
Timer 1 Control register
Timer 1 pre-scalar
Timer 2 Control register
Timer 2 pre-scalar
Watch Timer Control register
Oscillator Control register
Location FCH is Not Mapped
Basic Timer counter
Location FEH is Not Mapped
Interrupt Priority register
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
53
Table 4-3 describes the system and peripheral control registers set 1 bank 1.
Table 4-3
System and Peripheral Control Registers Set 1 Bank 1
Register Name
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Port 0 Control register (High Byte)
P0CONH
224
E0H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 0 Control register (Low Byte)
P0CONL
225
E1H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 0 Pull-up Resistor Enable
register
P0PUR
226
E2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 0 Interrupt Control register
P0INT
227
E3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Control Register (high byte)
P1CONH
228
E4H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Control register (Low byte)
P1CONL
229
E5H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Control register (high byte)
P2CONH
230
E6H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Control register (low byte)
P2CONL
231
E7H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Control register (high byte)
P3CONH
232
E8H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Control register (low byte)
P3CONL
233
E9H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 N-channel Open-drain Mode
register
PNE3
234
EAH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Interrupt control register
P3INT
235
EBH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Pull-up Resistor Enable
register
P3PUR
236
ECH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Pull-up Resistor Enable
register
P4PUR
237
EDH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Control register (high Byte)
P4CONH
238
EEH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Control register (low byte)
P4CONL
239
EFH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PNE4
240
F0H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 0 Data register
P0
241
F1H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Data register
P1
242
F2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Data register
P2
243
F3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Data register
P3
244
F4H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Data register
P4
245
F5H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
External Interrupt Pending register
PINTPND
246
F6H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SPI Control register
SPICON
247
F7H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SPI Status register
SPISTAT
248
F8H
R/W
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
0
SPI Data register
SPIDATA
249
F9H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Reset ID
RESETID
250
FAH
R/W
STOP Control register
STPCON
251
FBH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LMOD
252
FCH
R/W
–
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
Port 4 N-channel Open-drain Mode
register
LCD Mode register
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Refer to detail description
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Register Name
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
54
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCD Control register
LCON
253
FDH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LVD Control register
LVDCON
254
FEH
R/W
1
–
0
0
0
–
0
0
ROSCCON
255
FFH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Ring OSC Control register
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
55
Table 4-4 describes the system and peripheral control registers page 8.
Table 4-4
System and Peripheral Control Registers Page 8
Register Name
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UART0 Control register (high byte)
UART0CONH
0
00H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UART0 Control register (low byte)
UART0CONL
1
01H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UDATA0
2
02H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
BRDATA0
3
03H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
UART1 Control register (high byte)
UART1CONH
4
04H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UART1 Control register (low byte)
UART1CONL
5
05H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UDATA1
6
06H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
UART1 Baud Rate data register
BRDATA1
7
07H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Flash Memory Sector address
register (High Byte)
FMSECH
8
08H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory Sector Address
register (low byte)
FMSECL
9
09H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory User Programming
Enable register
FMUSR
10
0AH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory Control register
FMCON
11
0BH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
0
IIC Control register
ICCR
12
0CH
R/W
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
IIC Status register
ICSR
13
0DH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IIC Data Shift register
IDSR
14
0EH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
IAR
15
0FH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
SWTCON
16
10H
R/W
0
–
0
–
0
0
0
0
TBCON
17
11H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer B Reference Data register 0
(high byte)
TBDATA0H
18
12H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer B Reference Data register 0
(low byte)
TBDATA0L
19
13H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer B Reference Data register 1
(high byte)
TBDATA1H
20
14H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer B Reference Data register 1
(low byte)
TBDATA1L
21
15H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TBTRG
22
16H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Internal OSC Calibration Data
register
OSCCALDATA
23
17H
R/W
–
Internal OSC Calibration Control
register
OSCCALCON
24
18H
R/W
0
UART0 Data register
UART0 Baud Rate Data register
UART1 Data register
IIC Address register
Stop Wake-up Timer Control register
16-bit Timer B Control register
Timer B Trigger Control register
Refer to (NOTE)
0
0
0
0
0
NOTE: The reset value of OSCCALDATA register is factory-calibrated. Different chips may have different reset values.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
0
0
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
56
Figure 4-1 illustrates the register description format.
Bit number(s) that is/are appended to the
register name for bit addressing
Name of individual
Register
bit or related bits
Register name
ID
Register address
(hexadecimal)
D5H
FLAGS - System Flags Register
Bit Identifier
RESET Value
Read/Write
.7
.6
.5
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
x
R/W
x
R/W
x
R/W
x
R/W
x
R/W
x
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
Carry Flag (C)
0
Operation does not generate a carry or borrow condition
1
Operation generates carry-out or borrow into high-order bit7
Zero Flag
0
Operation result is a non-zero value
1
Operation result is zero
Sign Flag
0
Operation generates positive number (MSB = "0")
1
Operation generates negative number (MSB = "1")
R = Read-only
W = Write-only
R/W = Read/write
' - ' = Not used
Description of the
effect of specific
bit settings
Figure 4-1
PS031201-0813
RESET value notation:
'-' = Not used
'x' = Undetermind value
'0' = Logic zero
'1' = Logic one
Register Description Format
PRELIMINARY
Bit number:
MSB = Bit 7
LSB = Bit 0
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
57
4.1.1 ADCON-A/D Converter Control Register (D2H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .4
A/D Converter Input Selection Bits
0
0
0
0
Selects AD0
0
0
0
1
Selects AD1
0
0
1
0
Selects AD2
0
0
1
1
Selects AD3
0
1
0
0
Selects AD4
0
1
0
1
Selects AD5
0
1
1
0
Selects AD6
0
1
1
1
Selects AD7
1
0
0
0
Selects AD8
1
0
0
1
Selects AD9
Other values
.3
Invalid.
End-of-conversion Bit (read-only)
.2– .1
.0
0
Conversion not completed
1
Conversion completed
A/D Converter Clock Selection Bits
0
0
fosc/16
0
1
fosc/8
1
0
fosc/4
1
1
fosc/1 (fosc < 4MHz)
A/D Converter Start or Disable Bit
0
Disables operation
1
Starts operation
NOTE: Maximum ADC clock input = 4 MHz.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
58
4.1.2 BTCON-Basic Timer Control Register (D3H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .4
Watchdog Timer Function Disable Code(for System Reset)
1
0
1
0
Others
.3– .2
Disables watchdog timer function
Enables watchdog timer function
Basic Timer Clock Selection Bits
.1
0
0
fxx/4096
0
1
fxx/1024
1
0
fxx/128
1
1
Invalid bit
Basic Timer Counter Clear Bit
.0
0
No effect
1
Clears the basic timer counter value
(Cleared to "0" automatically after being cleared basic timer counter)
Clock Frequency Divider Clear Bit for Basic Timer and Timer Counters
0
No effect
1
Clears clock frequency dividers
(Cleared to "0" automatically after being cleared clock frequency dividers)
NOTE: When you write a "1" to BTCON.0 (or BTCON.1), the basic timer divider (or basic timer counter) is cleared.
The bit is then cleared automatically to "0".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
59
4.1.3 CLKCON-Clock Control Register (D4H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
–
–
0
0
–
–
–
R/W
–
–
R/W
R/W
–
–
–
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Oscillator IRQ Wake-up Function Bit
0
Enables IRQ for main wake-up in power down mode
1
Disables IRQ for main wake-up in power down mode
.6– .5
Does not use for the S3F8S19/F8S15
.4– .3
CPU Clock (System Clock) Selection Bits (NOTE)
.2– .0
0
0
fxx/16
0
1
fxx/8
1
0
fxx/2
1
1
fxx
Does not use for the S3F8S19/F8S15
NOTE: After a reset, the slowest clock (divided by 16) is selected as the system clock. To select faster clock speeds, load
appropriate values to CLKCON.3 and CLKCON.4
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
60
4.1.4 FLAGS-System Flags Register (D5H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Carry Flag (C)
.6
0
Operation does not generate a carry or borrow condition.
1
Operation generates a carry-out or borrows into high-order bit 7.
Zero Flag (Z)
.5
0
Operation result is a non-zero value.
1
Operation result is zero.
Sign Flag (S)
.4
0
Operation generates a positive number (MSB = "0").
1
Operation generates a negative number (MSB = "1").
Overflow Flag (V)
.3
0
Operation result is d + 127 and > – 128.
1
Operation result is > + 127 or < – 128.
Decimal Adjust Flag (D)
.2
0
Completes add operation
1
Completes subtraction operation
Half-Carry Flag (H)
.1
0
No carry-out of bit 3 or no borrow into bit 3 by addition or subtraction
1
Addition generated carry-out of bit 3 or subtraction generated borrow into bit 3
Fast Interrupt Status Flag (FIS)
.0
0
Interrupt return (IRET) in progress (when read)
1
Fast interrupt service routine in progress (when read)
Bank Address Selection Flag (BA)
PS031201-0813
0
Selects bank 0
1
Selects bank 1
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
61
4.1.5 FMCON-Flash Memory Control Register (0BH, Page 8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
–
–
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .4
Flash Memory Mode Selection Bits
0
1
0
1
Programming mode
1
0
1
0
Sector erase mode
0
1
1
0
Hard lock mode
Other values
.3
Not available
Sector Erase Status Bit
0
Sector erase success
1
Sector erase fail
.2– .1
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
.0
Flash Operation Start Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Stops operation
1
Starts operation (This bit will be cleared automatically just after the
corresponding operator completed).
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
62
4.1.6 FMSECH-Flash Memory Sector Address Register (High Byte) (08H, Page 8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .0
Flash Memory Sector Address Bits (High Byte)
th
th
15 - 8 bits to select a sector of flash ROM
NOTE: The high-byte flash memory sector address pointer value is the higher eight bits of the 16-bit pointer address.
4.1.7 FMSECL-Flash Memory Sector Address Register (Low Byte) (09H, Page 8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Flash Memory Sector Address Bit (Low Byte)
Seventh bit to select a sector of flash ROM
.6– .0
Bits 6 – 0
Don't care
NOTE: The low-byte flash memory sector address pointer value is the lower eight bits of the 16-bit pointer address.
4.1.8 FMUSR-Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (0AH, Page 8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .0
Flash Memory User Programming Enable Bits
PS031201-0813
10100101
Enables user programming mode
Other values
Disables user programming mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
63
4.1.9 ICCR-Multi-Master IIC-Bus Clock Control Register (0CH, PAGE8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Acknowledgement Enable Bit
.6
0
Acknowledges disable mode
1
Acknowledges enable mode
Tx Clock Selection Bit
.5
0
fosc/16
1
fosc/512
Multi-master IIC-Bus Tx/Rx Interrupt Enable Bit
.4
0
Disables
1
Enables
Multi-master
.3– .0
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
ICCR.3-0: Transmit Clock 4-bit Prescaler Bits
SCL clock = IICLK/CCR + 1
where, IICLK = fosc/16 when IICR.6 is "0", IICLK = fosc/512 when ICCR.6 is "1"
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
64
4.1.10 ICSR-IIC Status Register (0DH, PAGE 8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
Acknowledgement Enable Bit
.5
0
0
Slave receiver mode (Default mode)
0
1
Slave transmitter mode
1
0
Master receiver mode
1
1
Master transmitter mode
IIC-Bus Busy Bit
.4
0
IIC-bus is not busy
0
Stops condition generation
1
IIC-bus is busy (when read)
1
Stops condition generation (when write)
IIC-bus Interface Module Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables IIC-bus data transmit/receive
1
Enables IIC-bus data transmit/receive
Arbitration Lost Bit
Hardware sets this bit when the serial I/O interface in master transmit mode loses a
bus arbitration procedure. In slave mode this flag is set to "1" when ICCR.5 is "1" and
ICSR.2 is "0"
.2
Address Match Bit
.1
0
When Start or Stop or Reset condition was generated
1
When the received slave address matches to IAR register or general call
General Call Bit
.0
0
When Start/Stop condition is generated
1
When the received slave address is "00000000" (general call)
Received Acknowledge Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Receives ACK
1
Does not receive ACK
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
65
4.1.11 IMR-Interrupt Mask Register (DDH, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
.7
Interrupt Level 7 (IRQ7)
.6
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 6 (IRQ6)
.5
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 5 (IRQ5)
.4
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 4 (IRQ4)
.3
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 3 (IRQ3)
.2
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 2 (IRQ2)
.1
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 1 (IRQ1)
.0
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
Interrupt Level 0 (IRQ0)
0
Disables (masks)
1
Enables (unmasks)
NOTE: When an interrupt level is masked, the CPU does not recognize any interrupt requests that may be issued.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
66
4.1.12 IPH-Instruction Pointer (High Byte) (DAH, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
.7– .0
Instruction Pointer Address (High Byte)
The high-byte instruction pointer value is the upper 8 bits of the 16-bit instruction
pointer address (IP15–IP8). The lower byte of the IP address is located in the IPL
register (DBH).
4.1.13 IPL-Instruction Pointer (Low Byte) (DBH, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
.7– .0
Instruction Pointer Address (Low Byte)
The low-byte instruction pointer value is the lower 8 bits of the 16-bit instruction
pointer address (IP7–IP0). The upper byte of the IP address is located in the IPH
register (DAH).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
67
4.1.14 IPR-Interrupt Priority Register (FFH, BANK0)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
.7, .4 and .1
.6
Priority Control Bits for Interrupt Groups A, B, and C (NOTE)
0
0
0
Group priority undefined
0
0
1
B>C>A
0
1
0
A>B>C
0
1
1
B>A>C
1
0
0
C>A>B
1
0
1
C>B>A
1
1
0
A>C>B
1
1
1
Group priority undefined
Interrupt Subgroup C Priority Control Bit
.5
0
IRQ6 > IRQ7
1
IRQ7 > IRQ6
Interrupt Group C Priority Control Bit
.3
0
IRQ5 > (IRQ6, IRQ7)
1
(IRQ6, IRQ7) > IRQ5
Interrupt Subgroup B Priority Control Bit
.2
0
IRQ3 > IRQ4
1
IRQ4 > IRQ3
Interrupt Group B Priority Control Bit
.0
0
IRQ2 > (IRQ3, IRQ4)
1
(IRQ3, IRQ4) > IRQ2
Interrupt Group A Priority Control Bit
0
IRQ0 > IRQ1
1
IRQ1 > IRQ0
NOTE: Interrupt Group A - IRQ0, IRQ1
Interrupt Group B - IRQ2, IRQ3, IRQ4
Interrupt Group C - IRQ5, IRQ6, IRQ7
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
68
4.1.15 IRQ-Interrupt Request Register (DCH, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
.7
Level 7 (IRQ7) Request Pending Bit;
.6
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 6 (IRQ6) Request Pending Bit;
.5
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 5 (IRQ5) Request Pending Bit;
.4
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 4 (IRQ4) Request Pending Bit;
.3
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 3 (IRQ3) Request Pending Bit;
.2
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 2 (IRQ2) Request Pending Bit;
.1
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 1 (IRQ1) Request Pending Bit;
.0
0
Not pending
1
Pending
Level 0 (IRQ0) Request Pending Bit;
PS031201-0813
0
Not pending
1
Pending
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
69
4.1.16 LCON-LCD Control Register (FDH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
LCD Clock Selection Bits
.5– .3
0
0
fw/28 (128 Hz)
0
1
fw/27 (256 Hz)
1
0
fw/26 (512 Hz)
1
1
fw/25 (1024 Hz)
LCD Duty and Bias Selection Bits
0
0
0
1/8 duty, 1/4 bias
0
0
1
1/4 duty, 1/3 bias
0
1
0
1/3 duty, 1/3 bias
0
1
1
1/3 duty, 1/2 bias
1
x
x
1/2 duty, 1/2 bias
NOTE: "x" means don't care.
.2– .1
.0
LCD Bias Type Selection Bits (NOTE)
0
0
LCD invalid.
(VLC0 – VLC3, CA and CB are normal pins Input/Output (I/O pin)
0
1
Capacitor bias.
(VLC0 – VLC3, CA and CB are bias pins)
1
0
Internal resistor bias. (The voltage booster is always stopped and cut off;
VLC0 – VLC3, CA and CB are normal pins I/O pin)
1
1
External resistor bias. (The voltage booster is always stopped and cut off;
VLC0 – VLC3 are bias pins, CA and CB s are normal I/O pins)
LCD Display Control Bit
0
All LCD signals are low (The voltage booster is always stopped and cut off)
1
Turn display on (When LCON.2-.1 = "01", run and connect voltage booster)
NOTE:
1.
2.
3.
When LCON.2-.1 is selected to "01", P1.0- .5 is automatically selected to VLCn, CA and CB pin. (n = 0-3)
When LCON.2-.1 is capacitor bias selected, LCON.0 is select to "1" after 1 millisecond delay.
Refer to the program tip in Chapter 15 for more information.
When LCON.2-.1 is selected to "10", P1.0- .5 depends on P1CONH/L register.
When LCON.2-.1 are selected to "11", P1.2- .5 are automatically selected to VLCn. (n = 0-3)
CA and CB pins depend on P1CONL register.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
70
4.1.17 LMOD-LCD Mode Control Register (FCH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
–
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
Read/Write
–
–
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .3
Not used but keep always "0"
.2– .0
VLCD Voltage Selection Bits (Only when the capacitor bias is selected)
Values
PS031201-0813
1/4 Bias[V]
0
0
0
3.6 V
0
0
1
3.8 V
0
1
0
4.0 V
0
1
1
4.2 V
1
0
0
4.4 V
1
0
1
4.6 V
1
1
0
4.8 V
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
71
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Reset Value
0
–
0
0
–
–
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
–
R
R/W
–
–
R/W
R/W
.7
Low voltage detect (LVD) Enable/Disable Bit
0
Disables LVD
1
Enables LVD
.6
Not Used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.5
LVD Output Bit (Read Only)
.4
0
VDD > VLVD
1
VDD < VLVD
LVD Interrupt Enable/Disable Bit
0
Disables LVD interrupt
1
Enables LVD interrupt
.3– .2
Not Used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.1– .0
Detection Voltage Level Selection Bits
PS031201-0813
0
0
VLVD = 4.1 V
0
1
VLVD = 3.2 V
1
0
VLVD = 2.5 V
1
1
VLVD = 2.1 V
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
72
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
–
–
0
0
0
0
–
0
Read/Write
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
–
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .4
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
.3
Main Oscillator Control Bit
.2
0
RUNS main oscillator
1
STOPS main oscillator
Sub Oscillator Control Bit
0
RUNS sub oscillator
1
STOPS sub oscillator
.1
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
.0
System Clock Selection Bit
0
Selects main oscillator for system clock
1
Selects sub oscillator for system clock
NOTE: Only both main oscillator and sub oscillator are normally connected, OSCCON operation is effective.
4.1.20 OSCCALCON-Internal OSC Calibration Control Register (18H, PAGE8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .0
Internal OSC Calibration Control Bits
10100101
Enables OSCCALDATA register write
Other value
Disables OSCCALDATA register write
NOTE: Before writing OSCCALDATA register, you should set this OSCCALCON register as "10100101b".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
73
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P0.7/AD7 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (TAOUT)
1
0
Alternative function (AD7)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.6/AD6 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (TBOUT)
1
0
Alternative function (AD6)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.5/AD5 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (T0OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (AD5)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.4/AD4 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (T1OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (AD4)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
74
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P0.3/AD3 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (T2OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (AD3)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.2/AD2 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Not used
1
0
Alternative function (AD2)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.1/AD1 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Not used
1
0
Alternative function (AD1)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P0.0/AD0 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (BUZ)
1
0
Alternative function (AD0)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
75
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P0.7's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.6
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.6's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.5
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.5's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.4
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.4's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.3's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.2's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.1's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P0.0's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 0 is automatically disabled only when the corresponding pin is selected as push-pull output
or alternative function.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
76
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P0.3 (INT3) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P0.2 (INT2) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P0.1 (INT1) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P0.0 (INT0) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
77
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P1.7 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (ADC9)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.6 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (ADC8)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.5/VLC3 (NOTE) Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.4/VLC2 (NOTE) Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
NOTE: Refer to LCON Register in LCD chapter 15 for more information.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
78
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P1.3/VLC1 (NOTE) Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.2/VLC0 (NOTE) Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.1/CB (NOTE) Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P1.0/CA (NOTE) Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Not available
1
1
Push-pull output mode
NOTE: Refer to LCON register in LCD Chapter 15 for more information.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
79
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P2.7/SEG5/COM7 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.6/SEG4/COM6 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.5/SEG3/COM5 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.4/SEG2/COM4 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
80
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P2.3/SEG1/COM3 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.2/SEG0/COM2 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.1/COM1 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
P2.0/COM0 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Input mode; pull-up
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Push-pull output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
81
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P3.7/INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP/SEG13 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode (T1CAP)
0
1
Alternative function (T1OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.6/INT6/T1CLK/SEG12/SCL Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode (T1CLK)
0
1
Alternative function (IIC signal SCL) (NOTE)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.5/INT5/SDA /SEG11/ T2CLK Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode (T2CLK)
0
1
Alternative function (IIC signal SDA) (NOTE)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.4/INT4/ SEG10/ T2OUT/ T2CAP Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode (T2CAP)
0
1
Alternative function (T2OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
NOTE: If you want to use IIC open drain type, set PNE3.5 and PNE3.6 to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
82
4.1.30 P3CONL-Port 3 Control Register Low Byte (E9H, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P3.3/NSS/SEG9 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (NSS)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.2/ SCK/SEG8 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (SCK)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.1/MOSI/SEG7 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (MOSI)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P3.0/ MISO/SEG6 Configuration Bits
0
0
Schmitt trigger input mode
0
1
Alternative function (MISO)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
83
4.1.31 P3INT-Port 3 Interrupt Control Register (EBH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P3.7 (INT7) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P3.6 (INT6) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P3.5 (INT5) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
P3.4 (INT4) External Interrupt Configuration Bit
0
0
Disables interrupt
0
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
1
0
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
1
1
Enables interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
84
4.1.32 P3PUR-Port 3 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (ECH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P3.7's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.6
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.6's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.5
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.5's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.4
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.4's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.3's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.2's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.1's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P3.0's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 3 is automatically disabled only when the corresponding pin is selected as push-pull output85
or
alternative function
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
86
4.1.33 P4CONH-Port 4 Control Register High Byte (EEH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P4.7/RXD0/SEG21 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Input mode (RXD0)
0
1
Alternative function (RXD0 out)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.6/TXD0/SEG20 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Alternative function (TXD0)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.5/RXD1/SEG19 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode (RXD1)
0
1
Alternative function (RXD1 out)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.4/TXD1/SEG18 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Alternative function (TXD1)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
87
4.1.34 P4CONL-Port 4 Control Register Low Byte (EFH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
P4.3/TAOUT/TACAP/SEG17 Configuration Bits
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
0
Input mode (TACAP)
0
1
Alternative function (TAOUT)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.2/TACLK/SEG16 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode (TACLK)
0
1
Not available
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.1/TBOUT/SEG15 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Alternative function (TBOUT)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
P4.0/T0OUT/SEG14 Configuration Bits
0
0
Input mode
0
1
Alternative function (T0OUT)
1
0
Alternative function (LCD signal)
1
1
Output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
88
4.1.35 P4PUR-Port 4 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (EDH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P4.7's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.6
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.6's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.5
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.5's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.4
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.4's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.3's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.2's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.1's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
P4.0's Pull-up Resistor Enable Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Disables pull-up resistor
1
Enables pull-up resistor
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 4 is automatically disabled only when the corresponding pin is selected as pushpull output or alternative function
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
89
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
90
4.1.36 PNE3-Port 3 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (EAH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P3.7's Output Mode Selection Bit
.6
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.6's Output Mode Selection Bit
.5
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.5's Output Mode Selection Bit
.4
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.4's Output Mode Selection Bit
.3
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.3's Output Mode Selection Bit
.2
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.2's Output Mode Selection Bit
.1
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.1's Output Mode Selection Bit
.0
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P3.0's Output Mode Selection Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
91
4.1.37 PNE4-Port 4 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (F0H, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P4.7's Output Mode Selection Bit
.6
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.6's Output Mode Selection Bit
.5
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.5's Output Mode Selection Bit
.4
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.4's Output Mode Selection Bit
.3
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.3's Output Mode Selection Bit
.2
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.2's Output Mode Selection Bit
.1
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.1's Output Mode Selection Bit
.0
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
P4.0's Output Mode Selection Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drain output mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
92
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
P3.7 (INT7) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.6
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P3.6 (INT6) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.5
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P3.5 (INT5) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.4
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P3.4 (INT4) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.3
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P0.3 (INT3) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.2
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P0.2 (INT2) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.1
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P0.1 (INT1) External Interrupt Pending Bit
.0
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
P0.0 (INT0) External Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
93
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .4
Destination Register Page Selection Bits
0
0
0
0
Destination: page 0
0
0
0
1
Destination: page 1
0
0
1
0
Destination: page 2
0
0
1
1
Destination: page 3
0
1
0
0
Destination: page 4
0
1
0
1
Destination: page 5
0
1
1
0
Destination: page 6
0
1
1
1
Destination: page 7
1
0
0
0
Destination: page 8
Others
.3– .0
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
Source Register Page Selection Bits
0
0
0
0
Source: page 0
0
0
0
1
Source: page 1
0
0
1
0
Source: page 2
0
0
1
1
Source: page 2
0
1
0
0
Source: page 4
0
1
0
1
Source: page 5
0
1
1
0
Source: page 6
0
1
1
1
Source: page 7
1
0
0
0
Source: page 8
Others
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
NOTE:
1. In S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, the internal register file is configured as 9 pages (Pages 0-7, 8). The
7 are used for general purpose register file.
2.
/it uses page 8 of S3F8S19/F8S15 for LCD data register (30H–45H).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
pages 0-
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
94
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Read/Write
–
–
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .3
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.2
nReset pin Indicating Bit
.1
0
nReset pin does not generate reset (when read)
1
nReset pin generates reset (when it reads)
Watchdog Reset Indicating Bit
.0
0
Watch dog does not generate reset (when read)
1
Watch dog generates reset (when it reads)
LVR Indicating Bit
0
LVR does not generate reset (when it reads)
1
LVR generates reset (when it reads)
State of RESETID Depends on Reset Source
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LVR
–
–
–
–
–
0
0
1
WDT, or nReset pin
–
–
–
–
–
(3)
(3)
(2)
NOTE:
1.
To clear an indicating register, write "0" to indicate flag bit. By writing "1" to a reset the indicating flag
(RESETID.0-.1, RESETID.2) has no effect.
2.
Not affected by any other reset.
3.
Bits corresponding to sources that are active at the time of reset will be set.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
95
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Ring Oscillator (OSC) Enable Bit
.6– .0
PS031201-0813
0
Disables Ring OSC.
1
Enables Ring OSC.
Not Used.
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
96
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
1
1
0
0
0
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
–
–
–
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing only
.7– .3
Register Pointer 0 Address Value
Register pointer 0 can independently point to one of the 256-byte working register
areas in the register file.
By using the register pointers RP0 and RP1, you can select two 8-byte register slices
at a time as active working register space. After a reset, RP0 points to address C0H
in register set 1 by selecting the 8-byte working register slice C0H–C7H.
.2– .0
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
4.1.43 RP1-Register Pointer 1 (D7H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
1
1
0
0
1
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
–
–
–
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing only
.7– .3
Register Pointer 1 Address Value
Register pointer 1 can independently point to one of the 256-byte working register
areas in the register file.
By using the register pointers RP0 and RP1, you can select two 8-byte register slices
at a time as active working register space. After a reset, RP1 points to address C8H
in register set 1 by selecting the 8-byte working register slice C8H–CFH.
.2– .0
PS031201-0813
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
97
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing only
.7– .0
Stack Pointer Address (High Byte)
The high-byte stack pointer value is the upper eight bits of the 16-bit stack pointer
address (SP15–SP8). The lower byte of the stack pointer value is located in register
SPL (D9H). The SP value is undefined following a reset.
4.1.45 SPL-Stack Pointer Low Byte (D9H, SET1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing only
. 7– .0
Stack Pointer Address (Low Byte)
The low-byte stack pointer value is the lower eight bits of the 16-bit stack pointer
address (SP7–SP0). The upper byte of the stack pointer value is located in register
SPH (D8H). The SP value is undefined following a reset.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
98
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Interrupt Enable/Disable Bit
.6
0
Disables SPI Interrupt
1
Enables SPI Interrupt
SPI Enable Bit
.5
0
Disables SPI
1
Enables SPI
Data Order Selection Bit
.4
0
Least Significant Bit (LSB) First
1
Most Significant Bit (MSB) First
Master/Slave Mode Selection Bit
.3
0
Slave Mode
1
Master Mode
Clock Polarity Bit
.2
0
Clock Low when idle
1
Clock High when idle
Clock Phase Bit
.1– .0
PS031201-0813
0
Sample on the leading edge of SPCK
1
Sample on the trailing edge of SPCK
SPCK Rate Selection Bit
0
0
fosc/4
0
1
fosc/16
1
0
fosc/64
1
1
fosc/256
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
99
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
–
–
–
–
R/W
.7
SPI Interrupt Pending Bit
.6
0
No pending
1
Interrupt pending
Write Collision Bit
.5
0
No write collision
1
Write collision
Mode Fault Bit
.4– .1
.0
0
No Mode fault
1
Mode fault
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
0
Slave Mode
1
Master Mode
Double SPI Speed Bit
0
Single
1
Double when in Master Mode
4.1.48 STPCON-STOP Mode Control Register (FBH, BANK1)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .0
Stop Control Bit
10100101
Enables STOP instruction
Other value
Disables STOP instruction
NOTE:
1.
Before executing the STOP instruction, set this STPCON register as "10100101b".
2.
When STOPCON register is not set to #0A5H value, if you use STOP instruction, PC is changed to reset address.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
100
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
–
0
–
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7
STOP Wake-up Timer Enable bit
0
Disables STOP Wake-up Timer
1
Enables STOP Wake-up Timer
.6
Not used
.5
STOP Wake-up Timer Interrupt Enable bit
0
Disables Interrupt
1
Enables Interrupt
.4
Not used
.3– .0
STOP Wake-up Timer pre-scalar bits (SWTPSB)
SWTPSB[3-0]
SWTCLK = FCLK/(2
)
NOTE:
1.
Prescaler values (SWTPSB) higher than 12 are NOT valid.
2.
Retain bits .6 and .4 as default value "0".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
101
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
–
–
–
x
x
x
0
0
Read/Write
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .5
Not used for the S3F8S19/F8S15
.4– .2
Fast Interrupt Level Selection Bits (1)
0
0
0
IRQ0
0
0
1
IRQ1
0
1
0
IRQ2
0
1
1
IRQ3
1
0
0
IRQ4
1
0
1
IRQ5
1
1
0
IRQ6
1
1
1
IRQ7
Fast Interrupt Enable Bit (2)
.1
0
Disables fast interrupt processing
1
Enables fast interrupt processing
Global Interrupt Enable Bit (3)
.0
0
Disables all interrupt processing
1
Enables all interrupt processing
NOTE:
1.
You can select only one interrupt level at a time for fast interrupt processing.
2.
Setting SYM.1 to "1" enables fast interrupt processing for the interrupt level that SYM.2-SYM.4.currently selects.
3.
After a reset, enable global interrupt processing by executing an EI instruction
(not by writing a "1" to SYM.0).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
102
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .6
.5
Timer A Operating Mode Selection Bits
0
0
Interval mode (TAOUT mode)
0
1
Capture mode (capture on rising edge, counter running, Overflow (OVF)
occurs)
1
0
Capture mode (capture on falling edge, counter running, OVF occurs)
1
1
PWM mode (OVF interrupt can occur)
Timer A Counter Clear Bit
.4
0
No effect
1
Clears the timer A counter (After clearing, returns to zero)
Timer A Start/Stop Bit
.3
0
Stops Timer A
1
Starts Timer A
Timer A Match/Capture Interrupt Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer A Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer A Match Interrupt pending Bit
.0
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
Timer A Overflow Interrupt pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
103
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
R/W
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7
Timer A clock source selection
0
Internal clock source
1
External clock source from TACLK
.6– .5
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.3– .0
Timer A pre-scalar bits
TAPS[3-0]
TAPS = TA clock/(2
PS031201-0813
) Pre-scalar values higher than 12 are invalid
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
104
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .5
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.4– .3
Timer B Interrupt Time Selection Bits
.2
0
0
Generates after it borrows data0
0
1
Generates after it borrows data1
1
0
Generates after it borrows data0 and data1
1
1
Not available
Timer B Start/Stop Bit
.1
0
Disables timer B
1
Enables timer B
Timer B Mode Selection Bit
.0
0
One-shot mode
1
Repeat mode
Timer B Output Flip-flop Control Bit
PS031201-0813
0
TBOF is low (TBPWM: low level for data0, high level for data1)
1
TBOF is high (TBPWM: high level for data0, low level for data1)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
105
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7 – .6
Emergency detection pin selection bits: ( rising edge)
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1
0
0
Generates after it borrows data0
0
1
Generates after it borrows data1
1
0
Generates after it borrows data0 and data1
1
1
Not available
Trigger source selection bits:
0
0
P00
0
1
P01
1
0
P02
1
1
P03
INTX pin valid edge selection Bits:
0
0
Falling edge
0
1
Rising edge
1
X
Both falling and rising edge
Timer B trigger control by H/W or S/W:
0
Hardware control (external input trigger)
1
Software control (internal trigger)
Timer B trigger control by software:
(write only, automatically cleared after write "1")
.0
PS031201-0813
0
Does not trigger one-shot pulse
1
Triggers one-shot pulse
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
106
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .6
.5
Timer 0 Operating Mode Selection Bits
0
0
Interval mode (TAOUT mode)
0
1
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
1
0
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
1
1
PWM mode (OVF interrupt can occur)
Timer 0 Counter Clear Bit
.4
0
No effect
1
Clears the timer A counter (After clearing, return to zero)
Timer 0 Start/Stop Bit
.3
0
Stops Timer A
1
Starts Timer A
Timer 0 Match Interrupt Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 0 Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 0 Match Interrupt Pending Bit
.0
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
Timer 0 Overflow Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
107
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
–
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
.7– .5
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.3– .0
Timer 0 pre-scalar bits
T0PS[3-0]
T0PS = T0 clock/(2
PS031201-0813
) Pre-scalar values higher than 12 are invalid
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
108
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .6
.5
Timer 1 Operating Mode Selection Bits
0
0
Interval mode (T1OUT mode)
0
1
Capture mode (capture on rising edge, counter running, OVF occurs)
1
0
Capture mode (capture on falling edge, counter running, OVF occurs)
1
1
PWM mode (OVF interrupt can occur)
Timer 1 Counter Clear Bit
.4
0
No effect
1
Clears the timer A counter (After clearing, returns to zero)
Timer 1 Start/Stop Bit
.3
0
Stops Timer 1
1
Starts Timer 1
Timer 1 Match/Capture Interrupt Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 1 Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 1 Match Interrupt Pending Bit
.0
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
Timer 1 Overflow Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
109
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
R/W
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7
Timer 1 clock source selection
0
Internal clock source
1
External clock source from T1CLK
.6– .5
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.3– .0
Timer 1 pre-scalar bits
T1PS = T1 clock/(2
PS031201-0813
T1PS[3-0]
) Pre-scalar values higher than 12 are invalid
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
110
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7– .6
.5
Timer 2 Operating Mode Selection Bits
0
0
Interval mode (T2OUT mode)
0
1
Capture mode (capture on rising edge, counter running, OVF occurs)
1
0
Capture mode (capture on falling edge, counter running, OVF occurs)
1
1
PWM mode (OVF interrupt can occur)
Timer 2 Counter Clear Bit
.4
0
No effect
1
Clears the timer A counter (After clearing, returns to zero)
Timer 2 Start/Stop Bit
.3
0
Stops Timer 1
1
Starts Timer 1
Timer 2 Match/Capture Interrupt Enable Bit
.2
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 2 Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
.1
0
Disables interrupt
1
Enables interrupt
Timer 2 Match Interrupt pending Bit
.0
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
Timer 2 Overflow Interrupt pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (Clears pending bit when write)
1
Interrupt pending
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
111
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
RESET Value
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
R/W
–
–
–
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
.7
Timer 2 clock source selection
0
Internal clock source
1
External clock source from T2CLK
.6– .5
Not used for S3F8S19/F8S15
.3– .0
Timer 2 pre-scalar bits
T2PS = T2 clock/ (2
PS031201-0813
T2PS[3-0]
) Pre-scalar values higher than 12 are invalid
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
112
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
UART 0 Mode Selection Bits
.5
0
0
Mode 0: Shift register (fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
0
1
Mode 1: 8-bit UART (fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
1
0
Mode 2: 9-bit UART (fxx/16)
1
1
Mode 3: 9-bit UART (fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
Multiprocessor Communication Enable Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
.4
0
Disables
1
Enables
Serial Data Receive Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables
1
Enables
TB8 (Only when UART0CONL.7 = 0)
Location of the ninth data bit to be transmitted in Universal Asynchronous
Receiver/Transmitter (UART) 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 1, this bit is "don't care".
.2
RB8 (Only when UART0CONL.7 = 0)
Location of the ninth data bit to be received in UART 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
Note: When UART0CONL.7 = 1, this bit is "don't care".
.1
UART 0 Receive Interrupt Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables Rx interrupt
1
Enables Rx interrupt
UART 0 Receive Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (when read), Clears pending bit (when write)
1
Interrupt is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
113
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
UART 0 Transmit Parity-bit Auto-Generation Enable Bit
.6
0
Disables parity-bit auto-generation
1
Enables parity-bit auto-generation
UART 0 Transmit Parity-bit Selection Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 ONLY)
0
Even parity-bit
1
Odd parity-bit
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.5
UART 0 Receive Parity-bit Selection Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
0
Even parity-bit check
1
Odd parity-bit check
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.4
UART 0 Receive Parity-bit Error Status Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
0
No parity-bit error
1
Parity-bit error
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.3– .2
.1
UART 0 Clock Selection Bits
0
0
fxx/8
0
1
fxx/4
1
0
fxx/2
1
1
fxx/1
Uart 0 Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables Tx interrupt
1
Enables Tx interrupt
Uart 0 Transmit Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (when read), clears pending bit (when write)
1
Interrupt is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
114
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7– .6
UART 1 Mode Selection Bits
.5
0
0
Mode 0: Shift register (fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
0
1
Mode 1: 8-bit UART(fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
1
0
Mode 2: 9-bit UART(fxx/16)
1
1
Mode 3: 9-bit UART(fxx/(16 u (BR0DATA + 1)))
Multiprocessor Communication Enable Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
.4
0
Disables
1
Enables
Serial Data Receive Enable Bit
.3
0
Disables
1
Enables
TB8 (Only when UART1CONL.7 = 0)
Location of the ninth data bit to be transmitted in UART 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 1, this bit is "don't care".
.2
RB8 (Only when UART1CONL.7 = 0)
Location of the ninth data bit to be received in UART 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
NOTE: When UART0CONL.7 = 1, this bit is "don't care".
.1
Uart 1 Receive Interrupt Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables Rx interrupt
1
Enables Rx interrupt
Uart 1 Receive Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (when read), clears pending bit (when write)
1
Interrupt is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
115
4.1.64 UART1CONL-UART 1 Control Register Low Byte (05H, PAGE8)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
UART 1 Transmit Parity-bit Auto-Generation Enable Bit
.6
0
Disables parity-bit auto-generation
1
Enables parity-bit auto-generation
UART 1 Transmit Parity-bit Selection Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
0
Even parity-bit
1
Odd parity-bit
NOTE: When UART1CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.5
UART 1 Receive Parity-bit Selection Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
0
Even parity-bit check
1
Odd parity-bit check
NOTE: When UART1CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.4
UART 1 Receive Parity-bit Error Status Bit (for Modes 2 and 3 Only)
0
No parity-bit error
1
Parity-bit error
NOTE: When UART1CONL.7 = 0, this bit is "don't care".
.3– .2
.1
UART 1 Clock Selection Bits
0
0
fxx/8
0
1
fxx/4
1
0
fxx/2
1
1
fxx/1
Uart 1 Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables Tx interrupt
1
Enables Tx interrupt
Uart 1 Transmit Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
No interrupt pending (when read), clears pending bit (when write)
1
Interrupt is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
116
4.1.65 WTCON-Watch Timer Control Register (FAH, BANK0)
Bit Identifier
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
nRESET Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Read/Write
Addressing Mode
Register addressing mode only
.7
Watch Timer Clock Selection Bit
.6
0
Selects main clock divided by 128 (fx/128)
1
Selects sub clock (fxt)
Watch Timer Interrupt Enable Bit
.5– .4
.3– .2
.1
0
Disables watch timer interrupt
1
Enables watch timer interrupt
Buzzer Signal Selection Bits
0
0
0.5 kHz
0
1
1.0 kHz
1
0
2.0 kHz
1
1
4.0 kHz
Watch Timer Speed Selection Bits
0
0
Sets watch timer interrupt to 0.5 s
0
1
Sets watch timer interrupt to 0.25 s
1
0
Sets watch timer interrupt to 0.125 s
1
1
Sets watch timer interrupt to 1.995 ms
Watch Timer Enable Bit
.0
0
Disables watch timer. Clears frequency dividing circuits
1
Enables watch timer
Watch Timer Interrupt Pending Bit
PS031201-0813
0
Interrupt request is not pending; (when read) pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending (when read)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
117
5
Interrupt Structure
5.1 Overview
The S3C8/S3F8-series interrupt structure has three basic components:
x
Levels
x
Vectors
x
Sources
The SAM8RC CPU recognizes up to eight interrupt levels and supports up to 128 interrupt vectors. When a
specific interrupt level has multiple vector addresses, the vector priorities are established in hardware. A vector
address can be assigned to one or more sources.
5.1.1 Levels
Interrupt levels are the main unit for interrupt priority assignment and recognition. All peripherals and Input/Output
(I/O) blocks can issue interrupt requests. Alternatively, the peripheral and I/O operations are interrupt-driven.
There are eight possible interrupt levels: IRQ0–IRQ7, also called level 0-level 7. Each interrupt level directly
corresponds to an interrupt request number (IRQn). The total number of interrupt levels used in the interrupt
structure varies from device to device. The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller interrupt structure recognizes eight
interrupt levels.
The interrupt level numbers 0 through 7 do not necessarily indicate the relative priority of the levels. They are just
identifiers for the interrupt levels that are recognized by the CPU. The settings in the interrupt priority register
(IPR) determine the relative priority of different interrupt levels. Interrupt group and subgroup logic that IPR
settings control enables you to define more complex priority relationships between different levels.
5.1.2 Vectors
Each interrupt level can have one or more interrupt vectors, or it may have no vector address assigned at all. The
maximum number of vectors that can be supported for a given level is 128 (The actual number of vectors used for
S3C8/S3F8-series devices is always much smaller). If an interrupt level has multiple vector addresses, the vector
priorities are set in hardware. The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller uses 26 vectors.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
118
5.1.3 Sources
A source is any peripheral that generates an interrupt. A source can be an external pin or a counter overflow.
Each vector can have several interrupt sources. In S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller interrupt structure; there are
26 possible interrupt sources, which mean every source has its own vector.
When a service routine starts, the respective pending bit should be either cleared automatically by hardware or
cleared "manually" by software. The characteristics of the pending mechanism of source determine which method
would be used to clear its respective pending bit.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
119
5.2 Interrupt Types
The three components of the S3C8/S3F8 interrupt structure described before-levels, vectors, and sources-are
combined It combines them to determine the interrupt structure of an individual device and to make full use of its
available interrupt logic. There are three possible combinations of interrupt structure components, called interrupt
types 1, 2, and 3. The types differ in the number of vectors and interrupt sources that it assigns to each level
(Refer to Figure 5-1 for more information):
x
Type 1: One level (IRQn) + one vector (V1) + one source (S1)
x
Type 2: One level (IRQn) + one vector (V1) + multiple sources (S1 – Sn)
x
Type 3: One level (IRQn) + multiple vectors (V1 – Vn) + multiple sources (S1 – Sn , Sn+1 – Sn+m)
In the S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, two interrupt types are implemented.
Figure 5-1 illustrates the interrupt types of S3C8/S3F8-Series.
Type 1:
Levels
Vectors
Sources
IRQn
V1
S1
S1
Type 2:
IRQn
V1
S2
S3
Sn
Type 3:
IRQn
V1
S1
V2
S2
V3
S3
Vn
Sn
NOTES:
1. The number of Sn and Vn value is expandable.
2. In S3F8S19, interrupt types 1 and 2 are used.
Sn + 1
Sn + 2
Sn + m
Figure 5-1
PS031201-0813
S3C8/S3F8-Series Interrupt Types
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
120
5.3 S3F8S19/F8S15 Interrupt Structure
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller supports 26 interrupt sources. Every interrupt source has a corresponding
interrupt address. Eight interrupt levels are recognized by the CPU in this device-specific interrupt structure, as
illustrated in Figure 5-2.
When multiple interrupt levels are active, the interrupt priority register (IPR) determines the order in which
contending interrupts are to be serviced. If multiple interrupts occur within the same interrupt level, the interrupt
with the lowest vector address is usually processed first (The relative priorities of multiple interrupts within a single
level are fixed in hardware).
When the CPU grants an interrupt request, interrupt processing starts. All other interrupts are disabled and the
program counter value and status flags are pushed to stack. The starting address of the service routine is fetched
from the appropriate vector address (plus the next 8-bit value to concatenate the full 16-bit address) and the
service routine is executed.
Figure 5-2 illustrates the S3F8S19/F8S15 interrupt structure.
LEVEL
VECTOR
nRESET
100H
CCH
SOURCE
0
1
IRQ0
CEH
D0H
IRQ1
2
D2H
0
IRQ2
D4H
D6H
1
0
D8H
1
DAH
IRQ3
2
DCH
DEH
E0H
3
0
1
E2H
RESET/CLEAR
Basic Timer overflow
STW Timer
H/W
S/W
Timer A match/capture
S/W
Timer A overflow
H / W, S / W
Timer B match
H/W
Timer 0 match
S/W
Timer 0 overflow
H / W, S / W
Timer 1 match/capture
S/W
Timer 1 overflow
H / W, S / W
Timer 2 match/capture
S/W
Timer 2 overflow
H / W, S / W
LVD interrrupt
H/W
Watch timer overflow
S/W
SPI Interrupt
H / W, S / W
IRQ4
E4H
2
E6H
3
IIC transmit/receive interrupt
S/W
E8H
0
UART0 data transmit
S/W
UART0 data receive
S/W
UART1 data transmit
S/W
UART1 data receive
S/W
P0.0 External Interrupt
S/W
P0.1 External Interrupt
S/W
EAH
IRQ5
ECH
EEH
F0H
1
2
3
0
F2H
1
F4H
2
IRQ6
F6H
F8H
FAH
IRQ7
FCH
FEH
Figure 5-2
PS031201-0813
3
0
1
2
3
P0.2 External Interrupt
S/W
P0.3 External Interrupt
P3.4 External Interrupt
S/W
P3.5 External Interrupt
S/W
P3.6 External Interrupt
S/W
P3.7 External Interrupt
S/W
S/W
S3F8S19/F8S15 Interrupt Structure
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
121
5.3.1 Interrupt Vector Addresses
All interrupt vector addresses for the S3F8S19/F8S15 interrupt structure is stored in the vector address area of the
first 256 bytes of the program memory (ROM).
You can allocate unused locations in the vector address area as normal program memory. If you do so, ensure
not to overwrite any of the stored vector addresses.
The default program reset address in the ROM is 0100H.
Figure 5-3 illustrates the ROM vector address area.
(Decimal)
32,767
(HEX)
7FFFH
32K-byte
Program Memory
Area
100H
FFH
255
Interrupt Vector
Address Area
Default
Reset
Address
00H
0
Figure 5-3
ROM Vector Address Area
5.3.2 Enable/Disable Interrupt Instructions (EI, DI)
Executing the Enable Interrupts (EI) instruction globally enables the interrupt structure. All interrupts are then
serviced as they occur according to the established priorities.
NOTE: The system initialization routine executed after a reset should always contain an EI instruction to globally enable the
interrupt structure.
During the normal operation, you can execute the Disable Interrupt (DI) instruction at any time to globally disable
interrupt processing. The EI and DI instructions change the value of bit 0 in the system mode register (SYM)
register.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
122
5.4 System-Level Interrupt Control Registers
In addition to the control registers for specific interrupt sources, there are four system-level registers control
interrupt processing. They are:
x
The interrupt mask register, IMR, enables (un-masks) or disables (masks) interrupt levels.
x
The interrupt priority register, IPR, controls the relative priorities of interrupt levels.
x
The interrupt request register, IRQ, contains interrupt pending flags for each interrupt level (as opposed to
each interrupt source).
x
The system mode register, SYM, enables or disables global interrupt processing (SYM settings also enable
fast interrupts and control the activity of external interface, if implemented).
Table 5-1 describes the interrupt control register.
Table 5-1
Control Register
Interrupt mask register
Interrupt Control Register Overview
ID
R/W
IMR
R/W
Bit settings in the IMR register enables or disables processing of
interrupt for each of the eight interrupt levels: IRQ0–IRQ7.
Controls the relative processing priorities of the interrupt levels.
The eight levels of S3F8S19/F8S15 are organized into three
groups: A, B and C. Group A is IRQ0 and IRQ1, group B is IRQ2,
IRQ3and IRQ4, and group C is IRQ5, IRQ6, and IRQ7.
Interrupt priority register
IPR
R/W
Interrupt request register
IRQ
R
System mode register
SYM
R/W
Function Description
This register contains a request pending bit for each interrupt level.
This register enables/disables fast interrupt processing, and
dynamic global interrupt processing.
NOTE: All interrupts must be disabled before IMR register is changed to any value. Using DI instruction is recommended.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
123
5.5 Interrupt Processing Control Points
Interrupt processing can therefore be controlled in two ways:
x
globally
x
specific interrupt level and source
The system-level control points in the interrupt structure are:
x
Global interrupt enable and disable (by EI and DI instructions or by direct manipulation of SYM.0)
x
Interrupt level enable/disable settings (IMR register)
x
Interrupt level priority settings (IPR register)
x
Interrupt source enable/disable settings in the corresponding peripheral control registers
NOTE: While writing an application program that handles interrupt processing, ensure to include the necessary register file
address (register pointer) information.
Figure 5-4 illustrates the interrupt function diagram.
EI
S
nRESET
R
Q
Interrupt Request Register
(Read-only)
Polling
Cycle
IRQ0-IRQ7,
Interrupts
Interrupt Priority
Register
Vector
Interrupt
Cycle
Interrupt Mask
Register
Global Interrupt Control
(EI, DI or SYM.0
manipulation)
Figure 5-4
PS031201-0813
Interrupt Function Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
124
5.6 Peripheral Interrupt Control Registers
For each interrupt source there is one or more corresponding peripheral control registers that enable you to
control the interrupt generated by the related peripheral (Refer to Table 5-2 for more information).
Table 5-2 lists the interrupt source control and data registers.
Table 5-2
Interrupt Source Control and Data Registers
Interrupt Source
Timer A overflow
Timer A match/capture
Stop Wake up Timer
Timer B match
Timer 0 overflow
Timer 0 match/capture
Timer 1 overflow
Timer 1 match/capture Timer 2 overflow
Timer 2 match/capture
LVD Interrupt
Watch Timer overflow
SPI Interrupt
IIC transmit/receive Interrupt
PS031201-0813
Interrupt Level
Register (s)
Location (s)
IRQ0
TACON
TAPS
TADATA
TACNT
SWTCON
E2H, BANK0
E3H, BANK0
E1H, BANK0
E0H, BANK0
10H, PAGE8
IRQ1
TBCON
TBDATA0H
TBDATA0L
TBDATA1H
TBDATA1L
TBTRG
11H, PAGE8
12H, PAGE8
13H, PAGE8
14H, PAGE8
15H, PAGE8
16H, PAGE8
IRQ2
T0CON
T0DATAH
T0DATAL
T0CNTH
T0CNTL
T0PS
ECH, BANK0
EAH, BANK0
EBH, BANK0
E8H, BANK0
E9H, BANK0
EDH, BANK0
IRQ3
T1CON
T1DATAH
T1DATAL
T1CNTH
T1CNTL
T1PS T2CON
T2DATAH
T2DATAL
T2CNTH
T2CNTL
T2PS
F2H, BANK0
F0H, BANK0
F1H, BANK0
EEH, BANK0
EFH, BANK0
F3H, BANK0
F8H, BANK0
F6H, BANK0
F7H, BANK0
F4H, BANK0
F5H, BANK0
F9H, BANK0
IRQ4
LVDCON
WTCON
SPICCON
SPISTAT
SPIDATA
ICCR
ICSR
FEH, BANK1
FAH, BANK0
F7H, BANK1
F8H, BANK1
F9H, BANK1
0CH, PAGE8
0DH, PAGE8
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Interrupt Source
UART0 data transmit UART0 data
receive UART1 data transmit UART1
data receive
Interrupt Level
Register (s)
IDSR
IAR
Location (s)
0EH, PAGE8
0FH, PAGE8
IRQ5
UART0CONH
UART0CONL
UDATA0
BRDATA0
00H, PAGE8
01H, PAGE8
02H, PAGE8
03H, PAGE8
IRQ6
P0CONL
P0INT
PINTPND
E1H, BANK1
E3H, BANK1
F6H, BANK1
IRQ7
P3CONH
P3INT
PINTPND
E8H, BANK1
EBH, BANK1
F6H, BANK1
125
P0.0 External Interrupt
P0.1 External Interrupt
P0.2 External Interrupt
P0.3 External Interrupt
P3.4 External Interrupt
P3.5 External Interrupt
P3.6 External Interrupt
P3.7 External Interrupt
NOTE: If an interrupt is un-masked (Enables interrupt level) in the IMR register, a DI instruction should be executed before
clearing the pending bit or changing the enable bit of the corresponding interrupt.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
126
5.7 System Mode Register (SYM)
The system mode register, SYM (DEH, Set1), is used to globally enable and disable interrupt processing and to
control fast interrupt processing (Refer to Figure 5-5 for more information).
A reset clears SYM.1 and SYM.0 to "0". The 3-bit value for fast interrupt level selection, SYM.4-SYM.2, is
undetermined.
The instructions EI and DI enables and disables global interrupt processing, respectively, by modifying the bit 0
values of the SYM register. To enable interrupt processing an Enable Interrupt (EI) instruction must be included in
the initialization routine, which follows a reset operation. Although you can manipulate SYM.0 directly to enable
and disable interrupts during the normal operation, use EI and DI instructions for this purpose.
Figure 5-5 illustrates the system mode register (SYM).
System Mode Register (SYM)
DEH, Set1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
Always logic "0".
Fast interrupt level
selection bits:
Not used for the
S3F8S19
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
Figure 5-5
PS031201-0813
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
IRQ0
IRQ1
IRQ2
IRQ3
IRQ4
IRQ5
IRQ6
IRQ7
.0
LSB
Global interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable all interrupts processing
1 = Enable all interrupts processing
Fast interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable fast interrupts processing
1 = Enable fast interrupts processing
System Mode Register (SYM)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
127
5.8 Interrupt Mask Register (IMR)
The interrupt mask register, IMR (DDH, Set1) is used to enable or disable interrupt processing for individual
interrupt levels. After a reset, all IMR bit values are undetermined and therefore be written to their required
settings by the initialization routine.
Each IMR bit corresponds to a specific interrupt level: bit 1 to IRQ1, bit 2 to IRQ2 and so on. When the IMR bit of
an interrupt level is cleared to "0", interrupt processing for that level is disabled (masks). When you set a level's
IMR bit to "1", interrupt processing for the level is enabled (does not mask).
The IMR register is mapped to register location DDH, Set1. Bit values can be read and written by instructions
using the register addressing mode.
Figure 5-6 illustrates the interrupt mask register (IMR).
Interrupt Mask Register (IMR)
DDH, Set1, R/W
MSB
.7
IRQ7
NOTE:
.6
IRQ6
.5
IRQ5
IRQ4
.3
IRQ3
.2
IRQ2
.1
IRQ1
.0
LSB
IRQ0
Interrupt level enable bit:
0 = Disable (mask) interrupt level
1 = Enable (un-mask) interrupt level
Before IMR register is changed to any value,
all interrupts must be disable.
Using DI instruction is recommended.
Figure 5-6
PS031201-0813
.4
Interrupt Mask Register (IMR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
128
5.9 Interrupt Priority Register
The interrupt priority register, IPR (FFH, Set1, Bank0), is used to set the relative priorities of the interrupt levels in
the interrupt structure of microcontroller. After a reset, all IPR bit values are undetermined and therefore be written
to their required settings by the initialization routine.
When multiple interrupt sources are active, the source with the highest priority level is serviced first. If two sources
belong to the same interrupt level, the source with the lower vector address usually has the priority (This priority is
fixed in hardware).
To support programming of the relative interrupt level priorities, they are organized into groups and subgroups by
the interrupt logic. Note that these groups (and subgroups) are used only by IPR logic for the IPR register priority
definitions (Refer to Figure 5-7 for more information).
x
Group A
IRQ0, IRQ1
x
Group B
IRQ2, IRQ3, IRQ4
x
Group C
IRQ5, IRQ6, IRQ7
Figure 5-7 illustrates the interrupt request priority groups.
IPR
Group A
A1
IPR
Group B
A2
B1
IPR
Group C
B2
B21
IRQ0
IRQ1
IRQ2 IRQ3
Figure 5-7
PS031201-0813
C1
B22
IRQ4
C21
IRQ5 IRQ6
Interrupt Request Priority Groups
PRELIMINARY
C2
C22
IRQ7
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
In Figure 5-8, IPR.7, IPR.4 and IPR.1 controls the relative priority of interrupt groups A, B, and C. For example,129
the setting "001B" for these bits would select the group relationship B > C > A. The setting "101B" would select the
relationship C > B > A.
The functions of the other IPR bit settings are:
x
IPR.5 controls the relative priorities of group C interrupts.
x
Interrupt group C includes a sub-group that has an additional priority relationship among the interrupt levels 5,
6, and 7. IPR.6 defines the subgroup C relationship. IPR.5 controls the interrupt group C.
x
IPR.0 controls the relative priority setting of IRQ0 and IRQ1 interrupts.
Figure 5-8 illustrates the interrupt priority register (IPR).
Interrupt Priority Register (IPR)
FFH, Set1, Bank0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
Group priority:
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
= Undefined
=B>C>A
=A>B>C
=B>A>C
=C>A>B
=C>B>A
=A>C>B
= Undefined
Group B
0 = IRQ2 > (IRQ3, IRQ4)
1 = (IRQ3, IRQ4) > IRQ2
Subgroup B
0 = IRQ3 > IRQ4
1 = IRQ4 > IRQ3
Group C
0 = IRQ5 > (IRQ6, IRQ7)
1 = (IRQ6, IRQ7) > IRQ5
Subgroup C
0 = IRQ6 > IRQ7
1 = IRQ7 > IRQ6
Figure 5-8
PS031201-0813
LSB
Group A
0 = IRQ0 > IRQ1
1 = IRQ1 > IRQ0
D7 D4 D1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
.0
Interrupt Priority Register (IPR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
130
5.10 Interrupt Request Register (IRQ)
You can poll bit values in the interrupt request register, IRQ (DCH, Set1), to monitor interrupt request status for all
levels in the interrupt structure of microcontroller. Each bit corresponds to the interrupt level of the same number:
bit 0 to IRQ0, bit 1 to IRQ1, and so on. A "0" indicates that no interrupt request is currently being issued for that
level. A "1" indicates that an interrupt request has been generated for that level.
IRQ bit values are read-only addressable using register addressing mode. You can read (test) the contents of the
IRQ register at any time using bit or byte addressing to determine the current interrupt request status of specific
interrupt levels. After a reset, all IRQ status bits are cleared to "0".
You can poll IRQ register values even if a DI instruction has been executed (that is, if global interrupt processing
is disabled). When an interrupt occurs while the interrupt structure is disabled, the CPU will not service it. However
you can, still detect the interrupt request by polling the IRQ register. In this way, you can determine which events
occurred while the interrupt structure was globally disabled.
Figure 5-9 illustrates the interrupt control register (IRQ).
Interrupt Request Register (IRQ)
DCH, Set1, Read-only
MSB
.7
IRQ7
.6
IRQ6
.5
IRQ5
.3
IRQ4
IRQ3
.2
IRQ2
.1
IRQ1
.0
LSB
IRQ0
Interrupt level request pending bits:
0 = Interrupt level is not pending
1 = Interrupt level is pending
Figure 5-9
PS031201-0813
.4
Interrupt Request Register (IRQ)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
5.11 Interrupt Pending Function Types
131
This section includes:
x
Overview
x
Pending bits cleared automatically by hardware
x
Pending bits cleared by the service routine
5.11.1 Overview
There are two types of interrupt pending bits:
x
one type that is automatically cleared by hardware after the interrupt service routine is acknowledged and
executed
x
the other that must be cleared in the interrupt service routine
5.11.2 Pending Bits Cleared Automatically by Hardware
For interrupt pending bits that are cleared automatically by hardware, interrupt logic sets the corresponding
pending bit to "1" when a request occurs. It then issues an IRQ pulse to inform the CPU that an interrupt is waiting
to be serviced. The CPU acknowledges the interrupt source by sending an IACK, executes the service routine,
and clears the pending bit to "0". This type of pending bit is not mapped and cannot, therefore, be read or written
by application software.
In S3F8S19/F8S15 interrupt structure, Timer A, Timer 0, Timer 1 ,Timer 2 overflow interrupts, Timer B match
interrupt and LVD interrupt belong to this category of interrupts in which pending bits can be cleared automatically
by hardware.
5.11.3 Pending Bits Cleared by the Service Routine
The second type of pending bit is the one that should be cleared by program software. The service routine should
clear the appropriate pending bit before a return-from-interrupt subroutine (IRET) occurs. To do this, a "0" must be
written to the corresponding pending bit location in the mode of source or control register.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
5.12 Interrupt Source Polling Sequence
132
The interrupt request polling and servicing sequence is:
1. A source generates an interrupt request by setting the interrupt request bit to "1".
2. The CPU polling procedure identifies a pending condition for that source.
3. The CPU verifies the interrupt level of source.
4. The CPU generates an interrupt acknowledge signal.
5. Interrupt logic determines the vector address of interrupt.
6. The service routine starts and the source's pending bit is cleared to "0" (by hardware or by software).
7. The CPU continues polling for interrupt requests.
5.12.1 Interrupt Service Routines
Before an interrupt request is serviced, the following conditions must be met:
x
Interrupt processing must be globally enabled (EI, SYM.0 = "1")
x
The interrupt level must be enabled (IMR register)
x
The interrupt level should have the highest priority if more than one level is currently requesting service
x
The interrupt must be enabled at the source of interrupt (peripheral control register)
When all the above conditions are met, the interrupt request is acknowledged at the end of the instruction cycle.
The CPU then initiates an interrupt machine cycle that completes the processing sequence listed here:
1. Resets (clear to "0") the interrupt enable bit in the SYM register (SYM.0) to disable all subsequent interrupts.
2. Saves the program counter (PC) and status flags to the system stack.
3. Branches to the interrupt vector to fetch the address of the service routine.
4. Passes control to the interrupt service routine.
When the interrupt service routine is completed, the CPU issues an Interrupt Return (IRET). The IRET restores
the PC and status flags, setting SYM.0 to "1". It allows the CPU to process the next interrupt request.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
5.12.2 Generating Interrupt Vector Addresses
133
The interrupt vector area in the ROM (00H–FFH) contains the addresses of interrupt service routines that
correspond to each level in the interrupt structure. Vectored interrupt processing follows this sequence:
1. Push the low-byte of program counter value to the stack.
2. Push the high-byte of program counter value to the stack.
3. Push the FLAG register values to the stack.
4. Fetch the high-byte address of service routine from the vector location.
5. Fetch the low-byte address of service routine from the vector location.
6. Branch to the service routine specified by the concatenated 16-bit vector address.
NOTE: A 16-bit vector address always begins at an even-numbered ROM address within the range of 00H–FFH.
5.12.3 Nesting of Vectored Interrupts
It is possible to nest a higher-priority interrupt request while it services a lower-priority request.
To do this, you should follow these steps:
1. Push the current 8-bit interrupt mask register (IMR) value to the stack (PUSH IMR).
2. Load the IMR register with a new mask value that enables only the higher priority interrupt.
3. Execute an EI instruction to enable interrupt processing (a higher priority interrupt will be processed if it
occurs).
4. When the lower-priority interrupt service routine ends, execute DI, restore the IMR to its original value by
returning the previous mask value from the stack (POP IMR).
5. Execute an IRET.
Depending on the application, you may be able to simplify the procedure above to some extent.
5.12.4 Instruction Pointer
The instruction pointer (IP) is adopted by all the S3C8/S3F8-series microcontrollers to control the optional highspeed interrupt processing feature called fast interrupts. The IP consists of register pair DAH and DBH. The
names of IP registers are IPH (high byte, IP15–IP8) and IPL (low byte, IP7–IP0).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
134
5.12.5 Fast Interrupt Processing
The feature called fast interrupt processing enables an interrupt within a given level to be completed in
approximately 6 clock cycles rather than the usual 16 clock cycles. To select a specific interrupt level for fast
interrupt processing, you should write the appropriate 3-bit value to SYM.4–SYM.2. Then, to enable fast interrupt
processing for the selected level, you should set SYM.1 to "1".
Two other system registers support fast interrupt processing:
x
The instruction pointer (IP) that contains the starting address of the service routine (and later used to swap the
program counter
x
When a fast interrupt occurs, the contents of the FLAGS register are stored in an unmapped, dedicated
register called FLAGS' ("FLAGS prime").
NOTE: For the S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller, the service routines for any one of the eight interrupt levels: IRQ0–IRQ7, can
be selected for fast interrupt processing.
5.12.6 Procedure for Initiating Fast Interrupts
To initiate fast interrupt processing:
1. Load the start address of the service routine into the IP.
2. Load the interrupt level number (IRQn) into the fast interrupt selection field (SYM.4–SYM.2).
3. Write a "1" to the fast interrupt enable bit in the SYM register.
5.12.7 Fast Interrupt Service Routine
When an interrupt occurs in the level selected for fast interrupt processing, these events occur:
1. The contents of the instruction pointer and the PC are swapped.
2. The FLAG register values are written to the FLAGS' ("FLAGS prime") register.
3. The fast interrupt status bit in the FLAGS register is set.
4. The interrupt is serviced.
5. Assuming that the fast interrupt status bit is set, when the fast interrupt service routine ends, the instruction
pointer and PC values are swapped back.
6. The content of FLAGS' ("FLAGS prime") is copied automatically back to the FLAGS register.
7. The fast interrupt status bit in FLAGS is cleared automatically.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
5.12.8 Relationship to Interrupt Pending Bit Types
135
As described previously, there are two types of interrupt pending bits: One type that is automatically cleared by
hardware after the interrupt service routine is acknowledged and executed. The other that must be cleared by the
application program's interrupt service routine. You can select fast interrupt processing for interrupts with either
type of pending condition clear function - by hardware or by software.
5.13 Programming Guidelines
The only way to enable/disable a fast interrupt is to set/clear the fast interrupt enable bit in the SYM register,
SYM.1. Executing an EI or DI instruction globally enables or disables all interrupt processing, including fast
interrupts. If you use fast interrupts, ensure to load the IP with a new start address when the fast interrupt service
routine ends. Refer to IRET instruction in chapter 6 for more information.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
136
6
Instruction Set
6.1 Overview
The SAM8RC instruction set supports large register files that are typical of most SAM8 microcontrollers. There are
78 instructions.
The powerful data manipulation capabilities and features of the instruction set are:
x
Supports a full complement of 8-bit arithmetic and logic operations that includes multiplication and division
x
No special I/O instructions (I/O control/data registers are mapped directly into the register file)
x
Includes decimal adjustment in binary-coded decimal (BCD) operations
x
16-bit (word) data can be incremented and decremented
x
Provides flexible instructions for bit addressing, rotate, and shift operations
6.1.1 Data Types
The SAM8 CPU performs operations on bits, bytes, BCD digits, and two-byte words. Bits in the register file can be
set, cleared, complemented, and tested. Bits within a byte are numbered from 7 to 0, where bit 0 is the least
significant (right-most) bit.
6.1.2 Register Addressing
To access an individual register, an 8-bit address in the range 0-255 or the 4-bit address of a working register is
specified. Paired registers can be used to construct 16-bit data or 16-bit program memory or data memory
addresses. Refer to Chapter 2 "Address Spaces" for more information about register addressing.
6.1.3 Addressing Modes
There are seven explicit addressing modes, namely:
x
Register (R)
x
Indirect Register (IR)
x
Indexed (X)
x
Direct (DA)
x
Relative (RA)
x
Immediate (IM)
x
Indirect (IA)
Refer to Chapter 3 "Addressing Modes" for more information on these addressing modes.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
137
Figure 6-1 describes the Instruction Group summary.
Table 6-1
Mnemonic
Instruction Group Summary
Operands
Instruction
Load Instructions
CLR
dst
Clear
LD
dst, src
Load
LDB
dst, src
Load bit
LDE
dst, src
Load external data memory
LDC
dst, src
Load program memory
LDED
dst, src
Load external data memory and decrement
LDCD
dst, src
Load program memory and decrement
LDEI
dst, src
Load external data memory and increment
LDCI
dst, src
Load program memory and increment
LDEPD
dst, src
Load external data memory with pre-decrement
LDCPD
dst, src
Load program memory with pre-decrement
LDEPI
dst, src
Load external data memory with pre-increment
LDCPI
dst, src
Load program memory with pre-increment
LDW
dst, src
Load word
POP
dst
Pop from stack
POPUD
dst, src
Pop user stack (Decrementing)
POPUI
dst, src
Pop user stack (Incrementing)
PUSH
Src
Push to stack
PUSHUD
dst, src
Push user stack (Decrementing)
PUSHUI
dst, src
Push user stack (Incrementing)
Arithmetic Instructions
ADC
dst, src
Add with carry
ADD
dst, src
Add
CP
dst, src
Compare
DA
dst
Decimal adjust
DEC
dst
Decrement
DECW
dst
Decrement word
DIV
dst, src
Divide
INC
dst
Increment
INCW
dst
Increment word
MULT
dst, src
Multiply
SBC
dst, src
Subtract with carry
SUB
dst, src
Subtract
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Mnemonic
Operands
Instruction
Logic Instructions
AND
dst, src
Logical AND
COM
dst
Complement
OR
dst, src
Logical OR
XOR
dst, src
Logical exclusive OR
Program Control Instructions
BTJRF
dst, src
Bit test and jump relative on false
BTJRT
dst, src
Bit test and jump relative on true
CALL
dst
Call procedure
CPIJE
dst, src
Compare, increment and jump on equal
CPIJNE
dst, src
Compare, increment and jump on non-equal
DJNZ
r, dst
Decrement register and jump on non-zero
ENTER
–
Enter
EXIT
–
Exit
IRET
–
Interrupt return
JP
cc, dst
Jump on condition code
JP
dst
Jump unconditional
JR
cc, dst
Jump relative on condition code
NEXT
–
Next
RET
–
Return
WFI
–
Wait for interrupt
Bit Manipulation Instructions
BAND
dst, src
Bit AND
BCP
dst, src
Bit compare
BITC
dst
Bit complement
BITR
dst
Bit reset
BITS
dst
Bit set
BOR
dst, src
Bit OR
BXOR
dst, src
Bit XOR
TCM
dst, src
Test complement under mask
TM
dst, src
Test under mask
Rotate and Shift Instructions
RL
dst
Rotate left
RLC
dst
Rotate left through carry
RR
dst
Rotate right
RRC
dst
Rotate right through carry
SRA
dst
Shift right arithmetic
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
138
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Mnemonic
SWAP
Operands
dst
Instruction
Swap nibbles
CPU Control Instructions
CCF
–
Complement carry flag
DI
–
Disable interrupts
EI
–
Enable interrupts
IDLE
–
Enter Idle mode
NOP
–
No operation
RCF
–
Reset carry flag
SB0
–
Set bank 0
SB1
–
Set bank 1
SCF
–
Set carry flag
SRP
src
Set register pointers
SRP0
src
Set register pointer 0
SRP1
src
Set register pointer 1
STOP
PS031201-0813
–
Enter Stop mode
PRELIMINARY
139
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
140
6.2 Flags Register
The flags register (FLAGS) contains 8 bits that describe the current status of CPU operations. Four of these bits,
FLAGS.7–FLAGS.4, can be tested and used with conditional jump instructions; two others FLAGS.3 and FLAGS.2
are used for BCD arithmetic.
FLAGS also contain a bit to indicate the status of fast interrupt processing (FLAGS.1) and a bank address status
bit (FLAGS.0) to indicate whether bank 0 or bank 1 is currently being addressed. FLAGS can be set or reset by
instructions as long as its outcome does not affect the FLAGS, such as, Load instruction.
Logical and arithmetic instructions such as, AND, OR, XOR, ADD, and SUB can affect the FLAGS. For example,
the AND instruction updates the Zero, Sign and Overflow flags on the basis of outcome of the AND instruction.
When the AND instruction uses the FLAGS as the destination, two writes occur simultaneously to the FLAGS that
produces an unpredictable result.
Figure 6-1 illustrates the system Flags register (FLAGS).
System Flags Register (FLAGS)
D5H, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.0
LSB
Bank address
status flag (BA)
Carry flag (C)
Fast interrupt
status flag (FIS)
Zero flag (Z)
Sign flag (S)
PS031201-0813
.1
Half-carry flag (H)
Overflow flag (V)
Decimal adjust flag (D)
Figure 6-1
System Flags Register (FLAGS)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
141
6.3 Flag Descriptions
C
Carry Flag (FLAGS.7)
The C flag is set to "1" when the result from an arithmetic operation generates carry-out from or
borrow to the bit 7 position (MSB). After rotate and shift operations, it contains the last value shifted
out of the specified register. Program instructions can set, clear, or complement the carry flag.
Z
Zero Flag (FLAGS.6)
For arithmetic and logic operations, the Z flag is set to "1" if the result of the operation is zero. For
operations that test register bits, and for shift and rotate operations, the Z flag is set to "1" when the
result is logic zero.
S
Sign Flag (FLAGS.5)
Following arithmetic, logic, rotate, or shift operations, the sign bit identifies the state of the MSB of
the result. A logic zero indicates a positive number and a logic one indicates a negative number.
V
Overflow Flag (FLAGS.4)
The V flag is set to "1" when the result of a two's-complement operation is greater than + 127 or less
than–128. It also clears to "0" following logic operations.
D
Decimal Adjust Flag (FLAGS.3)
The DA bit is used to specify what type of instruction that it executed last during BCD operations so
that a subsequent decimal adjust operation can execute correctly. Usually, programmers cannot
access DA and cannot use as a test condition.
H
Half-Carry Flag (FLAGS.2)
The H bit is set to "1" whenever an addition generates a carry-out of bit 3, or when a subtraction
borrows out of bit 4. It is used by the Decimal Adjust (DA) instruction to convert the binary result of a
previous addition or subtraction into the correct decimal (BCD) result. A program seldom acceses
the H flag.
FIS
Fast Interrupt Status Flag (FLAGS.1)
The FIS bit is set during a fast interrupt cycle and resets during the Interrupt Return (IRET)following
interrupt servicing. When set, it inhibits all interrupts and causes the fast interrupt return to be
executed when the IRET instruction is executed.
BA
Bank Address Flag (FLAGS.0)
The BA flag indicates which register bank it currently selects in the set 1 area of the internal register
file, bank 0 or bank 1. The BA flag is cleared to "0" (select bank 0) when you execute the SB0
instruction and is set to "1" (select bank 1) when you execute the SB1 instruction.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
142
6.4 Instruction Set Notation
Table 6-2 describes the Flag Notation conventions.
Table 6-2
Flag Notation Conventions
Flag
Description
C
Carry flag
Z
Zero flag
S
Sign flag
V
Overflow flag
D
Decimal-adjust flag
H
Half-carry flag
0
Cleared to logic zero
1
Set to logic one
*
Set or cleared according to operation
–
Value is unaffected
x
Value is undefined
Table 6-3 describes the Instruction Set symbols.
Table 6-3
Instruction Set Symbols
Symbol
Description
dst
Destination operand
src
Source operand
@
Indirect register address prefix
PC
Program counter
IP
Instruction pointer
FLAGS
RP
Flags register (D5H)
Register pointer
#
Immediate operand or register address prefix
H
Hexadecimal number suffix
D
Decimal number suffix
B
Binary number suffix
opc
PS031201-0813
Opcode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
143
Table 6-4 describes the Instruction Notation conventions.
Table 6-4
Notation
Instruction Notation Conventions
Description
Actual Operand Range
Condition code
Refer to the list of condition codes in Table 6-7 for
more information.
r
Working register only
Rn (n = 0–15)
rb
Bit (b) of working register
Rn.b (n = 0–15, b = 0–7)
r0
Bit 0 (LSB) of working register
Rn (n = 0–15)
rr
Working register pair
RRp (p = 0, 2, 4, ..., 14)
R
Register or working register
reg or Rn (reg = 0–255, n = 0–15)
Rb
Bit "b" of register or working register
reg.b (reg = 0–255, b = 0–7)
RR
Register pair or working register pair
reg or RRp (reg = 0–254, even number only, where
p = 0, 2, ..., 14)
IA
Indirect addressing mode
addr (addr = 0–254, even number only)
Ir
Indirect working register only
@ Rn (n = 0–15)
IR
Indirect register or indirect working register
@ Rn or @ reg (reg = 0–255, n = 0–15)
Irr
Indirect working register pair only
@ RRp (p = 0, 2, ..., 14)
Indirect register pair or indirect working
register pair
@ RRp or @ reg (reg = 0–254, even only, where
p = 0, 2, ..., 14)
Indexed addressing mode
# reg [Rn] (reg = 0–255, n = 0–15)
XS
Indexed (short offset) addressing mode
# addr [RRp] (addr = range –128 to +127, where
p = 0, 2, ..., 14)
xl
Indexed (long offset) addressing mode
# addr [RRp] (addr = range 0–65535, where
p = 0, 2, ..., 14)
da
Direct addressing mode
addr (addr = range 0–65535)
ra
Relative addressing mode
addr (addr = number in the range + 127 to – 128 that
is an offset relative to the address of the next
instruction)
im
Immediate addressing mode
# data (data = 0–255)
iml
Immediate (long) addressing mode
# data (data = range 0–65535)
cc
IRR
X
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
144
Table 6-5 lists the Opcode quick reference (0–7).
Table 6-5
Opcode Quick Reference (0–7)
OPCODE Map
Lower Nibble (Hex)
–
–
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
U
0
DEC
R1
DEC
IR1
ADD
r1, r2
ADD
r1, Ir2
ADD
R2, R1
ADD
IR2, R1
ADD
R1, IM
BOR
r0–Rb
P
1
RLC
R1
RLC
IR1
ADC
r1, r2
ADC
r1, Ir2
ADC
R2, R1
ADC
IR2, R1
ADC
R1, IM
BCP
r1.b, R2
P
2
INC
R1
INC
IR1
SUB
r1, r2
SUB
r1, Ir2
SUB
R2, R1
SUB
IR2, R1
SUB
R1, IM
BXOR
r0–Rb
E
3
JP
IRR1
SRP/0/1
IM
SBC
r1, r2
SBC
r1, Ir2
SBC
R2, R1
SBC
IR2, R1
SBC
R1, IM
BTJR
r2.b, RA
R
4
DA
R1
DA
IR1
OR
r1, r2
OR
r1, Ir2
OR
R2, R1
OR
IR2, R1
OR
R1, IM
LDB
r0–Rb
5
POP
R1
POP
IR1
AND
r1, r2
AND
r1, Ir2
AND
R2, R1
AND
IR2, R1
AND
R1, IM
BITC
r1.b
N
6
COM
R1
COM
IR1
TCM
r1, r2
TCM
r1, Ir2
TCM
R2, R1
TCM
IR2, R1
TCM
R1, IM
BAND
r0–Rb
I
7
PUSH
R2
PUSH
IR2
TM
r1, r2
TM
r1, Ir2
TM
R2, R1
TM
IR2, R1
TM
R1, IM
BIT
r1.b
B
8
DECW
RR1
DECW
IR1
PUSHUD
IR1, R2
PUSHUI
IR1, R2
MULT
R2, RR1
MULT
IR2, RR1
MULT
IM, RR1
LD
r1, x, r2
B
9
RL
R1
RL
IR1
POPUD
IR2, R1
POPUI
IR2, R1
DIV
R2,RR1
DIV
IR2, RR1
DIV
IM, RR1
LD
r2, x, r1
L
A
INCW
RR1
INCW
IR1
CP
r1, r2
CP
r1, Ir2
CP
R2, R1
CP
IR2, R1
CP
R1, IM
LDC
r1, Irr2, xL
E
B
CLR
R1
CLR
IR1
XOR
r1, r2
XOR
r1, Ir2
XOR
R2, R1
XOR
IR2, R1
XOR
R1, IM
LDC
r2, Irr2, xL
C
RRC
R1
RRC
IR1
CPIJE
Ir, r2, RA
LDC
r1, Irr2
LDW
RR2, RR1
LDW
IR2, RR1
LDW
RR1, IML
LD
r1, Ir2
H
D
SRA
R1
SRA
IR1
CPIJNE
Irr, r2, RA
LDC
r2, Irr1
CALL
IA1
–
LD
IR1, IM
LD
Ir1, r2
E
E
RR
R1
RR
IR1
LDCD
r1, Irr2
LDCI
r1, Irr2
LD
R2, R1
LD
R2, IR1
LD
R1, IM
LDC
r1, Irr2, xs
X
F
SWAP
R1
SWAP
IR1
LDCPD
r2, Irr1
LDCPI
r2, Irr1
CALL
IRR1
LD
IR2, R1
CALL
DA1
LDC
r2, Irr1, xs
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
145
Table 6-6 lists the Opcode Quick references (8–F).
Table 6-6
Opcode Quick Reference (8–F)
OPCODE Map
Lower Nibble (Hex)
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
U
0
LD
r1, R2
LD
r2, R1
DJNZ
r1, RA
JR
cc, RA
LD
r1, IM
JP
cc, DA
INC
r1
NEXT
P
1
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
ENTER
P
2
EXIT
E
3
WFI
R
4
SB0
5
SB1
N
6
IDLE
I
7
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
STOP
B
8
DI
B
9
EI
L
A
RET
E
B
IRET
C
RCF
H
D
p
p
p
p
p
p
p
SCF
E
E
CCF
X
F
LD
r1, R2
LD
r2, R1
DJNZ
r1, RA
JR
cc, RA
LD
r1, IM
JP
cc, DA
INC
r1
NOP
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
146
6.5 Condition Codes
The opcode of a conditional jump always contains a 4-bit field called the condition code (cc). This specifies under
which conditions it is to execute the jump. For example, a conditional jump with the condition code for "equal" after
a compare operation only jumps if the two operands are equal.
The carry (C), zero (Z), sign (S) and overflow (V) flags are used to control the operation of conditional jump
instructions.
Table 6-7 describes the conditional codes.
Table 6-7
Binary
0000
Mnemonic
Condition Codes
Description
Flags Set
F
Always false
–
T
Always true
–
C
Carry
C=1
1111 (NOTE)
NC
No carry
C=0
0110 (NOTE)
Z
Zero
Z=1
1110 (NOTE)
NZ
Not zero
Z=0
1101
PL
Plus
S=0
0101
MI
Minus
S=1
0100
OV
Overflow
V=1
1000
0111
(NOTE)
1100
NOV
No overflow
V=0
(NOTE)
EQ
Equal
Z=1
1110 (NOTE)
NE
Not equal
Z=0
1001
GE
Greater than or equal
(S XOR V) = 0
0001
LT
Less than
(S XOR V) = 1
1010
GT
Greater than
(Z OR (S XOR V)) = 0
LE
Less than or equal
(Z OR (S XOR V)) = 1
UGE
Unsigned greater than or equal
C=0
0111 (NOTE)
ULT
Unsigned less than
C=1
1011
UGT
Unsigned greater than
(C = 0 AND Z = 0) = 1
0011
ULE
Unsigned less than or equal
(C OR Z) = 1
0110
0010
1111
(NOTE)
NOTE:
1.
It indicates condition codes that are related to two different mnemonics but that tests the same flag. For example, Z
and EQ are true if the zero flag (Z) is set, but after an ADD instruction, Z may be used; after a CP instruction, however, EQ
may be used.
2.
For operations involving unsigned numbers, the special condition codes UGE, ULT, UGT, and ULE must be used.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
147
6.6 Instruction Descriptions
This section describes information and programming examples for each instruction in the SAM8 instruction set. It
arranges information in a consistent format for improved readability and for fast referencing.
It includes the information listed in each instruction description:
x
Instruction name (mnemonic)
x
Full instruction name
x
Source/destination format of the instruction operand
x
Shorthand notation of the operation of information
x
Textual description of the effect of instruction
x
Specific flag settings affected by the instruction
x
Detailed description of the format of instruction, execution time, and addressing mode(s)
x
Programming example(s) that explians how to use the instruction
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
148
6.6.1 ADC-Add with Carry
ADC
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst + src + c
The source operand, along with the setting of the carry flag, is added to the destination operand
and the sum is stored in the destination. The contents of the source are unaffected. Two'scomplement addition is performed. In multiple precision arithmetic, this instruction permits the
carry from the addition of low-order operands to be carried into the addition of high-order
operands.
Flags:
C:
Sets if there is a carry from the most significant bit of the result; otherwise it clears.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurs, that is, if both operands are of the same sign and the
result is of the opposite sign; otherwise it clears.
D:
Always clears to "0".
H:
Sets if there is a carry from the most significant bit of the low-order four bits of the result;
otherwise it clears.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
12
r
r
6
13
r
lr
6
14
R
R
6
15
R
IR
6
16
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 10H, R2 = 03H, C flag = "1", register 01H = 20H, register 02H = 03H, and register
03H = 0AH:
ADC
ADC
ADC
ADC
ADC
R1, R2
R1, @R2
01H, 02H
01H, @02H
01H, #11H
o
o
o
o
o
R1 = 14H, R2
R1 = 1BH, R2
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
=
=
=
=
=
03H
03H
24H, register 02H = 03H
2BH, register 02H = 03H
32H
In the first example, destination register R1 contains the value 10H, the carry flag is set to "1", and
the source working register R2 contains the value 03H. The statement "ADC R1, R2" adds 03H
and the carry flag value ("1") to the destination value 10Hby leaving 14H in register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
149
6.6.2 ADD-Add
ADD
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst + src
The source operand is added to the destination operand and the sum is stored in the destination.
The contents of the source are unaffected. Two's-complement addition is performed.
Flags:
C:
Sets if there is a carry from the most significant bit of the result; cleared otherwise.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; cleared otherwise.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; cleared otherwise.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflowoccurs , that is, if both operands are of the same sign and the
result is of the opposite sign; cleared otherwise.
D:
Always cleared to "0".
H:
Sets if a carry from the low-order nibbleoccurs.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
02
r
r
6
03
r
lr
6
04
R
R
6
05
R
IR
6
06
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 12H, R2 = 03H, register 01H = 21H, register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0AH:
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
R1, R2
R1, @R2
01H, 02H
01H,@02H
01H, #25H
o
o
o
o
o
R1 = 15H, R2
R1 = 1CH, R2
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
=
=
=
=
=
03H
03H
24H, register 02H = 03H
2BH, register 02H = 03H
46H
In the first example, destination working register R1 contains 12H and the source working register
R2 contains 03H. The statement "ADD R1, R2" adds 03H to 12H by leaving the value 15H in
register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
150
6.6.3 AND-Logical AND
AND
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst AND src
The source operand is logically ANDed with the destination operand. The result is stored in the
destination. The AND operation results in a "1" bit being stored whenever the corresponding bits
in the two operands are both logic ones; otherwise a "0" bit value is stored. The contents of the
source are unaffected.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; cleared otherwise.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; cleared otherwise.
V:
Always cleared to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
52
r
r
6
53
r
lr
6
54
R
R
6
55
R
IR
6
56
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 12H, R2 = 03H, register 01H = 21H, register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0AH:
AND
AND
AND
AND
AND
R1, R2
R1,@R2
01H, 02H
01H, @02H
01H,#25H
o
o
o
o
o
R1 = 02H, R2
R1 = 02H, R2
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
=
=
=
=
=
03H
03H
01H, register 02H = 03H
00H, register 02H = 03H
21H
In the first example, destination working register R1 contains the value 12H and the source
working register R2 contains 03H. The statement "AND R1, R2" logically ANDs the source
operand 03H with the destination operand value 12H by leaving the value 02H in register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
151
6.6.4 BAND-Bit AND
BAND
dst, src.b
BAND
dst.b, src
Operation:
dst (0) m dst (0) AND src (b)
or
dst (b) m dst (b) AND src (0)
The specified bit of the source (or the destination) is logically ANDed with the zero bit (LSB) of the
destination (or source). The resultant bit is stored in the specified bit of the destination. No other
bits of the destination are affected. The source is unaffected.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; cleared otherwise.
S:
Clears to "0".
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not define.
H:
Does not define.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
src
opc
dst | b | 0
src
3
6
67
r0
Rb
opc
src | b | 1
dst
3
6
67
Rb
r0
NOTE: In the second byte of the 3 byte instruction formats, the destination (or source) address is 4 bits, the bit address "b" is
3 bits, and the LSB address value is 1 bit in length.
Examples:
Given: R1 = 07H and register 01H = 05H:
BAND
BAND
R1, 01H.1
01H.1, R1
o
o
R1 = 06H, register 01H = 05H
Register 01H = 05H, R1 = 07H
In the first example, source register 01H contains the value 05H (00000101B) and destination
working register R1 contains 07H (00000111B). The statement "BAND R1, 01H.1" ANDs the bit
1 value of the source register ("0") with the bit 0 value of register R1 (destination) by leaving the
value 06H (00000110B) in register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
152
6.6.5 BCP-Bit Compare
BCP
dst, src.b
Operation:
dst (0)-src (b)
The specified bit of the source is compared to (subtracts from) bit zero (LSB) of the destination.
The zero flag is set when the bits are the same; otherwise it clears. The comparison does not
affect the contents of both operands.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if two bits are similar; otherwise it clears.
S:
Clears to "0".
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not define.
H:
Does not define.
Format:
opc
dst | b | 0
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
6
17
src
Addr Mode
dst
src
r0
Rb
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the destination address is 4 bits, the bit address "b" is 3 bits, and the LSB
address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H and register 01H = 01H:
BCP
R1, 01H.1
o
R1 = 07H, register 01H = 01H
If destination working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B) and the source register
01H contains the value 01H (00000001B), the statement "BCP R1, 01H.1" compares 1 one of
the source register (01H) and bit 0 of the destination register (R1). As the bit values are
not identical, the zero flag bit (Z) is cleared in the FLAGS (0D5H).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
153
6.6.6 BITC-Bit Complement
BITC
dst.b
Operation:
dst (b) m NOT dst (b)
This instruction complements the specified bit within the destination without affecting any other
bits in the destination.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; Otherwise clears.
S:
Clears to "0".
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not define.
H:
Does not define.
Format:
opc
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
57
rb
dst | b | 0
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the destination address is 4 bits, the bit address "b".
is 3 bits, and the LSB address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H
BITC
R1.1
o
R1 = 05H
If working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B), the statement "BITC R1.1"
complements bit one of the destination and leaves the value 05H (00000101B) in register R1.
Because the result of the complement is not "0", the zero flag (Z) in the FLAGS (0D5H) is
cleared.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
154
6.6.7 BITR-Bit Reset
BITR
dst.b
Operation:
dst (b) m 0
The BITR instruction clears the specified bit within the destination without affecting any other bits
in the destination.
Flags:
Does not affect .
Format:
opc
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
77
rb
dst | b | 0
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the destination address is 4 bits, the bit address "b"
is 3 bits, and the LSB address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H:
BITR
R1.1
o
R1 = 05H
When the value of working register R1 is 07H (00000111B), the statement "BITR R1.1" clears bit1
of the destination register R1by leaving the value 05H (00000101B).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
155
6.6.8 BITS-Bit Set
BITS
dst.b
Operation:
dst (b) m 1
The BITS instruction sets the specified bit within the destination without affecting any other bits in
the destination.
Flags:
No flags are affected.
Format:
opc
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
77
rb
dst | b | 1
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the destination address is 4 bits, the bit address "b"
is 3 bits, and the LSB address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H:
BITS
R1.3
o
R1 = 0FH
If working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B), the statement "BITS R1.3" sets bit
3 of the destination register R1 to "1" by leaving the value 0FH (00001111B).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
156
6.6.9 BOR-Bit OR
BOR
dst, src.b
BOR
dst.b,src
Operation:
dst (0) m dst (0) OR src (b)
or
dst (b) m dst (b)
OR
src (0)
The specified bit of the source (or the destination) is logically ORed with bit zero (LSB) of the
destination (or the source). The resulting bit value is stored in the specified bit of the destination.
No other bits of the destination are affected. The source is unaffected.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Clears to "0".
V:
Does not affect.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
src
opc
dst | b | 0
src
3
6
07
r0
Rb
opc
src | b | 1
dst
3
6
07
Rb
r0
NOTE: In the second byte of the 3 byte instruction formats, the destination (or source) address is 4 bits, the bit address "b" is
3 bits, and the LSB address value is 1 bit.
Examples:
Given: R1 = 07H and register 01H = 03H:
BOR
BOR
R1, 01H.1 o R1 = 07H, register 01H = 03H
01H.2, R1 o Register 01H = 07H, R1 = 07H
In the first example, destination working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B) and
source register 01H the value 03H (00000011B). The statement "BOR R1, 01H.1" logically ORs
bit 1 of register 01H (source) with bit 0 of R1 (destination). This leaves the same value (07H)
in working register R1.
In the second example, destination register 01H contains the value 03H (00000011B) and the
source working register R1 the value 07H (00000111B). The statement "BOR 01H.2, R1" logically
ORs bit 2 of register 01H (destination) with bit 0 of R1 (source). This leaves the value 07H in
register 01H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
157
6.6.10 BTJRF-Bit Test, Jump Relative on False
BTJRF
dst, src.b
Operation:
If src (b) is a "0", then PC m PC + dst
The specified bit within the source operand is tested. If it is a "0", the relative address is added to
the program counter and control passes to the statement whose address is now in the PC;
otherwise, the instruction following the BTJRF instruction is executed.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
10
37
(NOTE)
opc
src | b | 0
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
RA
rb
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the source address is 4 bits, the bit address "b" is 3 bits, and the LSB
address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H:
BTJRF
SKIP, R1.3 o PC jumps to SKIP location
If working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B), the statement "BTJRF SKIP, R1.3"
tests bit 3. As it is "0", the relative address is added to the PC and the PC jumps to the
memory location pointed to the SKIP. (Ensure that the memory location must be within the
allowed range of + 127 to 128.)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
158
6.6.11 BTJRT-Bit Test, Jump Relative on True
BTJRT
dst, src.b
Operation:
If src (b) is a "1", then PC m PC + dst
The specified bit within the source operand is tested. If it is a "1", the relative address is added to
the program counter and control passes to the statement whose address is now in the PC;
otherwise, the instruction following the BTJRT instruction is executed.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
10
37
(NOTE)
opc
src | b | 1
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
RA
rb
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction format, the source address is 4 bits, the bit address "b" is 3 bits, and the LSB
address value is 1 bit in length.
Example:
Given: R1 = 07H:
BTJRT
SKIP, R1.1
If working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B), the statement "BTJRT SKIP, R1.1"
tests bit 1 in the source register (R1). As it is a "1", the relative address is added to the
PC and the PC jumps to the memory location pointed to by the SKIP. (Ensure that the
memory location must be within the allowed range of + 127 to 128.)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
159
6.6.12 BXOR-Bit XOR
BXOR
dst, src.b
BXOR
dst.b, src
Operation:
dst (0) m dst (0) XOR src (b)
or
dst (b) m dst (b) XOR src (0)
The specified bit of the source (or the destination) is logically exclusive-ORed with bit zero (LSB)
of the destination (or source). The result bit is stored in the specified bit of the destination. It does
not affect other bits of destination. It does not affect the source.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Clears to "0".
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
src
opc
dst | b | 0
src
3
6
27
r0
Rb
opc
src | b | 1
dst
3
6
27
Rb
r0
NOTE: In the second byte of the 3 byte instruction formats, the destination (or source) address is four bits, the bit address 'b'
is three bits, and the LSB address value is one bit in length.
Examples:
Given: R1 = 07H (00000111B) and register 01H = 03H (00000011B):
BXOR
BXOR
R1, 01H.1
01H.2, R1
o
o
R = 06H, register 01H = 03H
Register 01H = 07H, R1 = 07H
In the first example, destination working register R1 has the value 07H (00000111B) and source
register 01H has the value 03H (00000011B). The statement "BXOR R1, 01H.1" exclusive-ORs
bit 1 of register 01H (source) with bit 0 of R1 (destination). The result bit value is stored in bit
0 of R1, changing its value from 07H to 06H. It does not affect the value of source register 01H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
160
6.6.13 CALL-Call Procedure
CALL
dst
Operation:
SP
@SP
SP
@SP
PC
m
m
m
m
m
SP-1
PCL
SP-1
PCH
dst
The current contents of the program counter are pushed onto the top of the stack. The program
counter value used is the address of the first instruction following the CALL instruction. The
specified destination address is then loaded into the program counter and points to the first
instruction of a procedure. At the end of the procedure the return instruction (RET) can be used to
return to the original program flow. RET pops the top of the stack back into the program counter.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
3
14
F6
DA
dst
opc
dst
2
12
F4
IRR
opc
dst
2
14
D4
IA
Given: R0 = 35H, R1 = 21H, PC = 1A47H, and SP = 0002H:
CALL
3521H
o
CALL
CALL
@RR0
#40H
o
o
SP = 0000H
(Memory locations 0000H = 1AH, 0001H = 4AH, where
4AH is the address that follows the instruction.
SP = 0000H (0000H = 1AH, 0001H = 49H)
SP = 0000H (0000H = 1AH, 0001H = 49H)
In the first example, when the program counter value is 1A47H and the stack pointer contains the
value 0002H, the statement "CALL 3521H" pushes the current PC value onto the top of the stack.
The stack pointer now points to memory location 0000H. The PC is then loaded with the value
3521H, the address of the first instruction in the program sequence to be executed.
If the contents of the program counter and stack pointer are similar in the first example, the
statement "CALL @RR0" produces the same result except that the 49H is stored in stack
location 0001H (because the two-byte instruction format was used). The PC is then loaded with
the value 3521H, the address of the first instruction in the program sequence to be executed.
Assuming that the contents of the program counter and stack pointer are the same as in the first
example, when the program address 0040H contains 35H and program address 0041H contains
21H, the statement "CALL #40H" produces the same result as in the second example.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
161
6.6.14 CCF-Complement Carry Flag
CCF
Operation:
C m NOT C
Complements the carry flag (C). When C = "1", the value of the carry flag is changed to logic zero;
if C = "0", the value of the carry flag is changed to logic one.
Flags:
C:
Complements.
Does not affect any other flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
EF
opc
Example:
Given: The carry flag = "0":
CCF
When the carry flag = "0", the CCF instruction complements it in the FLAGS register (0D5H),
changing its value from logic zero to logic one.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
162
6.6.15 CLR-Clear
CLR
dst
Operation:
dst m "0"
Clears the destination location to "0".
Flags:
Does not affect any other flags..
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
B0
R
4
B1
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 4FH, register 01H = 02H, and register 02H = 5EH:
CLR
CLR
00H
@01H
o
o
Register 00H = 00H
Register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 00H
In Register (R) addressing mode, the statement "CLR 00H" clears the destination register 00H
value to 00H. In the second example, the statement "CLR @01H" uses Indirect Register (IR)
addressing mode to clear the 02H register value to 00H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
163
6.6.16 COM-Complement
COM
dst
Operation:
dst m NOT dst
Complements the contents of the destination location (one's complement); all "1s" are
changed to "0s", and vice-versa.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; cleared otherwise.
S:
Set if the result bit 7 is set; cleared otherwise.
V:
Always reset to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
60
R
4
61
IR
dst
Given: R1 = 07H and register 07H = 0F1H:
COM
COM
R1
@R1
o
o
R1 = 0F8H
R1 = 07H, register 07H = 0EH
In the first example, destination working register R1 contains the value 07H (00000111B). The
statement "COM R1" complements all the bits in R1: it changes all logic ones to logic zeros,
and vice-versa, leaving the value 0F8H (11111000B).
In the second example, it uses Indirect Register (IR) addressing mode to complement the value
of destination register 07H (11110001B) by leaving the new value 0EH (00001110B).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
164
6.6.17 CP-Compare
CP
dst, src
Operation:
dst-src
The source operand is compared to (subtract from) the destination operand, and it sets the
appropriate flags accordingly. The contents of both operands are unaffected by the
comparison.
Flags:
C:
Sets if a "borrow" occurs (src ! dst); otherwise it clears.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
src
opc
1.
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
A2
r
r
6
A3
r
lr
6
A4
R
R
6
A5
R
IR
6
A6
R
IM
dst | src
opc
Examples:
Bytes
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 02H and R2 = 03H:
CP
R1, R2 o
Set the C and S flags
Destination working register R1 contains the value 02H and source register R2 contains the value
03H. The statement "CP R1, R2" subtracts the R2 value (source/subtrahend) from the R1 value
(destination/minuend). As a "borrow" occurs and the difference is negative, C and S are "1".
2.
Given: R1 = 05H and R2 = 0AH:
SKIP
CP
JP
INC
LD
R1, R2
UGE, SKIP
R1
R3, R1
In this example, destination working register R1 contains the value 05H which is less than the
contents of the source working register R2 (0AH). The statement "CP R1, R2" generates C = "1".
The JP instruction does not jump to the SKIP location. After the statement "LD R3, R1"
executes, the value 06H remains in working register R3.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
165
6.6.18 CPIJE-Compare, Increment, and Jump on Equal
CPIJE
dst, src, RA
Operation:
If dst-src = "0", PC m PC + RA
Ir m Ir + 1
The source operand is compared to (subtracts from) the destination operand. When the result is
"0", the relative address is added to the program counter and the control passes to the statement
whose address is now in the program counter. Otherwise, the instruction immediately following
the CPIJE instruction is executed. In either case, the source pointer is incremented by one before
the next instruction is executed.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
src
dst
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
12
C2
RA
Addr Mode
dst
src
r
Ir
NOTE: Execution time is 18 cycles if the jump is taken or 16 cycles if it is not taken.
Example:
Given: R1 = 02H, R2 = 03H, and register 03H = 02H:
CPIJE
R1, @R2, SKIP
o
R2 = 04H, PC jumps to SKIP location
In this example, working register R1 contains the value 02H, working register R2 contains the
value 03H, and register 03 contains 02H. The statement "CPIJE R1, @R2, SKIP" compares the
@R2 value 02H (00000010B) to 02H (00000010B). As the result of the comparison is equal, the
relative address is added to the PC and the PC then jumps to the memory location that
SKIP points to. The source register (R2) is incremented by one, leaving a value of 04H. (Ensure
that the memory location is within the allowed range of + 127 to – 128.)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
166
6.6.19 CPIJNE-Compare, Increment, and Jump on Non-Equal
CPIJNE
dst, src, RA
Operation:
If dst-src "0", PC m PC + RA
Ir m Ir + 1
The source operand is compared to (subtracts from) the destination operand. When the result is
not "0", the relative address is added to the program counter and control passes to the statement
whose address is now in the program counter; otherwise the instruction following the CPIJNE
instruction is executed. In either case the source pointer is incremented by one before the next
instruction.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
src
dst
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
12
D2
RA
Addr Mode
dst
src
r
Ir
NOTE: Execution time is 18 cycles if the jump is taken or 16 cycles if it is not taken.
Example:
Given: R1 = 02H, R2 = 03H, and register 03H = 04H:
CPIJNE R1, @R2, SKIP
o
R2 = 04H, PC jumps to SKIP location
Working register R1 contains the value 02H, working register R2 (the source pointer) the value
03H, and general register 03 contains the value 04H. The statement "CPIJNE R1, @R2, SKIP"
subtracts 04H (00000100B) from 02H (00000010B). As the result of the comparison is non-equal,
the relative address is added to the PC and the PC then jumps to the memory location
that SKIP points to. The source pointer register (R2) is also incremented by one, leaving a value
of 04H. (Ensure that the memory location is within the allowed range of + 127 to – 128.)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
167
6.6.20 DA-Decimal Adjust
DA
dst
Operation:
dst m DA dst
The destination operand is adjusted to form two 4-bit BCD digits after an addition or subtraction
operation. For addition (ADD, ADC) or subtraction (SUB, SBC). the following table indicates the
operation that it performs (The operation is undefined if the destination operand was not the result
of a valid addition or subtraction of BCD digits):
Instruction
Carry
Before DA
Bits 4–7
Value (Hex)
H Flag
Before DA
Bits 0–3
Value (Hex)
Number Added
to Byte
Carry
After DA
–
0
0–9
0
0–9
00
0
–
0
0–8
0
A–F
06
0
–
0
0–9
1
0–3
06
0
ADD
0
A–F
0
0–9
60
1
ADC
0
9–F
0
A–F
66
1
–
0
A–F
1
0–3
66
1
–
1
0–2
0
0–9
60
1
–
1
0–2
0
A–F
66
1
–
1
0–3
1
0–3
66
1
–
0
0–9
0
0–9
00 = – 00
0
SUB
0
0–8
1
6–F
FA = – 06
0
SBC
1
7–F
0
0–9
A0 = – 60
1
–
1
6–F
1
6–F
9A = – 66
1
Flags:
C:
Sets if there was a carry from the most significant bit; otherwise it clears (see table).
Z:
Sets if result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
PS031201-0813
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
40
R
4
41
IR
dst
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
168
6.6.21 DA-Decimal Adjust
DA
(Continued)
Example:
Given: Working register R0 contains the value 15 (BCD), working register R1 contains
27 (BCD), and address 27H contains 46 (BCD):
ADD
DA
R1, R0 ; C m "0", H m "0", Bits 4–7 = 3, bits 0–3 = C, R1 m 3CH
R1
; R1 m 3CH + 06
If addition is performed by using the BCD values 15 and 27, the result should be 42. However, the
sum is incorrect, however, when the binary representations are added in the destination location
by using standard binary arithmetic:
0 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 15
+ 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 27
00111100 =
3CH
The DA instruction adjusts this result so that the correct BCD representation is obtained:
00111100
+00000110
01000010 =
42
Assuming the same values provided previously, the statements
SUB
DA
27H, R0 ; C m "0", H m "0", Bits 4–7 = 3, bits 0–3 = 1
@R1
;
@R1 m 31–0
Leave the value 31 (BCD) in address 27H (@R1).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
169
6.6.22 DEC-Decrement
DEC
dst
Operation:
dst m dst-1
The contents of the destination operand are decremented by one.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
00
R
4
01
IR
dst
Given: R1 = 03H and register 03H = 10H:
DEC
DEC
R1
@R1
o
o
R1 = 02H
Register 03H = 0FH
In the first example, if working register R1 contains the value 03H, the statement "DEC R1"
decrements the hexadecimal value by1, leaving the value 02H. In the second example, the
statement "DEC @R1" decrements the value 10H contained in the destination register 03H by
1, leaving the value 0FH.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
170
6.6.23 DECW-Decrement Word
DECW
dst
Operation:
dst m dst-1
The contents of the destination location (which must be an even address) and the operand
following that location are treated as a single 16-bit value that is decremented by one.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
8
80
RR
8
81
IR
dst
Given: R0 = 12H, R1 = 34H, R2 = 30H, register 30H = 0FH, and register 31H = 21H:
DECW
DECW
RR0
@R2
o
o
R0 = 12H, R1 = 33H
Register 30H = 0FH, register 31H = 20H
In the first example, destination register R0 contains the value 12H and register R1 contains the
value 34H. The statement "DECW RR0" addresses R0 and the next operand R1 as a 16-bit word
and decrements the value of R1 by1, leaving the value 33H.
NOTE: A system malfunction may occur if you use a Zero flag (FLAGS.6) result together with a DECW instruction. To avoid
this problem, that you should use DECW as shown in this example:
LOOP:
PS031201-0813
DECW
LD
OR
JR
RR0
R2, R1
R2, R0
NZ, LOOP
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
171
6.6.24 DI-Disable Interrupts
DI
Operation:
SYM (0) m 0
Bit zero of the system mode control register, SYM.0, is cleared to "0" by globally disabling all
interrupt processing. Interrupt requests continues to set their respective interrupt pending bits,
however the CPU does not service them when it disables the interrupt processing.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
8F
opc
Example:
Given: SYM = 01H:
DI
When the value of the SYM register is 01H, the statement "DI" leaves the new value 00H in the
register and clears SYM.0 to "0" by disabling the interrupt processing.
Before changing IMR, interrupt pending and interrupt source control register, ensure that it is in
the DI state.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
172
6.6.25 DIV-Divide (Unsigned)
DIV
dst, src
Operation:
dst y src
dst (UPPER) m REMAINDER
dst (LOWER) m QUOTIENT
The source operand (8 bits) divides the destination operand (16 bits). The quotient (8 bits) is
stored in the lower half of the destination. The remainder (8 bits) is stored in the upper half of the
8
destination. When the quotient is t 2 , the numbers that it stores in the upper and lower halves of
the destination for quotient and remainder are incorrect. Both operands are treated as unsigned
integers.
Flags:
8
9
C:
Sets if the V flag is set and quotient is between 2 and 2 1; otherwise it clears.
Z:
Set sif divisor or quotient = "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if MSB of quotient = "1"; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if quotient is t 2 or if divisor = "0"; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
8
Format:
opc
src
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
26/10
94
RR
R
26/10
95
RR
IR
26/10
96
RR
IM
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
NOTE: Execution takes 10 cycles if the divide-by-zero is attempted; otherwise it takes 26 cycles.
Examples:
Given: R0 = 10H, R1 = 03H, R2 = 40H, register 40H = 80H:
DIV
DIV
DIV
RR0, R2
RR0, @R2
RR0, #20H
o
o
o
R0 = 03H, R1 = 40H
R0 = 03H, R1 = 20H
R0 = 03H, R1 = 80H
In the first example, destination working register pair RR0 contains the values 10H (R0) and 03H
(R1), and register R2 contains the value 40H. The statement "DIV RR0, R2" divides the 16-bit
RR0 value by the 8-bit value of the R2 (source) register. After the DIV instruction, R0 contains the
value 03H and R1 contains 40H. The 8-bit remainder is stored in the upper-half of the destination
register RR0 (R0) and the quotient in the lower-half (R1).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
173
6.6.26 DJNZ-Decrement and Jump if Non-Zero
DJNZ
r, dst
Operation:
r m r-1
If r z 0, PC m PC + dst
The working register being used as a counter is decremented. If the contents of the register are
not logic zero after decrementing, the relative address is added to the program counter and
control passes to the statement whose address is now in the PC. The range of the relative
address is + 127 to 128 and the original value of the PC is taken to be the address of the
instruction byte after the DJNZ statement.
NOTE: In case of using DJNZ instruction, the working register that it uses as a counter should be set at
one of locations 0C0H to 0CFH with SRP, SRP0, or SRP1 instruction.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
r | opc
Example:
dst
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
8 (Jump taken)
rA
RA
8 (No jump)
r = 0 to F
Given: R1 = 02H and LOOP is the label of a relative address:
SRP
DJNZ
#0C0H
R1, LOOP
DJNZ is typically used to control a "loop" of instructions. In many cases, a label is used as the
destination operand instead of a numeric relative address value. In the example, working register
R1 contains the value 02H, and LOOP is the label for a relative address.
The statement "DJNZ R1, LOOP" decrements register R1 by one by leaving the value 01H.
As the contents of R1 after the decrement are non-zero, the jump is taken to the relative
address that the LOOP label specifies.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
174
6.6.27 EI-Enable Interrupts
EI
Operation:
SYM (0) m 1
An EI instruction sets bit 0 of the system mode register, SYM.0 to "1". This enables interrupts to
be serviced as they occur (assuming they have highest priority). If the pending bit of an interrupt
is set while interrupt processing was disabled (by executing a DI instruction), it will be serviced
when you execute the EI instruction.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
9F
opc
Example:
Given: SYM = 00H:
EI
If the SYM register contains the value 00H, that is, if interrupts are currently disabled, the
statement "EI" sets the SYM register to 01H by enabling all interrupts. (SYM.0 is the enable bit for
global interrupt processing.)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
175
6.6.28 ENTER-Enter
ENTER
Operation:
m
m
m
m
m
SP
@SP
IP
PC
IP
SP-2
IP
PC
@IP
IP + 2
This instruction is useful when implementing threaded-code languages. The contents of the
instruction pointer are pushed to the stack. The program counter (PC) value is then written to the
instruction pointer. The program memory word that is pointed to by the instruction pointer is
loaded into the PC, and the instruction pointer is incremented by two.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
14
1F
opc
Example:
The diagram below shows one example of how to use an ENTER statement.
Bef ore
Address
Af ter
Address
Data
IP
0050
PC
0040
SP
0022
Address
22
Data
40
41
42
43
0043
PC
0110
SP
0020
20
21
22
IPH
IPL
Data
Data
Enter
Address H
Address L
Address H
Memory
1F
01
10
Address
Stack
PS031201-0813
Data
IP
Stack
PRELIMINARY
40
41
42
43
00
50
110
Data
Enter
Address H
Address L
Address H
Routine
Memory
1F
01
10
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
176
6.6.29 EXIT-Exit
EXIT
Operation:
m
m
m
m
IP
SP
PC
IP
@SP
SP + 2
@IP
IP + 2
This instruction is useful when implementing threaded-code languages. The stack value is
popped and loaded into the instruction pointer. The program memory word that is pointed to by
the instruction pointer is then loaded into the program counter, and the instruction pointer is
incremented by two.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode (Hex)
1
14 (Internal stack)
2F
opc
16 (Internal stack)
Example:
The diagram below shows one example of how to use an EXIT statement.
Bef ore
Address
IP
Af ter
Data
Address
0050
IP
Address
PC
SP
20
21
22
PCL old
PCH
00
50
Exit
60
SP
0022
22
Data
Main
2F
Memory
Stack
PS031201-0813
Data
0060
60
00
0022
IPH
IPL
Data
Address
PC
140
0052
Data
0040
50
51
Data
Stack
PRELIMINARY
Memory
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
177
6.6.30 IDLE-Idle Operation
IDLE
Operation:
The IDLE instruction stops the CPU clock while allowing system clock oscillation to continue. An
Interrupt request (IRQ) or external reset operation release idle.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
6F
opc
Example:
The instruction
IDLE
Stops the CPU clock but not the system clock.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Addr Mode
dst
src
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
178
6.6.31 INC-Increment
INC
dst
Operation:
dst m dst + 1
The contents of the destination operand are incremented by one.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Set if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
1
4
rE
r
dst | opc
r = 0 to F
opc
Examples:
dst
2
4
20
R
4
21
IR
Given: R0 = 1BH, register 00H = 0CH, and register 1BH = 0FH:
INC
INC
INC
R0
00H
@R0
o
o
o
R0 = 1CH
Register 00H = 0DH
R0 = 1BH, register 01H = 10H
In the first example, if destination working register R0 contains the value 1BH, the statement "INC
R0" leaves the value 1CH in that same register.
The next example shows the effect an INC instruction has on register 00H, assuming that it
contains the value 0CH.
In the third example, INC is used in Indirect Register (IR) addressing mode to increment the value
of register 1BH from 0FH to 10H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
179
6.6.32 INCW-Increment Word
INCW
dst
Operation:
dst m dst + 1
It treats the contents of the destination (which must be an even address) and the byte following
that location as a single 16-bit value. This value is incremented by one.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Set if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
8
A0
RR
8
A1
IR
dst
Given: R0 = 1AH, R1 = 02H, register 02H = 0FH, and register 03H = 0FFH:
INCW
INCW
RR0
@R1
o
o
R0 = 1AH, R1 = 03H
Register 02H = 10H, register 03H = 00H
In the first example, the working register pair RR0 contains the value 1AH in register R0 and 02H
in register R1. The statement "INCW RR0" increments the 16-bit destination by one, leaving the
value 03H in register R1. In the second example, the statement "INCW @R1" uses Indirect
Register (IR) addressing mode to increment the contents of general register 03H from 0FFH to
00H and register 02H from 0FH to 10H.
NOTE: A system malfunction may occur if you use a Zero (Z) flag (FLAGS.6) result together with an INCW instruction. To
avoid this problem, you should use INCW as shown :
LOOP:
PS031201-0813
INCW
LD
OR
JR
RR0
R2, R1
R2, R0
NZ, LOOP
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
180
6.6.33 IRET-Interrupt Return
IRET
IRET (Normal)
IRET (Fast)
Operation:
FLAGS m @SP PC l IP
SP m SP + 1
FLAGS m FLAGS
PC m @SP
FIS m 0
SP m SP + 2
SYM (0) m 1
This instruction is used at the end of an interrupt service routine. It restores the flag register and
the program counter. It also re-enables global interrupts. A "normal IRET" is executed only if the
fast interrupt status bit (FIS, bit one of the FLAGS register, 0D5H) is cleared (= "0"). If a fast
interrupt occurred, IRET clears the FIS bit that was set at the beginning of the service routine.
Flags:
Restores all flags to their original settings (that is, the settings before the interrupt occurs).
Format:
IRET
(Normal)
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
opc
1
10 (Internal stack)
BF
12 (Internal stack)
Example:
IRET
(Fast)
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
opc
1
6
BF
In the figure below, the instruction pointer is initially loaded with 100H in the main program before
interrupts are enabled. When an interrupt occurs, the program counter and instruction pointer are
swapped. This causes the PC to jump to address 100H and the IP to keep the return address.
The last instruction in the service routine normally is a jump to IRET at address FFH. This causes
the instruction pointer to be loaded with 100H "again" and the program counter to jump back to
the main program. Now, the next interrupt can occur and the IP is still correct at 100H.
0H
FFH
100H
IRET
Interrupt
Serv ice
Routine
JP to FFH
FFFFH
NOTE: In this fast interrupt example in the figure above, if the last instruction is not a jump to IRET, you must pay attention to
the order of the last two instructions. The IRET cannot be immediately preceded by a clearing of the interrupt status
(as with a reset of the IPR register).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
181
6.6.34 JP-Jump
JP
cc, dst (Conditional)
JP
dst
Operation:
If cc is true, PC m dst
(Unconditional)
The conditional JUMP instruction transfers program control to the destination address when the
condition that condition code (cc) specifies is true; otherwise, the instruction following the JP
instruction is executed. The unconditional JP simply replaces the contents of the PC with the
contents of the specified register pair. Control then passes to the statement addressed by the PC.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format: (1)
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
3
8
ccD
DA
(2)
cc | opc
dst
cc = 0 to F
opc
dst
2
8
30
IRR
NOTE:
1.
2.
You can use the 3 byte format for a conditional jump and the 2 byte format for an unconditional jump.
In the first byte of the three-byte instruction format (conditional jump), the condition code and the opcode are both
four bits.
Examples:
Given: The carry flag (C) = "1", register 00 = 01H, and register 01 = 20H:
JP
JP
C, LABEL_W
@00H
o
o
LABEL_W = 1000H, PC = 1000H
PC = 0120H
The first example shows a conditional JP. Assuming that you can set the carry flag to "1", the
statement
"JP C, LABEL_W" replaces the contents of the PC with the value 1000H and transfers control to
that location. Had the carry flag not been set, control would then have passed to the statement
immediately to the next JP instruction.
The second example shows an unconditional JP. The statement "JP@00" replaces the contents
of the PC with the contents of the register pair 00H and 01H by leaving the value 0120H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
182
6.6.35 JR-Jump Relative
JR
cc, dst
Operation:
If cc is true, PC m PC + dst
When the condition specified by the condition code (cc) is true, the relative address is added to
the program counter and control passes to the statement whose address is now in the program
counter; otherwise, the instruction following the JR instruction is executed. (Refer to the list of
condition codes for more information).
The range of the relative address is + 127, – 128, and the original value of the program counter is
taken to be the address of the first instruction byte following the JR statement.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
6
ccB
RA
(NOTE)
cc | opc
dst
cc = 0 to F
NOTE: In the first byte of the 2 byte instruction format, the condition code and the opcode are each four bits.
Example:
Given: The carry flag = "1" and LABEL_X = 1FF7H:
JR
C, LABEL_X
o
PC = 1FF7H
If you set the carry flag (that is, if the condition code is true), the statement "JR C, LABEL_X"
passes control to the statement whose address is currently in the PC. Otherwise, the program
instruction following the JR would be executed.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
183
6.6.36 LD-Load
LD
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
The contents of the source are loaded into the destination. The source's contents are unaffected.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
dst | opc
src | opc
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
rC
r
IM
4
r8
r
R
4
r9
R
r
src
dst
2
Addr Mode
dst
src
r = 0 to F
opc
opc
opc
PS031201-0813
dst | src
src
dst
2
dst
src
3
3
4
C7
r
lr
4
D7
Ir
r
6
E4
R
R
6
E5
R
IR
6
E6
R
IM
6
D6
IR
IM
opc
src
dst
3
6
F5
IR
R
opc
dst | src
x
3
6
87
r
x[r]
opc
src | dst
x
3
6
97
x[r]
r
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
184
6.6.37 LD-Load
LD
(Continued)
Examples:
Given: R0 = 01H, R1 = 0AH, register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 20H,
register 02H = 02H, LOOP = 30H and register 3AH = 0FFH:
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
PS031201-0813
R0, #10H
R0, 01H
01H, R0
R1, @R0
@R0, R1
00H, 01H
02H,@00H
00H, #0AH
@00H, #10H
@0H, 02H
R0, #LOOP[R1]
#LOOP[R0],R1
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
R0 = 10H
R0 = 20H, register 01H = 20H
Register 01H = 01H, R0 = 01H
R1 = 20H, R0 = 01H
R0 = 01H, R1 = 0AH, register 01H = 0AH
Register 00H = 20H, register 01 = 20H
Register 02H = 20H, register 00H = 01H
Register 00H = 0AH
Register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 10H
Register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 02, register 02H = 02H
R0 = 0FFH, R1 = 0AH
Register 31H = 0AH, R0 = 01H, R1 = 0AH
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
185
6.6.38 LDB-Load Bit
LDB
dst, src.b
LDB
dst.b, src
Operation:
dst (0) m src (b)
or
dst (b) m src (0)
The specified bit of the source is loaded into bit zero (LSB) of the destination, or bit 0 of the
source is loaded into the specified bit of the destination. No other bits of the destination are
affected. The source is unaffected.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
src
opc
dst | b | 0
src
3
6
47
r0
Rb
opc
src | b | 1
dst
3
6
47
Rb
r0
NOTE: In the second byte of the instruction formats, the destination (or source) address is 4 bits, the bit address 'b' is 3 bits,
and the LSB address value is 1-bit in length.
Examples:
Given: R0 = 06H and general register 00H = 05H:
LDB
LDB
R0, 00H.2
00H.0, R0
o
o
R0 = 07H, register 00H = 05H
R0 = 06H, register 00H = 04H
In the first example, destination working register R0 contains the value 06H and the source
general register 00H the value 05H. The statement "LD R0,00H.2" loads the bit two value of the
00H register into bit zero of the R0 registerby leaving the value 07H in register R0.
In the second example, 00H is the destination register. The statement "LD 00H.0,R0" loads bit
zero of register R0 to the specified bit (bit zero) of the destination registerby leaving 04H in
general register 00H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
186
6.6.39 LDC/LDE-Load Memory
LDC/LDE
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
This instruction loads a byte from program or data memory into a working register or vice-versa.
The source values are unaffected. LDC refers to program memory and LDE to data memory. The
assembler makes "Irr" or "rr" values an even number for program memory and odd an od
number for data memory.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
src
1.
opc
dst | src
2
10
C3
r
Irr
2.
opc
src | dst
2
10
D3
Irr
r
3.
opc
dst | src
XS
3
12
E7
r
XS
[rr]
4.
opc
src | dst
XS
3
12
F7
XS
[rr]
r
5.
opc
dst | src
XLL
XLH
4
14
A7
r
XL [rr]
6.
opc
src | dst
XLL
XLH
4
14
B7
XL [rr]
r
7.
opc
dst | 0000
DAL
DAH
4
14
A7
r
DA
8.
opc
src | 0000
DAL
DAH
4
14
B7
DA
r
9.
opc
dst | 0001
DAL
DAH
4
14
A7
r
DA
10.
opc
src | 0001
DAL
DAH
4
14
B7
DA
r
NOTE:
1.
The source (src) or working register pair [rr] for formats 5 and 6 cannot use register pair 0-1.
2.
For formats 3 and 4, the destination address "XS[rr]" and the source address "XS[rr]" are 1 byte each.
3.
For formats 5 and 6, the destination address "XL[rr]" and the source address "XL[rr]" are 2 byte each.
4.
The DA and r source values for formats 7 and 8 are used to address program memory. You can use the second set of
values, used in formats 9 and 10, to address data memory.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
187
6.6.40 LDC/LDE-Load Memory
LDC/LDE
(Continued)
Examples:
Given: R0 = 11H, R = 34H, R2 = 01H, R3 = 04H; Program memory locations
0103H = 4FH, 0104H = 1A, 0105H = 6DH, and 1104H = 88H. External data memory
locations 0103H = 5FH, 0104H = 2AH, 0105H = 7DH, and 1104H = 98H:
LDC
R0,@RR2
LDE
R0,@RR2
LDC (NOTE) @RR2, R0
LDE
@RR2, R
LDC
R0, #01H[RR2]
LDE
R0, #01H[RR2]
;
;
;
;
R0
R0
R0
R0
m contents
= 1AH, R2 =
m contents
= 2AH, R2 =
of program memory location 0104H
01H, R3 = 04H
of external data memory location 0104H
01H, R3 = 04H
; 11H (contents of R0) is loaded into program memory
; Location 0104H (RR2,)
; Working registers R0, R2, R3 o no change
; 11H (contents of R0) is loaded into external data memory
; Location 0104H (RR2),
; Working registers R0, R2, R3 o no change
; R0 m contents of program memory location 0105H
;(01H + RR2),
; R0 = 6DH, R2 = 01H, R3 = 04H
; R0 m contents of external data memory location 0105H
; (01H + RR2), R0 = 7DH, R2 = 01H, R3 = 04H
LDC (NOTE) #01H[RR2],R0; 11H (contents of R0) is loaded into program memory location
;
;
;
#1000H[RR2];
;
#1000H[RR2];
;
1104H
;
1104H
;
;
LDE#01H[RR2],R0
LDC
R0,
LDE
R0,
LDC
LDE
R0,
R0,
LDC (NOTE) 1105H, R0
LDE
1105H, R0
;
;
;
;
0105H (01H + 0104H)
11H (contents of R0) is loaded into external data memory
Location 0105H (01H + 0104H)
R0 m contents of program memory location 1104H
(1000H + 0104H), R0 = 88H, R2 = 01H, R3 = 04H
R0 contents of external data memory location 1104H
(1000H + 0104H), R0 = 98H, R2 = 01H, R3 = 04H
R0 contents of program memory location 1104H, R0 = 88H
0 m contents of external data memory location 1104H,
R0 = 98H
11H (contents of R0) is loaded into program memory location
1105H, (1105H) m 11H
11H (contents of R0) is loaded into external data memory
Location 1105H, (1105H) m 11H
NOTE: Masked ROM type devices do not support these instructions.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
188
6.6.41 LDCD/LDED-Load Memory and Decrement
LDCD/LDED
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
rr m rr – 1
You can uses these instructions for user stacks or block transfers of data from program or
data memory to the register file. A working register pair addresses specifies the address of the
memory location. The contents of the source location are loaded into the destination location. The
memory address is then decremented. The contents of the source are unaffected.
LDCD and LDED refer to external data memory respectively. The assembler makes "Irr" an even
number for program memory and an odd number for data memory.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
10
E2
dst | src
Addr Mode
dst
src
r
Given: R6 = 10H, R7 = 33H, R8 = 12H, program memory location 1033H = 0CDH,
and external data memory location 1033H = 0DDH:
LDCD R8, @RR6
; 0CDH (contents of program memory location 1033H) is loaded
; into R8 and RR6 is decremented by one
; R8 = 0CDH, R6 = 10H, R7 = 32H (RR6 m RR6 – 1)
LDED R8, @RR6
; 0DDH (contents of data memory location 1033H) is loaded
; into R8 and RR6 is decremented by one (RR6 m RR6 – 1)
; R8 = 0DDH, R6 = 10H, R7 = 32H
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Irr
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
189
6.6.42 LDCI/LDEI-Load Memory and Increment
LDCI/LDEI
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
rr m rr + 1
You can use these instructions for user stacks or block transfers of data from program or data
memory to the register file. A working register pair specifies the address of the memory location.
The contents of the source location are loaded into the destination location. The memory
address is then incremented automatically. The contents of the source are unaffected.
LDCI and LDEI refer to external data memory respectively. The assembler makes "Irr" even for
program memory and odd for data memory.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
10
E3
dst | src
Addr Mode
dst
src
r
Irr
Given: R6 = 10H, R7 = 33H, R8 = 12H, program memory locations 1033H = 0CDH and 1034H
= 0C5H; external data memory locations 1033H = 0DDH and 1034H = 0D5H:
LDCI
R8,@RR6
; 0CDH (contents of program memory location 1033H) is loaded
; into R8 and RR6 is incremented by one (RR6 m RR6 + 1)
; R8 = 0CDH, R6 = 10H, R7 = 34H
LDEI
R8,@RR6
; 0DDH (contents of data memory location 1033H) is loaded
; into R8 and RR6 is incremented by one (RR6 m RR6 + 1
; R8 = 0DDH, R6 = 10H, R7 = 34H
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
190
6.6.43 LDCPD/LDEPD-Load Memory with Pre-Decrement
LDCPD/
LDEPD
dst, src
Operation:
rr m rr – 1
dst m src
You can use these instructions for block transfers of data from program or data memory from the
register file. A working register pair specifies the address of the memory location. It decrements
the address of the memory location. The contents of the source location are then loaded into the
destination location. The contents of the source are unaffected.
LDCPD and LDEPD refer to external data memory respectively. The assembler makes "Irr" an
even number for program memory and an odd number for external data memory.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
14
F2
src | dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
Irr
Given: R0 = 77H, R6 = 30H and R7 = 00H:
LDCPD
@RR6, R0
;
;
;
;
(RR6 m RR6 – 1)
77H (contents of R0) is loaded into program memory location
2FFFH (3000H – 1H)
R0 = 77H, R6 = 2FH, R7 = 0FFH
LDEPD
@RR6, R0
;
;
;
;
(RR6 m RR6 – 1)
77H (contents of R0) is loaded into external data memory
location 2FFFH (3000H – 1H
R0 = 77H, R6 = 2FH, R7 = 0FFH
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
r
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
191
6.6.44 LDCPI/LDEPI-Load Memory with Pre-Increment
LDCPI/
LDEPI
dst, src
Operation:
rr m rr + 1
dst m src
You can these instructions for block transfers of data from program or data memory from the
register file. A working register pair specifies the address of the memory location. It increments
the address of the memory location. The contents of the source location are loaded into the
destination location. The contents of the source are unaffected.
LDCPI refers to program memory and LDEPI refers to external data memory. The assembler
makes "Irr" an even number for program memory and an odd number for data memory.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
14
F3
src | dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
Irr
Given: R0 = 7FH, R6 = 21H and R7 = 0FFH:
LDCPI
@RR6, R0
;
;
;
;
(RR6 m RR6 + 1)
7FH (contents of R0) is loaded into program memory
Location 2200H (21FFH + 1H)
R0 = 7FH, R6 = 22H, R7 = 00H
LDEPI
@RR6, R0
;
;
;
;
(RR6 m RR6 + 1)
7FH (contents of R0) is loaded into external data memory
Location 2200H (21FFH + 1H)
R0 = 7FH, R6 = 22H, R7 = 00H
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
r
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
192
6.6.45 LDW-Load Word
LDW
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
The contents of the source (a word) are loaded into the destination. The contents of the source
are unaffected.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
src
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
8
C4
RR
RR
8
C5
RR
IR
8
C6
RR
IML
dst
dst
src
4
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R4 = 06H, R5 = 1CH, R6 = 05H, R7 = 02H, register 00H = 1AH,
register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 03H, and register 03H = 0FH:
LDW
LDW
RR6, RR4
00H, 02H
o
o
R6 = 06H, R7 = 1CH, R4 = 06H, R5 = 1CH
Register 00H = 03H, register 01H = 0FH,
register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0FH
LDW
LDW
LDW
LDW
RR2,
04H,
RR6,
02H,
o
o
o
o
R2 = 03H, R3
Register 04H
R6 = 12H, R7
Register 02H
@R7
@01H
#1234H
#0FEDH
=
=
=
=
0FH,
03H, register 05H = 0FH
34H
0FH, register 03H = 0EDH
In the second example, the statement "LDW 00H,02H" loads the contents of the source word
02H, 03H into the destination word 00H, 01H. This leaves the value 03H in general register 00H
and the value 0FH in register 01H.
The other examples show how to use the LDW instruction with various addressing modes and
formats.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
193
6.6.46 MULT-Multiply (Unsigned)
MULT
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst u src
The source operand (8 bits) multiplies the 8-bit destination operand (even register of the register
pair) It stores the product (16 bits) in the register pair that destination address specifies.
Flags:
C:
Set if result is ! 255; otherwise it clears.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if MSB of the result is a "1"; otherwise it clears.
V:
Cleared.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
src
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
22
84
RR
R
22
85
RR
IR
22
86
RR
IM
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: Register 00H = 20H, register 01H = 03H, register 02H = 09H, register 03H = 06H:
MULT
MULT
MULT
00H, 02H
00H, @01H
00H, #30H
o
o
o
Register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 20H, register 02H = 09H
Register 00H = 00H, register 01H = 0C0H
Register 00H = 06H, register 01H = 00H
In the first example, the statement "MULT 00H, 02H" multiplies the 8-bit destination operand (in
the register 00H of the register pair 00H, 01H) by the source register 02H operand (09H). The 16bit product, 0120H, is stored in the register pair 00H, 01H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
194
6.6.47 NEXT-Next
NEXT
PC m @ IP
Operation:
IP m IP + 2
The NEXT instruction is useful when implementing threaded-code languages. The program
memory word that is pointed to by the instruction pointer is loaded into the program counter. The
instruction pointer is then incremented by two.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
10
0F
opc
Example:
The following diagram shows one example of how to use the NEXT instruction.
Bef ore
Address
Af ter
Data
IP
0043
PC
0120
Address
Address
43
44
45
120
IP
PC
0130
Data
Address H
Address L
Address H
01
10
Address
Next
43
44
45
130
Memory
PS031201-0813
Data
0045
PRELIMINARY
Data
Address H
Address L
Address H
Routine
Memory
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
195
6.6.48 NOP-No Operation
NOP
Operation:
No action is performed when the CPU executes this instruction. Typically, one or more NOPs are
executed in sequence in order to effect a timing delay of variable duration.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
FF
opc
Example:
When the instruction
NOP
is encountered in a program, operation does not occur. Instead, there is a delay in instruction
execution time.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
196
6.6.49 OR-Logical OR
OR
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst OR src
The source operand is logically ORed with the destination operand and the result is stored in the
destination. The contents of the source are unaffected. The OR operation results in a "1" being
stored whenever either of the corresponding bits in the two operands is a "1"; otherwise it stores a
"0".
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Always cleared to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
42
r
r
6
43
r
lr
6
44
R
R
6
45
R
IR
6
46
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R0 = 15H, R1 = 2AH, R2 = 01H, register 00H = 08H, register 01H = 37H, and register
08H = 8AH:
OR
OR
OR
OR
OR
R0, R1
R0, @R2
00H, 01H
01H, @00H
00H, #02H
o
o
o
o
o
R0 = 3FH, R1
R0 = 37H, R2
Register 00H
Register 00H
Register 00H
=
=
=
=
=
2AH
01H, register 01H = 37H
3FH, register 01H = 37H
08H, register 01H = 0BFH
0AH
In the first example, when working register R0 contains the value 15H and register R1 contains
the value 2AH, the statement "OR R0, R1" logical-ORs the R0 and R1 register contents and
stores the result (3FH) in destination register R0.
The other examples show the use of the logical OR instruction with the various addressing modes
and formats.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
197
6.6.50 POP-Pop from Stack
POP
dst
Operation:
dst m @SP
SP m SP + 1
The contents of the location addressed by the stack pointer are loaded into the destination. The
stack pointer is then incremented by one.
Flags:
No flags affected.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
8
50
R
8
51
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 1BH, SPH (0D8H) = 00H, SPL (0D9H) =
0FBH and stack register 0FBH = 55H:
POP
POP
00H
@00H
o
o
Register 00H = 55H, SP = 00FCH
Register 00H = 01H, register 01H = 55H, SP = 00FCH
In the first example, general register 00H contains the value 01H. The statement "POP 00H"
loads the contents of location 00FBH (55H) into destination register 00H and then increments the
stack pointer by one. Register 00H then contains the value 55H and the SP points to location
00FCH.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
198
6.6.51 POPUD-Pop User Stack (Decrementing)
POPUD
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
IR m IR – 1
You can use this instruction for user-defined stacks in the register file. It loads the contents of the
register file location that the user stack pointer addresses into the destination. The user stack
pointer is then decremented.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Example:
src
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
8
92
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
R
IR
Given: Register 00H = 42H (user stack pointer register), register 42H = 6FH, and register 02H =
70H:
POPUD
02H, @00H
o
Register 00H = 41H, register 02H = 6FH, register 42H = 6FH
If general register 00H contains the value 42H and register 42H contains the value 6FH, the
statement "POPUD 02H, @00H" loads the contents of register 42H into the destination register
02H. The user stack pointer is then decremented by oneby leaving the value 41H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
199
6.6.52 POPUI-Pop User Stack (Incrementing)
POPUI
dst, src
Operation:
dst m src
IR m IR + 1
You can use the POPUI instruction for user-defined stacks in the register file. The contents of the
register file location addressed by the user stack pointer are loaded into the destination. The user
stack pointer is then incremented.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Example:
src
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
8
93
dst
Addr Mode
dst
src
R
IR
Given: Register 00H = 01H and register 01H = 70H:
POPUI
02H, @00H
o
Register 00H = 02H, register 01H = 70H, register 02H = 70H
If general register 00H contains the value 01H and register 01H the value 70H, the statement
"POPUI 02H, @00H" loads the value 70H into the destination general register 02H. Then, it
increments the user stack pointer (register 00H) by one, changing its value from 01H to 02H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
200
6.6.53 PUSH-Push to Stack
PUSH
src
Operation:
SP m SP – 1
@SP m src
A PUSH instruction decrements the stack pointer value and loads the contents of the source (src)
into the location The decremented stack pointer addresses the location. The operation then adds
the new value to the top of the stack.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
src
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
8 (Internal clock)
70
R
71
IR
8 (External clock)
8 (Internal clock)
8 (External clock)
Examples:
Given: Register 40H = 4FH, register 4FH = 0AAH, SPH = 00H and SPL = 00H:
PUSH
40H
o
Register 40H = 4FH, stack register 0FFH = 4FH,
SPH = 0FFH, SPL = 0FFH
PUSH
@40H
o
Register 40H = 4FH, register 4FH = 0AAH, stack register
0FFH = 0AAH, SPH = 0FFH, SPL = 0FFH
In the first example, when the stack pointer contains the value 0000H, and general register 40H
contains the value 4FH, the statement "PUSH 40H" decrements the stack pointer from 0000 to
0FFFFH. It then loads the contents of register 40H into location 0FFFFH and adds this new value
to the top of the stack.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
201
6.6.54 PUSHUD-Push User Stack (Decrementing)
PUSHUD
dst, src
Operation:
IR m IR – 1
dst m src
You can use this instruction to address user-defined stacks in the register file. PUSHUD
decrements the user stack pointer and loads the contents of the source into the register. The
decremented stack pointer addresses the register.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Example:
dst
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
8
82
src
Addr Mode
dst
src
IR
R
Given: Register 00H = 03H, register 01H = 05H, and register 02H = 1AH:
PUSHUD @00H, 01H
o
Register 00H = 02H, register 01H = 05H, register 02H = 05H
If the user stack pointer (register 00H, for example) contains the value 03H, the statement
"PUSHUD @00H, 01H" decrements the user stack pointer by oneby leaving the value 02H. It
then loads the 01H register value, 05H, into the register. The decremented user stack pointer
addresses the register.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
202
6.6.55 PUSHUI-Push User Stack (Incrementing)
PUSHUI
dst, src
Operation:
IR m IR + 1
dst m src
You can use this instruction for user-defined stacks in the register file. PUSHUI increments the
user stack pointer and then loads the contents of the source into the register location. The
incremented user stack pointer addresses the register location.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Example:
dst
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
3
8
83
src
Addr Mode
dst
src
IR
R
Given: Register 00H = 03H, register 01H = 05H, and register 04H = 2AH:
PUSHUI @00H, 01H
o
Register 00H = 04H, register 01H = 05H, register 04H = 05H
If the user stack pointer (register 00H, for example) contains the value 03H, the statement
"PUSHUI @00H, 01H" increments the user stack pointer by oneby leaving the value 04H. It then
loads the 01H register value, 05H, into the location. The incremented user stack pointer
addresses the location.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
203
6.6.56 RCF-Reset Carry Flag
RCF
RCF
Operation:
Cm0
The carry flag is cleared to logic zero, regardless of its previous value.
Flags:
C:
Cleared to "0".
Does not affect any other flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
CF
opc
Example:
Given: C = "1" or "0":
The instruction RCF clears the carry flag (C) to logic zero.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
204
6.6.57 RET-Return
RET
Operation:
PC m @SP
SP m SP + 2
Normally, you can use the RET instruction to return to the previously executing procedure at the
end of a procedure. A CALL instruction enters the procedure. The contents of the location that the
stack pointer addresses are popped into the program counter. The next statement that is
executed is the one that the new program counter value addresses.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode (Hex)
1
8 (Internal stack)
AF
opc
10 (Internal stack)
Example:
RET
o
Given: SP = 00FCH, (SP) = 101AH, and PC = 1234:
PC = 101AH, SP = 00FEH
The statement "RET" pops the contents of stack pointer location 00FCH (10H) into the high byte
of the program counter. The stack pointer then pops the value in location 00FEH (1AH) into the
low byte of PC and it executes the instruction at location 101AH. The stack pointer now points to
memory location 00FEH.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
205
6.6.58 RL-Rotate Left
RL
dst
Operation:
C m dst (7)
dst (0) m dst (7)
dst (n + 1) m dst (n), n = 0-6
The contents of the destination operand are rotated left one bit position. The initial value of bit 7 is
moved to the bit zero (LSB) position and also replaces the carry flag.
7
0
C
Flags:
C:
Set if the bit rotated from the most significant bit position (bit 7) was "1".
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Set if arithmetic overflow occurred; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
90
R
4
91
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 0AAH, register 01H = 02H and register 02H = 17H:
RL
RL
00H
@01H
o
o
Register 00H = 55H, C = "1"
Register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 2EH, C = "0"
In the first example, when general register 00H contains the value 0AAH (10101010B), the
statement "RL 00H" rotates the 0AAH value left one bit positionby leaving the new value 55H
(01010101B) and setting the carry and overflow flags.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
206
6.6.59 RLC-Rotate Left Through Carry
RLC
dst
Operation:
dst (0) m C
C m dst (7)
dst (n + 1) m dst (n), n = 0-6
The contents of the destination operand with the carry flag are rotated left one bit position. The
initial value of bit 7 replaces the carry flag (C); the initial value of the carry flag replaces bit zero.
7
0
C
Flags:
C:
Sets if the bit rotated from the most significant bit position (bit 7) was "1".
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred, that is, if the sign of the destination changed during
rotation; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
10
R
4
11
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 0AAH, register 01H = 02H, and register 02H = 17H, C = "0":
RLC
RLC
00H
@01H
Register 00H = 54H, C = "1"
Register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 2EH, C = "0"
In the first example, when general register 00H has the value 0AAH (10101010B), the statement
"RLC 00H" rotates 0AAH 1 bit position to the left. The initial value of bit 7 sets the carry flag and
the initial value of the C flag replaces bit 0 of register 00Hby leaving the value 55H (01010101B).
The MSB of register 00H resets the carry flag to "1" and sets the overflow flag.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
207
6.6.60 RR-Rotate Right
RR
dst
Operation:
C m dst (0)
dst (7) m dst (0)
dst (n) mdst (n + 1), n = 0-6
The contents of the destination operand are rotated right one bit position. The initial value of bit
zero (LSB) is moved to bit 7 (MSB) and also replaces the carry flag (C).
7
0
C
Flags:
C:
Sets if the bit rotated from the least significant bit position (bit zero) was "1".
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred, that is, if the sign of the destination changed during
rotation; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
E0
R
4
E1
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 31H, register 01H = 02H, and register 02H = 17H:
RR
RR
00H
@01H
Register 00H = 98H, C = "1"
Register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 8BH, C = "1"
In the first example, when general register 00H contains the value 31H (00110001B), the
statement "RR 00H" rotates this value one bit position to the right. It moves the initial value of bit
zero to bit 7by leaving the new value 98H (10011000B) in the destination register. The initial bit
zero also resets the C flag to "1" and the sign flag and overflow flag are also set to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
208
6.6.61 RRC-Rotate Right through Carry
RRC
dst
Operation:
dst (7) m C
C m dst (0)
dst (n)m dst (n + 1), n = 0-6
The contents of the destination operand and the carry flag are rotated right one bit position. The
initial value of bit zero (LSB) replaces the carry flag; the initial value of the carry flag replaces bit 7
(MSB).
7
0
C
Flags:
C:
Sets if the bit rotated from the least significant bit position (bit zero) was "1".
Z:
Sets if the result is "0" otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred, that is, if the sign of the destination changed during
rotation; otherwise it clears.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
C0
R
4
C1
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 55H, register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 17H, and C = "0":
RRC
RRC
00H
@01H
Register 00H = 2AH, C = "1"
Register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 0BH, C = "1"
In the first example, when general register 00H contains the value 55H (01010101B), the
statement "RRC 00H" rotates this value 1 bit position to the right. The initial value of bit 0
("1") replaces the carry flag and the initial value of the C flag ("1") replaces bit 7. This leaves the
new value 2AH (00101010B) in destination register 00H. The sign flag and overflow flag are both
cleared to "0".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
209
6.6.62 SB0-Select Bank 0
SB0
Operation:
BANK m 0
The SB0 instruction clears the bank address flag in the FLAGS (FLAGS.0) to logic 0 by selecting
the bank 0 register addressing in the set 1 area of the register file.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
4F
opc
Example:
The statement
SB0
clears FLAGS.0 to "0" by selecting the bank 0 register addressing.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
210
6.6.63 SB1-Select Bank 1
SB1
Operation:
BANK m 1
The SB1 instruction sets the bank address flag in the FLAGS (FLAGS.0) to logic one by selecting
bank 1 register addressing in the set 1 area of the register file. (It does not implement bank 1 in
some KS88-series microcontrollers.)
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
5F
opc
Example:
The statement
SB1
sets FLAGS.0 to "1" by selecting the bank 1 register addressing, when implemented.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
211
6.6.64 SBC-Subtract With Carry
SBC
dst, src
Operation:
dstm dst-src-c
The source operand, along with the current value of the carry flag, is subtracted from the
destination operand and the result is stored in the destination. The contents of the source are
unaffected. You can perform subtraction by adding the two's-complement of the source operand
to the destination operand. In multiple precision arithmetic, this instruction permits the carry
("borrow") from the subtraction of the low-order operands to be subtracted from the subtraction of
high-order operands.
Flags:
C:
Sets if a borrow occurred (src ! dst); otherwise it clears.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred, that is, if the operands were of opposite sign and the
sign of the result is the same as the sign of the source; otherwise it clears.
D:
Always set to "1".
H:
Clears when there is a carry from the most significant bit of the low-order four bits of the
result; set otherwise, indicating a "borrow".
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
32
r
r
6
33
r
lr
6
34
R
R
6
35
R
IR
6
36
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 10H, R2 = 03H, C = "1", register 01H = 20H, register 02H = 03H, and register
03H = 0AH:
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
R1, R2
R1, @R2
01H,
01H, @02H
01H, #8AH
R1 = 0CH, R2
R1 = 05H, R2
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
=
=
=
=
=
03H
03H,
1CH,
15H,
95H;
register 03H = 0AH
register 02H = 03H
register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0AH
C, S, and V = "1"
In the first example, when working register R1 contains the value 10H and register R2 the value
03H, the statement "SBC R1, R2" subtracts the source value (03H) and the C flag value ("1") from
the destination (10H) and then stores the result (0CH) in register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
212
6.6.65 SCF-Set Carry Flag
SCF
Operation:
Cm1
The carry flag (C) is set to logic one, regardless of its previous value.
Flags:
C:
Set to "1".
Does not affect any other flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
DF
opc
Example:
The statement
SCF
sets the carry flag to logic 1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
213
6.6.66 SRA-Shift Right Arithmetic
SRA
dst
Operation:
dst (7) m dst (7)
C m dst (0)
dst (n) m dst (n + 1), n = 0-6
An arithmetic shift-right of one bit position is performed on the destination operand. Bit zero (the
LSB) replaces the carry flag. The value of bit 7 (the sign bit) is unchanged and is shifted into bit
position 6.
7
6
0
C
Flags:
C:
Sets if the bit shifted from the LSB position (bit zero) was "1".
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Always cleared to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
D0
R
4
D1
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 9AH, register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0BCH, and C = "1":
SRA
SRA
00H
@02H
Register 00H = 0CD, C = "0"
Register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0DEH, C = "0"
In the first example, when general register 00H contains the value 9AH (10011010B), the
statement "SRA 00H" shifts the bit values in register 00H right 1 bit position. Bit zero ("0") clears
the C flag and bit 7 ("1") is then shifted into the bit 6 position (bit 7 does not change). This leaves
the value 0CDH (11001101B) in destination register 00H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
214
6.6.67 SRP/SRP0/SRP1-Set Register Pointer
SRP
src
SRP0
src
SRP1
src
Operation:
If src (1) = 1 and src (0) = 0 then:
If src (1) = 0 and src (0) = 1 then:
If src (1) = 0 and src (0) = 0 then:
src (3–7)
src (3–7)
src (4–7),
0
src (4–7),
1
RP0 (3–7)
RP1 (3–7)
RP0 (4–7)
RP0 (3)
RP1 (4–7)
RP1 (3)
The source data bits 1 and 0 (LSB) determine whether to write one or both of the register
pointers, RP0 and RP1. Bits 3–7 of the selected register pointer are written unless both register
pointers are selected. RP0.3 is then cleared to logic zero and RP1.3 is set to logic one.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
src
2
4
31
IM
src
The statement
SRP # 40H
Sets register pointer 0 (RP0) at location 0D6H to 40H and register pointer 1 (RP1) at location
0D7H to 48H.
The statement "SRP0 #50H" sets RP0 to 50H, and the statement "SRP1 #68H" sets RP1 to
68H.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
215
6.6.68 STOP-Stop Operation
STOP
Operation:
The STOP instruction stops both the CPU and system clock and causes the microcontroller to
enter Stop mode. During Stop mode, the contents of on-chip CPU registers, peripheral registers,
and I/O port control and data registers are retained. An external reset operation or external
interrupts release the Stop mode. For the reset operation, the RESET pin must be held to Low
level until the required oscillation stabilization interval has elapsed.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4
7F
opc
Example:
The statement
STOP
Halts all microcontroller operations.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Addr Mode
dst
src
–
–
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
216
6.6.69 SUB-Subtract
SUB
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst-src
The source operand is subtracted from the destination operand and the result is stored in the
destination. The contents of the source are unaffected. Subtraction is performed by adding the
two's complement of the source operand to the destination operand.
Flags:
C:
Sets if a "borrow" occurred; otherwise it clears.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result is negative; otherwise it clears.
V:
Sets if arithmetic overflow occurred, that is, if the operands were of opposite signs and
sign of the result is of the same as the sign of the source operand; otherwise it
D:
Always set to "1".
H:
Clears if there is a carry from the most significant bit of the low-order four bits of the
result; set otherwise indicating a "borrow".
the
clears.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
22
r
r
6
23
r
lr
6
24
R
R
6
25
R
IR
6
26
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R1 = 12H, R2 = 03H, register 01H = 21H, register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 0AH:
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
R1, R2
R1, @R2
01H, 02H
01H, @02H
01H, #90H
01H, #65H
R1 = 0FH, R2
R1 = 08H, R2
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
Register 01H
=
=
=
=
=
=
03H
03H
1EH, register 02H = 03H
17H, register 02H = 03H
91H; C, S, and V = "1"
0BCH; C and S = "1", V = "0"
In the first example, when working register R1 contains the value 12H and when register R2
contains the value 03H, the statement "SUB R1, R2" subtracts the source value (03H) from the
destination value (12H) and stores the result (0FH) in destination register R1.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
217
6.6.70 SWAP-Swap Nibbles
SWAP
dst
Operation:
dst (0-3) l dst (4-7)
The contents of the lower four bits and upper four bits of the destination operand are swapped.
7
Flags:
4 3
0
C:
Does not define.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Does not define.
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
Addr Mode
dst
2
4
F0
R
4
F1
IR
dst
Given: Register 00H = 3EH, register 02H = 03H, and register 03H = 0A4H:
SWAP
SWAP
00H
@02H
Register 00H = 0E3H
Register 02H = 03H, register 03H = 4AH
In the first example, when general register 00H contains the value 3EH (00111110B), the
statement "SWAP 00H" swaps the lower and upper four bits (nibbles) in the 00H registerby
leaving the value 0E3H (11100011B).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
218
6.6.71 TCM-Test Complement under Mask
TCM
dst, src
Operation:
(NOT dst) AND src
This instruction tests selected bits in the destination operand for a logic 1 value. You can specify
the bits to be tested by setting a "1" bit in the corresponding position of the source operand
(mask). The TCM statement complements the destination operand, which is then ANDed with the
source mask. You can verify the zero (Z) flag to determine the result. The destination and
source operands are unaffected.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Always clears to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
62
r
r
6
63
r
lr
6
64
R
R
6
65
R
IR
6
66
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, R2 = 12H, register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H, and register
02H = 23H:
TCM
TCM
TCM
TCM
R0, R1
R0, @R1
00H, 01H
00H, @01H
TCM
00H, #34
R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, Z = "1"
R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, register 02H = 23H, Z = "0"
Register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H, Z = "1"
Register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H,
register 02H = 23H, Z = "1"
Register 00H = 2BH, Z = "0"
In the first example, when working register R0 contains the value 0C7H (11000111B) and register
R1 the value 02H (00000010B), the statement "TCM R0, R1" tests bit 1 in the destination register
for a "1" value. Because the mask value corresponds to the test bit, the Z flag is set to logic 1
and can be tested to determine the result of the TCM operation.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
219
6.6.72 TM-Test under Mask
TM
dst, src
Operation:
dst AND src
This instruction tests selected bits in the destination operand for a logic 0 value. The bits to be
tested are specified by setting a "1" bit in the corresponding position of the source operand
(mask), which is ANDed with the destination operand. The zero (Z) flag can then be checked to
determine the result. The destination and source operands are unaffected.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Set if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Set if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Always reset to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
72
r
r
6
73
r
lr
6
74
R
R
6
75
R
IR
6
76
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, R2 = 18H, register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H, and register
02H = 23H:
TM
TM
TM
TM
R0, R1
R0, @R1
00H, 01H
00H, @01H
TM
00H, #54H
R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, Z = "0"
R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, register 02H = 23H, Z = "0"
Register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H, Z = "0"
Register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H,
register 02H = 23H, Z = "0"
Register 00H = 2BH, Z = "1"
In the first example when working register R0 contains the value 0C7H (11000111B) and register
R1 the value 02H (00000010B), the statement "TM R0, R1" tests bit 1 in the destination register
for a "0" value. Because the mask value does not match the test bit, the Z flag is cleared to logic 0
and can be tested to determine the result of the TM operation.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
220
6.6.73 WFI-Wait for Interrupt
WFI
Operation:
The CPU is effectively halted until an interrupt occurs, except that DMA transfers can still take
place during this wait state. The WFI status can be released by an internal interrupt that includes
a fast interrupt.
Flags:
Does not affect any flags.
Format:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
1
4n
3F
opc
NOTE: (N = 1, 2, 3…)
Example:
The following sample program structure shows the sequence of operations that follow a "WFI"
statement:
Main program
.
.
.
EI
WFI
(Next instruction)
(Enable global interrupt)
(Wait f or interrupt)
.
.
.
Interrupt occurs
Interrupt serv ice routine
.
.
.
Clear interrupt f lag
IRET
Serv ice routine completed
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
221
6.6.74 XOR-Logical Exclusive OR
XOR
dst, src
Operation:
dst m dst XOR src
The source operand is logically exclusive-ORed with the destination operand and the result is
stored in the destination. The exclusive-OR operation results in a "1" bit being stored whenever
the corresponding bits in the operands are different; otherwise, it stores a "0" bit.
Flags:
C:
Does not affect.
Z:
Sets if the result is "0"; otherwise it clears.
S:
Sets if the result bit 7 is set; otherwise it clears.
V:
Always reset to "0".
D:
Does not affect.
H:
Does not affect.
Format:
opc
opc
opc
Examples:
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode
(Hex)
2
4
B2
r
r
6
B3
r
lr
6
B4
R
R
6
B5
R
IR
6
B6
R
IM
dst | src
src
dst
dst
3
src
3
Addr Mode
dst
src
Given: R0 = 0C7H, R1 = 02H, R2 = 18H, register 00H = 2BH, register 01H = 02H, and
register 02H = 23H:
XOR
XOR
XOR
XOR
XOR
R1
R1 value with
PS031201-0813
R0, R1
R0, @R1
00H, 01H
00H, @01H
00H, #54H
R0 = 0C5H, R1 = 02H
R0 = 0E4H, R1 = 02H, register 02H = 23H
Register 00H = 29H, register 01H = 02H
Register 00H = 08H, register 01H = 02H, register 02H = 23H
Register 00H = 7FH
In the first example when working register R0 contains the value 0C7H and when register
contains the value 02H, the statement "XOR R0, R1" logically exclusive-ORs the
the R0 value and stores the result (0C5H) in the destination register R0.
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
222
7
Clock Circuit
7.1 Overview
By smart option (3FH.2– .0 in ROM), you can select internal RC oscillator, external RC oscillator, or external
oscillator. An internal RC oscillator source provides a typical 8 MHz, 4 MHz, 1 MHz or 0.5 MHz depending on
smart option.
An external RC oscillation source provides a typical 4 MHz clock for S3F8S19/F8S15. An internal capacitor
supports the RC oscillator circuit. An external crystal or ceramic oscillation source provides a maximum 12 MHz
clock. The XIN and XOUT pins connect the oscillation source to the on-chip clock circuit. Figure 7-1, Figure 7-2,
and Figure 7-3 illustrate simplified external RC oscillator and crystal/ceramic oscillator circuits.
7.2 System Clock Circuit
The components of system clock circuit are:
x
External crystal, ceramic resonator, RC oscillation source, or an external clock source
x
Free running Ring oscillator can work in stop mode
x
Oscillator stop and wake-up functions
x
Programmable frequency divider for the CPU clock (fxx divided by 1, 2, 8 or 16)
x
System clock control register, CLKCON
x
Oscillator control register, OSCCON and STOP control register, STPCON
x
Ring oscillator control register, ROSCCON
Figure 7-1 illustrates the main oscillator circuit (RC Oscillator with Internal Capacitor).
XIN
R
S3F8S19/15
XOUT
Figure 7-1
PS031201-0813
Main Oscillator Circuit (RC Oscillator with Internal Capacitor)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Figure 7-2 illustrates the main oscillator circuit (Crystal/Ceramic Oscillator).
C1
XIN
S3F8S19/15
C2
Figure 7-2
XOUT
Main Oscillator Circuit (Crystal/Ceramic Oscillator)
Figure 7-3 illustrates the sub-system oscillator circuit.
XTIN
S3F8S19/15
XT OUT
32.768 kHz
Figure 7-3
PS031201-0813
Sub-System Oscillator Circuit (Crystal Oscillator)
PRELIMINARY
223
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
224
7.3 C2.Clock Status during Power-Down Modes
The two power-down modes, Stop mode and IDLE mode, affect clock oscillation as:
x
In Stop mode, the main oscillator "freezes", halting the CPU and peripherals. The contents of the register file
and current system register values are retained. A reset operation or an external interrupt with RC-delay noise
filter releases stop mode and starts oscillator (for S3F8S19/F8S15, INT0–INT7).
x
In Idle mode, the internal clock signal is gated off to the CPU, but not to interrupt control and the timer. The
current CPU status is preserved, including stack pointer, program counter, and flags. Data in the register file is
retained. Idle mode is released by a reset or by an interrupt (external or internally-generated).
7.4 System Clock Control Register (CLKCON)
The system clock control register, CLKCON, is located in location D4H. It is Read/Write addressable and its
functions are:
x
Oscillator Interrupt request (IRQ) wake-up function enable/disable (CLKCON.7)
x
Oscillator frequency divide-by value: non-divided, 2, 8 or 16 (CLKCON.4 and CLKCON.3)
The CLKCON register controls whether or not an external interrupt can be used to trigger a Stop mode release
(this is called the "IRQ wake-up" function). The IRQ wake-up enable bit is CLKCON.7.
After a reset, the external interrupt oscillator wake-up function is enabled, and the fOSC/16 (the slowest clock
speed) is selected as the CPU clock. If required, you can then increase the CPU clock speed to fOSC, fOSC/2 or
fOSC/8.
Figure 7-4 illustrates the system clock control register.
System Clock Control Register (CLKCON)
D4H, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
Oscillator IRQ wake-up enable bit:
0 = Enable IRQ for main system
oscillator wake-up function in
power down mode.
1 = Disable IRQ for main system
oscillator wake-up function in
power down mode.
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Not used for S3F8S19
Divide-by selection bits for
CPU clock frequency:
00 = fosc/16
01 = fosc/8
10 = fosc/2
11 = fosc (non-divided)
Not used for S3F8S19
Figure 7-4
PS031201-0813
System Clock Control Register (CLKCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
225
7.5 Internal Oscillator Calibration Control Register (OSCCALCON)
The internal oscillator calibration control register, OSCCALCON, is located in location 18H, on page8. It is
Read/Write addressable and its functions are:
x
Enables/disables OSCCALDATA register written.
After a reset, the OSCCALDATA register written is disabled, because the value of OSCCALCON is "other values".
If required, you can write the OSCCALDATA register by setting the value of OSCCALCON to "10100101B".
Figure 7-5 illustrates the internal oscillator calibration control register.
Internal Oscillator Calibration Control Register (OSCCALCON)
18H, Page8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
10100101 = Enable OSCCALDATA register write
Others = Disable OSCCALDATA register write
Figure 7-5
PS031201-0813
Internal Oscillator Calibration Control Register (OSCCALCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
226
7.6 Internal Oscillator Calibration Data Register (OSCCALDATA)
The internal oscillator calibration data register, OSCCALDATA, is located in location 17H, on page8. It is
Read/Write addressable and its functions are:
x
Calibrate the internal oscillator
After a reset, a factory calibrated value is loaded to OSCCALDATA register. This value is factory calibrated at
VDD = 5 V, 25oC. If used under different condition, you can calibrate the internal oscillator by writing different
values to OSCCALDATA register. Setting the OSCCALDATA register to a lower value (minimum 0x00), results a
higher frequency. While setting the OSCCALDATA register to a higher value (maximum 0x7F), results a lower
frequency. Note that, before writing the OSCCALDATA register, the OSCCALCON register should be set to
"10100101" to enable OSCCALDATA register data written.
Figure 7-6 illustrates the internal oscillator calibration data register.
Internal Oscillator Calibration Data Register (OSCCALDATA)
17H, Page8, R/W
MSB
.7
Not used
Figure 7-6
PS031201-0813
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Internal oscillator calibration data
Internal Oscillator Calibration Data Register (OSCCALDATA)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
227
7.7 Oscillator Control Register (OSCCON)
The oscillator control register, OSCCON, is located in set 1, bank 0, at address FBH.
It is Read/Write addressable and its functions are:
x
System clock selection
x
Main oscillator control
x
Sub oscillator control
OSCCON.0 register settings selects Main clock or Sub clock as system clock.
After a reset, Main clock is selected for system clock because the reset value of OSCCON.0 is "0".
The main oscillator can be stopped or run by setting OSCCON.3.
The sub oscillator can be stopped or run by setting OSCCON.2.
Figure 7-7 illustrates the oscillator control register.
Oscillator Control Register (OSCCON)
FBH, BANK0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
Not used for S3F8S19
Main Oscillator Control Bit:
0 = Main oscillator RUN
1 = Main oscillator STOP
.1
.0
LSB
System clock selection bit:
0 = Select main oscillator
1 = Select sub oscillator
Not used for S3F8S19
Sub Oscillator Control Bit:
0 = Sub oscillator RUN
1 = Sub oscillator STOP
Figure 7-7
PS031201-0813
Oscillator Control Register (OSCCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
228
7.8 Switching the CPU Clock
Data loading in the oscillator control register, OSCCON, determines whether a main or a sub clock is selected as
the CPU clock. It also determines how this frequency is to be divided by setting CLKCON. This makes it possible
to switch dynamically between main and sub clocks and to modify operating frequencies.
OSCCON.0 selects the main clock (fx) or the sub clock (fxt) for the CPU clock. OSCCON .3 starts or stops main
clock oscillation, and OSCCON.2 starts or stops sub clock oscillation. CLKCON.4– .3 controls the frequency
divider circuit, and divides the selected fxx clock by 1, 2, 8 and 16.
For example, you are using the default CPU clock (normal operating mode and a main clock of fx/16) and you
want to switch from the main clock (fx) to a sub clock (fxt) and to stop the main clock. To do this, you need to set
CLKCON.4-.3 to "11", OSCCON.0 to "1" and OSCCON.3 to "1" simultaneously. This switches the clock from fx to
fxt and stops main clock oscillation.
The following steps must be taken to switch from a sub clock to the main clock are:
x
Set OSCCON.3 to "0" to enable main clock oscillation
x
After a certain number of machine cycles have elapsed, select the main clock by setting OSCCON.0 to "0"
Example 7-1 shows the switching of CPU clock.
Example 7-1
1.
Switching the CPU clock
This example shows how to change from the main clock to the sub clock:
MA2SUB
LD
OSCCON, #09H
; Switches to the sub clock
; Stop the main clock oscillation
RET
2.
This example shows how to change from sub clock to main clock:
SUB2MA
DLY16
DEL
AND
CALL
AND
RET
SRP
LD
NOP
DJNZ
OSCCON, #07H
DLY16
OSCCON, #06H
; Start the main clock oscillation
; Delay 16 ms
; Switch to the main clock
#0C0H
R0, #20H
R0,DEL
RET
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
229
7.9 Ring Oscillator Control Register (ROSCCON)
The Ring oscillator control register, ROSCCON, is located in Bank 1, at address FFH. It is Read/Write
addressable and its functions are:
x
Timer 1 clock source selection bit
x
Ring oscillator enable bit
ROSCCON.6 register settings select system clock or Ring oscillator as Stop wake-up timer clock source.
After a reset, system clock is selected for Stop wake-up timer clock source because the reset value of
ROSCCON.6 is "0".
The Ring oscillator can be stopped or run by setting ROSCCON.7.
Figure 7-8 illustrates the ring oscillator control register.
Ring Oscillator Control Register (ROSCCON)
FFH, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Free Running Stop waka-up Reserved Bit
Timer Clock Source Selection
Bit:
0 = Select System Clock: Fosc
1 = Select Ring OSC
Ring OSC Enable Bit:
0 = Ring OSC Disabled
1 = Ring OSC Enabled
Figure 7-8
PS031201-0813
Ring Oscillator Control Register (ROSCCON)
PRELIMINARY
LSB
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
230
7.10 Stop Control Register (STPCON)
The STOP control register, STPCON, is located in the bank 1 of set1, address F8H. It is Read/Write addressable
and its function are:
x
Enable/Disable STOP instruction
After a reset, the STOP instruction is disabled, because the value of STPCON is "other values".
If required, you can use the STOP instruction by setting the value of STPCON to "10100101B".
Figure 7-9 illustrates the STOP control register.
STOP Control Register (STPCON)
FBH, BANK1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
STOP Control bits:
Other values = Disable STOP instruction
10100101 = Enable STOP instruction
NOTE: Before executing the STOP instruction, set the STPCON
register as "10100101b". Otherwise the STOP instruction
will not be executed and reset will be generated.
Figure 7-9
PS031201-0813
STOP Control Register (STPCON)
PRELIMINARY
LSB
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
231
Figure 7-10 illustrates the system clock circuit diagram.
Stop Release
INT
Main-System
Oscillator
Circuit
fXT
fX
Sub-system
Oscillator
Circuit
Watch Timer
LCDController
Selector 1
fXX
Stop
OSCCON.3
Stop
OSCCON.0
1/1-1/4096
STOP OSC
inst.
Frequency
Dividing
Circuit
STPCON
1/1
CLKCON.4-.3
1/2
1/8
1/16
OSCCON.2
Basic Timer
Timer/Counter A, B, 0, 1, 2
Watch Timer
LCD Controller
Stop wake-up Timer
A/D Converter
UART0, 1
SPI
IIC
LVR
Selector 2
CPU
Figure 7-10
PS031201-0813
System Clock Circuit Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
232
8
RESET and Power-Down
8.1 Overview
By using smart option (3FH.7 in ROM), you can select internal RESET (Low Voltage Reset (LVR))) or external
RESET.
You can reset the S3F8S19/F8S15 by using:
x
External power-on-reset
x
External nRESET input pin pulled low
x
Digital watchdog peripheral timing out
x
LVR
During an external power-on reset, the voltage at VDD is High level and the nRESET pin is forced to Low level. The
nRESET signal is an input through a Schmitt trigger circuit where it is then synchronized to CPU clock. This brings
the S3F8S19/F8S15 into a known operating status. To ensure correct start-up, take care that you do not release
nRESET signal before the VDD level is sufficient to allow MCU operation at the chosen frequency.
The nRESET pin must be held as Low level for a minimum time interval after the power supply enters within
tolerance to allow time for internal CPU clock oscillation to stabilize.
When a reset occurs during normal operation (with both VDD and nRESET at High level), the signal at the nRESET
pin is forced Low and the Reset operation starts. All system and peripheral control registers are then set to their
default hardware Reset values (Refer to Table 8-1 for more information).
The MCU provides a watchdog timer function to ensure graceful recovery from software malfunction. If watchdog
timer is not refreshed before an end-of-counter condition (overflow) is reached, the internal reset will be activated.
The on-chip Low Voltage, Reset features static Reset when supply voltage is below a reference value (Type 1.9,
2.3, 3.0, 3.9 V). Owing to this feature, external reset circuit can be removed while keeping the application safety.
As long as the supply voltage is below the reference value, there is an internal and static RESET. The MCU can
start only when the supply voltage rises over the reference value.
When you calculate power consumption, ensure that a static current of LVR circuit should be added a CPU
operating current in any operating modes such as Stop, Idle, and normal RUN mode.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
233
Figure 8-1 illustrates the low voltage reset circuit.
Watchdog RESET
RESET
N.F
Internal System
RESETB
Longger than 1us
VDD
VIN
Comparator
+
VREF
When the VDD level
is lower than VLVR
N.F
-
Longger than 1us
VDD
Smart Option 3FH.7
VREF
BGR
NOTES:
1. The target of voltage detection level is the one you selected at smart option 3FH.
2. BGR is Band Gap voltage Reference
Figure 8-1
Low Voltage Reset Circuit
NOTE: To program the duration of the oscillation stabilization interval, you should make the appropriate settings to the basic
timer control register, BTCON, before entering Stop mode. Also, if you do not want to use the basic timer watchdog
function, which causes a system reset if a basic timer counter overflow occurs, you can disable it by writing "1010B"
to the upper nibble of BTCON.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
234
8.1.1 MCU Initialization Sequence
The sequences of events that occur during a Reset operation are:
x
All interrupts are disabled.
x
The watchdog function (basic timer) is enabled.
x
Ports 0–4 are set to input mode
x
Peripheral control and data registers reset their initial values (Refer Table 8-1 for more information).
x
The program counter is loaded with the ROM reset address, 0100H or other values set by smart option.
x
When the programmed oscillation stabilization time interval elapses, the address stored in the first and second
bytes of RESET address in ROM is fetched and executed.
Figure 8-2 illustrates the block diagram of reset.
Smart Option
nRESET
MUX
Internal nRESET
LVR nRESET
Watchdog nRESET
Figure 8-2
Reset Block Diagram
Figure 8-3 illustrates the timing for S3F8S19/F8S15 after reset.
Oscillation Stabilization Wait Time (8.19 ms/at 8 MHz)
nRESET Input
Idle Mode
Normal Mode or
Power-Down Mode
Operation Mode
RESET Operation
Figure 8-3
PS031201-0813
Timing for S3F8S19/F8S15 After RESET
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
235
8.2 Power-Down Modes
This section includes:
x
Stop Mode
x
Using RESET to release Stop mode
x
Using an external interrupt to release stop mode
8.2.1 Stop Mode
Stop mode is invoked by the instruction STOP (opcode 7FH). In Stop mode, the operation of the CPU and all
peripherals is halted. That is, the on-chip main oscillator stops and the supply current is reduced to less than 2 PA
when LVR (Low Voltage Reset) is enabled. All system functions are halted when the clock "freezes", but data
stored in the internal register file is retained. Stop mode can be released by using one of these methods:
x
nRESET signal
x
External interrupt
NOTE: Before executing the STOP instruction, STPCON register must be set to "10100101B".
8.2.2 Using RESET to Release Stop Mode
Stop mode is released when the nRESET signal is released and returns to High level. All system and peripheral
control registers are then reset to their default values and the contents of all data registers are retained. A Reset
operation automatically selects a slow clock (fx/16) because CLKCON.3 and CLKCON.4 are cleared to "00B".
After the oscillation stabilization interval elapses, the CPU executes the system initialization routine by fetching the
16-bit address stored in the first and second bytes of RESET address (configured by smart option) in ROM.
8.2.3 Using an External Interrupt to Release Stop Mode
External interrupts with an RC-delay noise filter circuit can be used to release Stop mode (Clock-related external
interrupts cannot be used). External interrupts INT0–INT7 in the S3F8S19/F8S15 interrupt structure meet this
criterion.
Note that when Stop mode is released by an external interrupt, values in system and peripheral control registers
does not change. When you use an interrupt to release Stop mode, the CLKCON.3 and CLKCON.4 register
values remain do no change and the currently selected clock value is used. Thus you can also program the
duration of the oscillation stabilization interval by putting the appropriate value to BTCON register before entering
Stop mode.
The external interrupt is serviced when the Stop mode release occurs. After an Interrupt Return (IRET) from the
service routine, the instruction immediately following the one that initiated Stop mode is executed.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
236
8.3 IDLE Mode
Idle mode is invoked by the instruction IDLE (opcode 6FH). In Idle mode, CPU operations are halted while select
peripherals remain active. During Idle mode, the internal clock signal is gated off to the CPU, but not to interrupt
logic and timer/counters. Port pins retain the mode (input or output) they had at the time IDLE mode was entered.
There are two methods to release idle mode:
1. Execute a Reset. All system and peripheral control registers are reset to their default values and the contents
of all data registers are retained. The Reset automatically selects a slow clock (f xx/16) because CLKCON.3
and CLKCON.4 are cleared to "00B". If interrupts are masked, a Reset is the only way to release idle mode.
2. Activate any enabled interrupt, causing idle mode to be released. When you use an interrupt to release idle
mode, the CLKCON.3 and CLKCON.4 register values remain do not change, and the currently selected clock
value is used. The interrupt is then serviced. After an IRET from the service routine, the instruction
immediately following the one that initiated idle mode is executed.
NOTE:
1.
Only external interrupts that are not clock-related can be used to release stop mode. However, to release Idle mode, any
type of interrupt (that is, internal or external) can be used.
2.
Before you enter the STOP or IDLE mode, ADC must be disabled. Otherwise, STOP or IDLE current will be increased
significantly.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
237
8.4 Hardware Reset Values
The reset values for CPU and system registers, peripheral control registers, and peripheral data registers
following a reset operation.
The following notation is used to represent reset values:
x
A "1" or a "0" show the reset bit value as logic one or logic zero, respectively.
x
An "x" means that the bit value is undefined after a reset.
x
A dash ("–") means that the bit is either not used or not mapped, but read 0 is the bit value.
Table 8-1 lists the S3F8S19/F8S15 set1 register values after RESET.
Table 8-1
Register Name
S3F8S19/F8S15 Set1 Register Values after RESET
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
R/W
nRESET Value(bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
A/D Converter Data Register
(High Byte)
ADDATAH
208
D0H
R
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
A/D Converter Data Register
(Low Byte)
ADDATAL
209
D1H
R
–
–
–
–
–
–
x
x
A/D Converter Control Register
ADCON
210
D2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Basic Timer Control Register
BTCON
211
D3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLKCON
212
D4H
R/W
0
–
–
0
0
–
–
–
FLAGS
213
D5H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
0
Register Pointer 0
RP0
214
D6H
R/W
1
1
0
0
0
–
–
–
Register Pointer 1
RP1
215
D7H
R/W
1
1
0
0
1
–
–
–
Stack Pointer (high byte)
SPH
216
D8H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Stack Pointer (low byte)
SPL
217
D9H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Instruction Pointer (High Byte)
IPH
218
DAH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Instruction Pointer (Low Byte)
IPL
219
DBH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Interrupt Request Register
IRQ
220
DCH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Interrupt Mask Register
IMR
221
DDH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
System Mode Register
SYM
222
DEH
R/W
–
–
–
x
x
x
0
0
Register Page Pointer
PP
223
DFH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
System Clock control Register
System Flags Register
NOTE: –: Not mapped or not used, x: Does not define.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
238
Table 8-2 lists the value of system and peripheral control registers set1 bank 0.
Table 8-2
System and Peripheral Control Registers Set1 Bank 0
Register Name
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
TACNT
224
E0H
Timer A Data Register
TADATA
225
Timer A Control Register
TACON
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
226
E2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAPS
227
E3H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Counter Register
(High Byte)
T0CNTH
232
E8H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Counter Register
(Low Byte)
T0CNTL
233
E9H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 0 Data Register (High Byte)
T0DATAH
234
EAH
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 0 Data Register (Low Byte)
T0DATAL
235
EBH
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T0CON
236
ECH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T0PS
237
EDH
R/W
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Counter Register
(High Byte)
T1CNTH
238
EEH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Counter Register
(Low Byte)
T1CNTL
239
EFH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 Data Register (High Byte)
T1DATAH
240
F0H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 1 Data Register (Low Byte)
T1DATAL
241
F1H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T1CON
242
F2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1PS
243
F3H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Counter Register (High Byte)
T2CNTH
244
F4H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Counter Register (Low Byte)
T2CNTL
245
F5H
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 2 Data Register (High Byte)
T2DATAH
246
F6H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer 2 Data Register (Low Byte)
T2DATAL
247
F7H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T2CON
248
F8H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T2PS
249
F9H
R/W
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
WTCON
250
FAH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OSCCON
251
FBH
R/W
–
–
–
–
0
0
–
0
BTCNT
253
FDH
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IPR
255
FFH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Timer A Counter Register
Timer A Pre-scalar
Location E4H to E7H are Not Mapped
Timer 0 Control Register
Timer 0 Pre-scalar
Timer 1 Control Register
Timer 1 Pre-scalar
Timer 2 Control Register
Timer 2 Pre-scalar
Watch Timer Control Register
Oscillator Control Register
Location FCH is Not Mapped
Basic Timer Counter
Location FEH is Not Mapped
Interrupt Priority Register
NOTE: –: Not mapped or not used, x: Undefined
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
239
Table 8-3 lists the value of system and peripheral control registers set1 bank 1.
Table 8-3
System and Peripheral Control Registers Set1 Bank 1
Register Name
Mnemonic
Port 0 Control Register (High Byte)
Port 0 Control Register (Low Byte)
Address
Decimal
Hex
P0CONH
224
E0H
P0CONL
225
Port 0 Pull-up Resistor Enable
Register
P0PUR
Port 0 Interrupt Control Register
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
226
E2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
P0INT
227
E3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Control Register (High Byte)
P1CONH
228
E4H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Control Register (Low Byte)
P1CONL
229
E5H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Control Register (High Byte)
P2CONH
230
E6H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Control Register (Low Byte)
P2CONL
231
E7H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Control Register (High Byte)
P3CONH
232
E8H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Control Register (Low Byte)
P3CONL
233
E9H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 N-Channel Open-drain
Mode Register
PNE3
234
EAH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Interrupt Control Register
P3INT
235
EBH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Pull-up Resistor Enable
Register
P3PUR
236
ECH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Pull-up Resistor Enable
Register
P4PUR
237
EDH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Control Register (High Byte)
P4CONH
238
EEH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Control Register (Low Byte)
P4CONL
239
EFH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PNE4
240
F0H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 0 Data Register
P0
241
F1H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 1 Data Register
P1
242
F2H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 2 Data Register
P2
243
F3H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 3 Data Register
P3
244
F4H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 Data Register
P4
245
F5H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
External Interrupt Pending Register
PINTPND
246
F6H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SPI Control Register
SPICON
247
F7H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SPI Status Register
SPISTAT
248
F8H
R/W
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
0
SPI Data Register
SPIDATA
249
F9H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Reset ID
RESETID
250
FAH
R/W
STOP Control Register
STPCON
251
FBH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LCD Mode Register
LMOD
252
FCH
R/W
–
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
LCD Control Register
LCON
253
FDH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Port 4 N-Channel Open-drain
Mode Register
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Refer to detail description
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Register Name
LVD Control Register
Ring OSC Control Register
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
LVDCON
254
FEH
ROSCCON
255
FFH
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
240
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
1
–
0
0
0
–
0
0
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
NOTE: –: Not mapped or not used, read "0"; x: Undefined
Table 8-4 lists the values of system and peripheral control registers page 8.
Table 8-4
Register Name
System and Peripheral Control Registers Page 8
Mnemonic
Address
Decimal
Hex
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UART0 Control Register
(High Byte)
UART0CONH
0
00H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UART0 Control Register
(Low Byte)
UART0CONL
1
01H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UDATA0
2
02H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
BRDATA0
3
03H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
UART1 Control Register
(High Byte)
UART1CONH
4
04H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UART1 Control Register
(Low Byte)
UART1CONL
5
05H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
UDATA1
6
06H
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
UART1 Baud Rate Data Register
BRDATA1
7
07H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Flash Memory Sector Address
Register (High Byte)
FMSECH
8
08H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory Sector Address
Register (Low Byte)
FMSECL
9
09H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory User Programming
Enable Register
FMUSR
10
0AH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Flash Memory Control Register
FMCON
11
0BH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
0
IIC Control Register
ICCR
12
0CH
R/W
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
IIC Status Register
ICSR
13
0DH
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IIC Data Shift Register
IDSR
14
0EH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
IAR
15
0FH
R/W
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Stop Wake-up Timer Control
Register
SWTCON
16
10H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
16-bit Timer B control register
TBCON
17
11H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Timer B Reference Data Register 0
(High Byte)
TBDATA0H
18
12H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Timer B Reference Data Register 0
(Low Byte)
TBDATA0L
19
13H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
UART0 Data Register
UART0 Baud Rate Data Register
UART1 Data Register
IIC Address Register
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Register Name
Mnemonic
Timer B Reference Data Register 1
(High Byte)
Timer B Reference Data Register 1
(Low Byte)
Address
Decimal
Hex
TBDATA1H
20
14H
TBDATA1L
21
TBTRG
Internal OSC Calibration Data
Register
Internal OSC Calibration Control
Register
Timer B Trigger Control Register
R/W
nRESET Value (bit)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
15H
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
22
16H
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OSCCALDATA
23
17H
R/W
–
OSCCALCON
24
18H
R/W
0
0
0
0
(NOTE)
0
0
0
0
NOTE: The reset value of OSCCALDATA register is factory-calibrated. Different chips may have different reset values.
PS031201-0813
241
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
242
9
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
9.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller has 5-bit-programmable I/O ports, P0-P4. This port provides a total of 40 I/O
pins. Each port can be flexibly configured to meet application design requirements. The CPU accesses ports by
directly writing or reading port registers. No special I/O instructions are required.
Table 9-1 lists configuration overview of the S3F8S19/F8S15 I/O port functions.
Table 9-1
Port
S3F8S19/F8S15 Port Configuration Overview
Configuration Options
0
I/O port with bit-programmable pins.
Configurable to Schmitt trigger input or push-pull output mode. Pull-up resistors can be
assigned by software. Pins can also be assigned individually as alternative function pins.
1
I/O port with bit-programmable pins.
Configurable to input or push-pull output mode. Pull-up resistors can be assigned by software.
Pins can also be assigned individually as alternative function pins.
2
I/O port with bit-programmable pins.
Configurable to input mode, push-pull output mode. Pins can also be assigned individually as
alternative function pins.
3
I/O port with bit-programmable pins.
Configurable to Schmitt trigger input mode, push-pull output mode or open-drain output mode.
Pins can also be assigned individually as alternative function pins.
4
I/O port with bit-programmable pins.
Configurable to input mode, push-pull output mode or open-drain output mode. Pins can also
be assigned individually as alternative function pins.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
243
9.2 Port Data Registers
Table 9-2 provides an overview of the register locations of all five S3F8S19/F8S15 I/O port data registers.
Data registers for ports 0, 1, 2, 3 and 4 have the general format as illustrated in Figure 9-1.
Table 9-2
Register Name
Port Data Register Summary
Mnemonic
Decimal
Hex
Location
R/W
Port 0 data register
P0
241
F1H
Set1, Bank1
R/W
Port 1 data register
P1
242
F2H
Set1, Bank1
R/W
Port 2 data register
P2
243
F3H
Set1, Bank1
R/W
Port 3 data register
P3
244
F4H
Set1, Bank1
R/W
Port 4 data register
P4
245
F5H
Set1, Bank1
R/W
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
244
9.3 Port 0
Port 0 is an 8-bit I/O port that you can use in two ways:
x
General-purpose I/O
x
Alternative function
Port 0 is accessed directly by writing or reading the port 0 data register, P0 at location F1H, Set1 Bank1.
9.3.1 Port 0 Control Register (P0CONH, P0CONL)
Port 0 pins are configured individually by bit-pair settings in two control registers located at:
x
P0CONH (high byte, E0H, Set1 Bank1)
x
P0CONL (low byte, E1H, Set1 Bank1)
When you select output mode, a push-pull circuit is configured. The various selections that are available are:
x
Schmitt trigger input mode.
x
Output mode (Push-pull or Open-drain)
x
Alternative function: External Interrupt – INT0, INT1,INT2, INT3
x
Alternative function: BUZ output-BUZ
x
Alternative function: ADC input-ADC0-ADC7
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
245
Figure 9-1 illustrates the port 0 control register high byte (P0CONH)
Port 0 High Control Register (P0CONH)
E0H, Set1, Bank1, R/W, Reset value:00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P0.7/ AD7 P0.6/ AD6
.3
.2
P0.5/ AD5
.1
.0
LSB
P0.4/ AD4
.7 -.6 bit/P0.7/ AD7 Configuration Bits
Input mode
Alternative function (TAOUT)
Alternative function (AD7)
Push-pull output mode
.5 .4 bit/P0.6/ AD6 Configuration Bits
00
01
10
11
00
01
10
11
Input mode
Alternative function (TBOUT)
Alternative function (AD6)
Push-pull output
.3 .2 bit/P0.5/ AD5 Configuration Bits
00
01
10
11
Input mode
Alternative function (T0OUT)
Alternative function (AD5)
Push-pull output mode
.1 .0 bit/P0.4/ AD4 Configuration Bits
00
01
10
11
Input mode
Alternative function (T1OUT)
Alternative function (AD4)
Push-pull output mode
Note: If you want to use LCD pin and TXOUT at the same time, you can set P0CONH
toĀ01010101" to use alternative function TXOUT.
Figure 9-1
PS031201-0813
Port 0 Control Register High Byte (P0CONH)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
246
Figure 9-2 illustrates the pull-up resistor enable register (P0PUR).
Port 0 Pull-up Resistor Enable Register (P0PUR)
E2H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P0.7
P0.6
P0.5
P0.4
.3
.2
P0.3 P0.2
.1
.0
P0.1
LSB
P0.0
P0PUR bit configuration settings:
0
Disable Pull-up Resistor
1
Enable Pull-up Resistor
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 0 is automatically disabled
only when the corresponding pin is selected as
push-pull output or alternative function.
Figure 9-2
Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (P0PUR)
Figure 9-3 illustrates the Port 0 interrupt control register (P0INT).
Port 0 Interrupt Control Register (P0INT)
E3H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
P0.3/ INT3
.5
.4
P0.2/INT2
.3
.2
P0.1/INT1
.1
.0
LSB
P0.0/INT0
P0INT bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
10
01
11
Disable interrupt
Enable interrupt; interrupt on falling edge
Enable interrupt; interrupt on rising edge
Enable interrupt; interrupt on rising or falling edge
Figure 9-3
PS031201-0813
Port 0 Interrupt Control Register (P0INT)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
247
9.4 Port 1
Port 1 is an 8-bit I/O port with individually configurable pins. Port 1 pins are accessed directly by writing or reading
the port 1 data register, P1 at location F2H in set 1, bank1. P1.0–P1.7 can serve as inputs (with or without pullups) and push-pull outputs or you can configure the alternative functions:
x
CA, CB, VLC0 to VLC3
9.4.1 Port 1 Control Register High Byte
Port 1 has one 8-bit control register: P1CONH for P1.7–P1.4. A reset clears the P1CONH registers to "00H" by
configuring all pins to input mode. You use control registers settings to:
x
Select input or output mode
x
Enable pull-up resistors
x
Select push-pull mode
x
Enable the alternative functions
While programming the port, remember that any alternative peripheral I/O function you configure using the port 1
control registers must also be enabled in the associated peripheral module.
Figure 9-4 illustrates the Port 1 control register high byte.
Port 1 Control Register (P1CONH)
E4H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
P1.6/ADC8 P1.5/VLC3(note) P1.4/VLC2(note)
P1.7/ADC9
P1CONH bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
Input mode
01
10
Input mode, pull-up
11
Output mode, push-pull
Alternative function (ADC8 for P1.6, ADC9 for P1.7)
NOTE: Refer to LCON register in LCD Chapter.
Figure 9-4
PS031201-0813
Port 1 Control Register High Byte
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
248
9.4.2 Port 1 Control Register Low Byte (P1CONL)
Port 1 has one 8-bit control register: P1CONLfor P1.3–P1.0. A reset clears the P1CONL registers to "00H" by
configuring all pins to input mode. You use control registers settings to select input or output mode, enable pull-up
resistors, select push-pull mode and enable the alternative functions.
When programming the port, please remember that any alternative peripheral I/O function you configure using the
port 1 control registers must also be enabled in the associated peripheral module.
Figure 9-5 illustrates the port 1 control register low byte.
Port 1 Control Register (P1CONL)
E5H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
P1.3/VLC1(note) P1.2/VLC0(note) P1.1/CB(note) P1.0/CA(note)
P1CONL bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
Input mode
01
10
Input mode, pull-up
11
not available
Output mode, push-pull
NOTE: Refer to LCON register in LCD Chapter.
Figure 9-5
PS031201-0813
Port 1 Control Register Low Byte
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
249
9.5 Port 2
Port 2 is an 8-bit I/O port with individually configurable pins. Port 2 pins are accessed directly by writing or reading
the port 2 data register, P2 at location F3H in set 1, bank 1. P2.0–P2.7 can serve as inputs (with or without pullups) and push-pull outputs or you can configure the alternative functions:
x
Low-byte pins (P2.0–P2.3): COM0, COM1, COM2/SEG0, COM3/SEG1
x
High-byte pins (P2.4–P2.7): COM4/SEG2, COM5/SEG3, COM6/SEG4, COM7/SEG5
9.5.1 Port 2 Control Registers (P2CONH, P2CONL)
Port 2 has two 8-bit control registers: P2CONH for P2.4–P2.7 and P2CONL for P2.0–P2.3. A reset clears the
P2CONH and P2CONL registers to "00H"by configuring all pins to input mode. You use control registers settings
to select input (with or without pull-ups) or push-pull output mode and enable the alternative functions.
When programming the port, please remember that any alternative peripheral I/O function you configure using the
port 2 control registers must also be enabled in the associated peripheral module.
Figure 9-6 illustrates the Port 2 high-byte control register.
Port 2 Control Register, High Byte (P2CONH)
E6H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
P2.7/SEG5
/COM7
.4
P2.6/SEG4
/COM6
.3
.2
P2.5/SEG3
/COM5
.1
.0
LSB
P2.4/SEG2
/COM4
P2CONH bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
01
10
Input mode
Input mode, pull-up
Alternative function (LCD signal)
11
Output mode, push-pull
Figure 9-6
PS031201-0813
Port 2 High-Byte Control Register (P2CONH)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
250
Figure 9-7 illustrates the Port 2 low-byte control register.
Port 2 Control Register, Low Byte (P2CONL)
E7H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
P2.3/SEG1
/COM3
.5
.4
P2.2/SEG0
/COM2
.3
.2
P2.1/COM1
.1
.0
LSB
P2.0/COM0
P2CONL bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
01
Input mode
Input mode, pull-up
10
11
Alternative function (LCD signal)
Output mode, push-pull
Figure 9-7
PS031201-0813
Port 2 Low-Byte Control Register (P2CONL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
251
9.6 Port 3
Port 3 is an 8-bit I/O port with individually configurable pins. Port 3 pins are accessed directly by writing or reading
the port 3 data register, P3 at location F1H in set 1, bank 1. P3.0–P3.7 can serve as inputs (with or without pullups), and outputs (push pull or open-drain). P3.7–P3.0 can serve as segment pins for LCD or you can configure
the alternative functions:
x
Low-byte pins (P3.0–P3.3): MISO, MOSI, SCK, NSS
x
High-byte pins (P3.4–P3.7): INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP, INT5/T2CLK/SDA, INT6/T1CLK/SCL, INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP
9.6.1 Port 3 Control Register (P3CONH, P3CONL)
Port 3 has two 8-bit control registers: P3CONH for P3.4-P3.7 and P3CONL for P3.0-P3.3. A reset clears the
P3CONH and P3CONL registers to "00H" by configuring all pins to input mode. In input mode, three different
selections are available. They are:
x
Schmitt trigger input with interrupt generation on falling signal edges.
x
Schmitt trigger input with interrupt generation on rising signal edges.
x
Schmitt trigger input with interrupt generation on falling/rising signal edges.
When programming the port, please remember that any alternative peripheral I/O function you configure using the
port 3 control registers must also be enabled in the associated peripheral module.
9.6.2 Port 3 Interrupt Enable and Pending Registers (P3INT, PINTPND)
To process external interrupts at the port 3 pins, the additional control registers are provided:
x
port 3 interrupt enable register P3INT (EBH, set 1, bank 1)
x
port 3 interrupt pending register PINTPND (F6H, set 1, bank1)
The port 3 interrupt pending register PINTPND enables you to verify for interrupt pending conditions and clears
the pending condition when the interrupt service routine has been initiated. The application program detects
interrupt requests by polling the PINTPND register at regular intervals.
When the interrupt enable bit of any port 3 pin is "1", a rising or falling signal edge at that pin generates an
interrupt request. The corresponding PINTPND bit is then automatically set to "1" Interrupt Request (IRQ) level
becomes low to signal the CPU that an interrupt request is waiting. When the CPU acknowledges the interrupt
request, application software should clear the pending condition by writing a "0" to the corresponding PINTPND
bit.
9.6.3 Port 3 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (P3PUR)
By using the port 3 pull-up resistor enable register, P3PUR (ECH, set1, bank1), you can configure pull-up resistors
to individual port 3 pins.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
252
9.6.4 Port 3 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (PNE3)
By using the port 3 n-channel open-drain mode register, PNE3 (EAH, set1, bank1), you can configure push-pull or
open-drain output mode to individual port 3 pins.
Figure 9-8 illustrates the Port 3 high-byte control register.
Port 3 Control Register, High Byte (P3CONH)
E8H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
LSB
.0
P3.7/INT7/T1OUT P3.6/INT6/ P3.5/INT5/T2OUT/ P3.4/INT4/
T1CLK/ T2CLK/SDA/SEG11 T2OUT/T2C
/T1CAP/SEG13
AP/SEG10
SEG12/
SCL
P3CONH bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
Schmitt trigger input mode (T1CAP, T1CLK, T2CAP, T2CLK)
01
Alternative function (T1OUT, SCL, SDA, T2OUT)
10
Alternative function (LCD signal)
11
Output mode
Figure 9-8
Port 3 High-Byte Control Register (P3CONH)
Figure 9-9 illustrates the port 3 low-byte control register.
Port 3 Control Register, Low Byte (P3CONL)
E9H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
P3.3/NSS/SEG9
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
P3.1/MOSI/SEG7 P3.0/
P3.2/
MISO/SEG6
SCK/SEG8
P3CONL bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
Schmitt trigger input mode (SCK in)
01
Alternative function (SCK out, NSS, MOSI, MISO)
10
Alternative function (LCD signal)
11
Output mode
Figure 9-9
PS031201-0813
Port 3 Low-Byte Control Register (P3CONL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
253
Figure 9-10 illustrates the Port 3 interrupt control register.
Port 3 Interrupt Control Register (P3INT)
EBH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
INT7
.4
.3
INT6
.2
.1
INT5
.0
LSB
INT4
P3INTH bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
Disable interrupt
01
Enable interrupt by falling edge
10
Enable interrupt by rising edge
11
Enable interrupt by both falling and rising edge
Figure 9-10
Port 3 Interrupt Control Register (P3INT)
Figure 9-11 illustrates the Port 3 and Port 0 interrupt pending register.
Port 3 & Port 0 Interrupt Pending Register (PINTPND)
F6H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
P3.7
P3.6
P3.5
P3.4
P0.3
P0.2
P0.1
P0.0
LSB
PINTPND bit configuration settings:
Figure 9-11
PS031201-0813
0
Interrupt request is not pending,
pending bit clear when write 0
1
Interrupt request is pending
Port 3 and Port 0 Interrupt Pending Register (PINTPND)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
254
Figure 9-12 illustrates the Port 3 pull-up resistor enable register.
Port 3 Pull-up Resistor Enable Register (P3PUR)
ECH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P3.7
P3.6
P3.5
P3.4
.3
.2
P3.3 P3.2
.1
P3.1
.0
LSB
P3.0
P3PUR bit configuration settings:
0
Disable Pull-up Resistor
1
Enable Pull-up Resistor
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 3 is automatically disabled
only when the corresponding pin is selected as
push-pull output or alternative function.
Figure 9-12
Port 3 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (P3PUR)
Figure 9-13 illustrates the Port 3 N-channel open-drain mode register.
Port 3 N-Channel Open-drain Mode Register (PNE3)
EAH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P3.7
P3.6
P3.5
P3.4
.3
.2
P3.3 P3.2
.1
P3.1
.0
LSB
P3.0
PNE3 bit configuration settings:
Figure 9-13
PS031201-0813
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drainl output mode
Port 3 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (PNE3)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
255
9.7 Port 4
Port 4 is an 8-bit I/O port with individually configurable pins. Port 4 pins are accessed directly by writing or reading
the port 4 data register, P4 at location F5H in set 1, bank 1. P4.0–P4.7 can serve as inputs (with or without pullups) and outputs (push pull or open-drain). P4.7–P4.0 can serve as segment pins for LCD or you can configure
the alternative functions:
x
Low-byte pins (P4.0-P4.3): T0OUT, TBOUT, TACLK, TACAP, TAOUT
x
High-byte pins (P4.4-P4.7): TxD1, RxD1, TxD0, RxD0
9.7.1 Port 4 Control Register (P4CONH, P4CONL)
Port 4 has two 8-bit control registers: P4CONH for P4.4–P4.7 and P4CONL for P4.0–P4.3. A reset clears the
P4CONH and P4CONL registers to "00H" by configuring all pins to input mode. You use control registers settings
to select input or output mode, enable pull-up resistors, select push-pull or open drain output mode and enable the
alternative functions.
When programming the port, please remember that any alternative peripheral I/O function you configure using the
port 4 control registers should also be enabled in the associated peripheral module.
9.7.2 Port 4 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (P4PUR)
By using the port 4 pull-up resistor enable register, P4PUR (EDH, set1, bank1), you can configure pull-up resistors
to individual port 4 pins.
9.7.3 Port 4 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (PNE4)
By using the port 4 n-channel open-drain mode register, PNE4 (F0H, set1, bank1), you can configure push-pull or
open-drain output mode to individual port 4 pins.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
256
Figure 9-14 illustrates the Port 4 high-byte control register.
Port 4 Control Register, High Byte (P4CONH)
EEH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
P4.7/SEG21 P4.6/SEG20 P4.5/SEG19 P4.4/SEG18
/RXD0
/TXD0
/RXD1
/TXD1
P4CONH bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
01
10
Input mode (RXD0, RXD1)
Alternative function (RXD0, TXD0, RXD1, TXD1)
Alternative function (LCD signal)
11
Output mode
Figure 9-14
Port 4 High-Byte Control Register (P4CONH)
Figure 9-15 illustrates the port 4 low-byte control register.
Port 4 Control Register, Low Byte (P4CONL)
EFH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P4.3/TAOUT/TAC P4.2/TACLK
AP/SEG17
/SEG16
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
P4.1/TBOU P4.0/T0OUT/SEG
T/SEG15
14
P4CONL bit-pair pin configuration settings:
00
01
10
Input mode (TACAP, TACLK)
Alternative function (TAOUT, TBOUT, T0OUT)
Alternative function (LCD signal)
11
Output mode
Figure 9-15
PS031201-0813
Port 4 Low-Byte Control Register (P4CONL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
257
Figure 9-16 illustrates the Port 4 pull-up resistor enable register.
Port 4 Pull-up Resistor Enable Register (P4PUR)
EDH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
P4.7
.5
P4.6 P4.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
P4.4
P4.3
P4.2
P4.1
P4.0
LSB
P4PUR bit configuration settings:
0
Disable Pull-up Resistor
1
Enable Pull-up Resistor
NOTE: A pull-up resistor of port 4 is automatically disabled
only when the corresponding pin is selected as
push-pull output or alternative function.
Figure 9-16
Port 4 Pull-Up Resistor Enable Register (P4PUR)
Figure 9-17 illustrates the Port 4 N-channel open-drain mode register.
Port 4 N-Channel Open-drain Mode Register (PNE4)
F0H, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
P4.7
P4.6
P4.5
P4.4
.3
.2
P4.3 P4.2
.1
P4.1
.0
LSB
P4.0
PNE4 bit configuration settings:
Figure 9-17
PS031201-0813
0
Push-pull output mode
1
Open-drainl output mode
Port 4 N-Channel Open-Drain Mode Register (PNE4)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
258
10
Basic Timer
10.1 Overview
S3F8S19/F8S15 has an 8-bit basic timer.
10.1.1 Basic Timer
You can use the basic timer (BT) in two different ways:
x
As a watchdog timer to provide an automatic reset mechanism in the event of a system malfunction.
x
To signal the end of the required oscillation stabilization interval after a reset or a Stop mode release.
The functional components of the basic timer block are:
x
Clock frequency divider (fxx divided by 4096, 1024, 128) with multiplexer
x
8-bit basic timer counter, BTCNT (set 1, Bank 0, FDH, read-only)
x
Basic timer control register, BTCON (set 1, D3H, Read/Write)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
259
10.2 Basic Timer Control Register
The basic timer control register, BTCON, is used to select the input clock frequency to clear the basic timer
counter and frequency dividers. It also enables or disables the watchdog timer function. It is located in set 1,
address D3H, and is Read/Write addressable using Register addressing mode.
A reset clears BTCON to "00H". This enables the watchdog function and selects a basic timer clock frequency of
fxx/4096. To disable the watchdog function, you should write the signature code "1010B" to the basic timer
register control bits BTCON.7–BTCON.4.
You can clear the 8-bit basic timer counter, BTCNT (set 1, bank 0, FDH) at any time during the normal operation
by writing a "1" to BTCON.1. To clear the frequency dividers, write a "1" to BTCON.0.
Figure 10-1 illustrates the basic timer control register.
Basic TImer Control Register (BTCON)
D3H, Set 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
Watchdog timer enable bits:
1010B
= Disable watchdog function
Other value = Enable watchdog function
.1
.0
LSB
Divider clear bit:
0 = No effect
1= Clear dvider
Basic timer counter clear bit:
0 = No effect
1= Clear BTCNT
Basic timer input clock selection bits:
00 = fXX/4096
01 = fXX/1024
10 = fXX/128
11 = invalid selection
Figure 10-1
PS031201-0813
Basic Timer Control Register (BTCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
10.3 Basic Timer Function Description
260
This section includes:
x
Watchdog timer function
x
Oscillation stabilization interval timer function
10.3.1 Watchdog Timer Function
You can program the basic timer overflow signal (BTOVF) to generate a reset by setting BTCON.7–BTCON.4 to
any value other than "1010B". (The "1010B" value disables the watchdog function). A reset clears BTCON to
"00H" and automatically enables the watchdog timer function. A reset also selects the CPU clock (as determined
by the current CLKCON register setting) divided by 4096 as the BT clock.
The MCU is resented whenever a basic timer counter overflow occurs. During normal operation, the application
program should prevent the overflow, and the accompanying reset operation from occurring. To do this, you
should clear BTCNT value (by writing a "1" to BTCON.1) at regular intervals.
If a system malfunction occurs due to circuit noise or some other error condition, the BT counter clear operation
will not be executed and a basic timer overflow occurs, initiating a reset. Alternatively, during the normal operation,
a BTCNT clear instruction always beak the basic timer overflow loop (a bit 7 overflow of the 8-bit basic timer
counter, BTCNT). If a malfunction occurs, a reset is triggered automatically.
10.3.2 Oscillation Stabilization Interval Timer Function
You can also use the basic timer to program a specific oscillation stabilization interval after a reset or when an
external interrupt releases stop mode.
In stop mode, whenever a reset or an external interrupt occurs, the oscillator starts. The BTCNT value then starts
increasing at the rate of fxx/4096 (for reset), or at the rate of the preset clock source (for an external interrupt).
When BTCNT.4 overflows, a signal is generated to indicate that it elapses the stabilization interval and to gate the
clock signal off to the CPU so that it can resume the normal operation.
In summary, the events that occur when stop mode is released:
1. During the stop mode, a power-on reset or an external interrupt occurs to trigger the Stop mode release and
oscillation starts.
2. If a power-on reset occurs, the basic timer counter increases at the rate of fxx/4096. If an interrupt is used to
release stop mode, the BTCNT value increases at the rate of the preset clock source.
3. Clock oscillation stabilization interval begins and continues until bit 4 of the basic timer counter overflows.
4. When a BTCNT.4 overflow occurs, the normal CPU operation resumes.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
261
Figure 10-2 illustrates the basic timer block diagram.
RESET or STOP
Bit 1
Bits 3, 2
Basic Timer Control Register
(Write '1010xxxxB' to Disable)
Data Bus
fXX/4096
Clear
fXX/1024
fXX
DIV
fXX/128
8-Bit Up Counter
(BTCNT, Read-Only)
MUX
OVF
Start the CPU (NOTE)
R
Bit 0
NOTE:
During a power-on reset operation, the CPU is idle during the required oscillation
stabilization interval (until bit 4 of the basic timer counter overflows).
Figure 10-2
PS031201-0813
Basic Timer Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
RESET
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
262
11
8-Bit Timer A
11.1 Overview
The 8-bit timer A is an 8-bit general-purpose timer/counter.
Timer A has three operating modes; you can select one of the modes using appropriate TACON setting.
The settings are:
x
Interval timer mode (Toggle output at TAOUT pin)
x
Capture input mode with a rising or falling edge trigger at the TACAP pin
x
PWM mode (TAOUT)
The functional components of Timer A are:
x
Clock frequency divider (fxx divided by 1024, 256, 64, 8 or 1) with multiplexer
x
External clock input pin (TACLK)
x
8-bit counter (TACNT), 8-bit comparator, and 8-bit reference data register (TADATA)
x
I/O pins for capture input (TACAP) or PWM or match output (TAOUT)
x
Timer A overflows interrupt (IRQ0 vector D0H) and matches/captures interrupt (IRQ0 vector CEH) generation
x
Timer A control register, TACON (set 1, Bank 0, E2H, and Read/Write)
x
Timer A pre-scalar register
PS031201-0813
and TAPS (set 1, Bank 0, E3H, and Read/Write)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
263
11.2 Timer A Control Register (TACON)
You use the timer A control register, TACON, to:
x
Select the timer A operating mode (interval timer, capture mode or PWM mode)
x
Select the timer A input clock frequency
x
Clear the timer A counter and TACNT
x
Enable the timer A overflow interrupt or timer A match/capture interrupt
TACON is located in set 1, Bank 0 at address E2H and is Read/Write addressable using Register addressing
mode.
A reset clears TACON to "00H". This sets timer A to normal interval timer mode, selects an input clock frequency
of fxx, and disables all timer A interrupts. You can clear the timer A counter at any time during normal operation by
writing "1" to TACON.5.
The timer A overflow interrupt (TAOVF) in interrupt level IRQ0 and have the vector address D0H. When a timer A
overflow interrupt occurs and is serviced by the CPU, the pending condition is cleared automatically by hardware
or must be cleared by software.
To enable the timer A match/capture interrupt (IRQ0, vector CEH), you should write TACON.3 to "1". To detect a
match/capture interrupt pending condition, the application program polls TACON.1. When a "1" is detected, a
timer A match or capture interrupt is pending. When the interrupt request has been serviced, the pending
condition should be cleared by software by writing a "0" to the timer A match/capture interrupt pending bit,
TACON.1.
Figure 11-1 illustrates the timer A control register.
Timer A Control Register (TACON)
E2H, Set1, Bank0, R/W, Reset: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer A OVF Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer A operating mode selection bit:
00 = Interval mode (TAOUT mode)
01 = Capture mode (capture on rising edge,
counter running, OVF can occur)
10 = Capture mode (capture on falling edge,
counter running, OVF can occur)
11 = PWM mode (OVF interrupt and match
interrupt can occur)
Timer A match Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer A counter clear bit:
0 = No effect
1 = Clear the timer A counter
(when write)
Timer A overflow interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable overflow interrupt
1 = Enable overflow interrrupt
Timer A match/capture interrupt
enable bit:
0 = Disable interrupt
1 = Enable interrrupt
Timer A start/stop bit:
0 = Stop timer A
1 = Start timer A
NOTE:
When the counter clear bit(.5) is set, the 8-bit counter is cleared and
it will be cleared automatically.
Figure 11-1
PS031201-0813
Timer A Control Register (TACON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
264
Figure 11-2 illustrates the timer A pre-scalar register.
Timer A Prescaler Register (TAPS)
E2H, Set1, Bank0, R/W Reset Value: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
Timer A prescaler bit (TAPSB)
TA CLK = fxx/(2^TAPSB)
Timer A clock source selection bit
0 = Internal clock source
1 = External clock source from TACLK
Not used for S3F8S19
Note: Prescaler values(TAPSB) above 12 are not valid.
Figure 11-2
PS031201-0813
LSB
Timer A Pre-scalar Register (TAPS)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
265
11.3 Function Description
This section includes:
x
Timer A interrupts
x
Interval timer function
x
Pulse width modulation mode
x
Capture mode
11.3.1 Timer A Interrupts
The timer A module can generate two interrupts:
x
Timer A overflow interrupt (TAOVF)
x
Timer A match/capture interrupt (TAINT)
Timer A overflow interrupt can be cleared by both software and hardware and match/capture interrupt pending
conditions are cleared by software when it has been serviced.
11.3.2 Interval Timer Function
The timer A module can generate an interrupt: the timer A match interrupt (TAINT).
When timer A interrupt occurs and is serviced by the CPU, the pending condition should be cleared by software.
In interval timer mode, a match signal is generated and TAOUT is toggled when the counter value is identical to
the value written to the Timer A reference data register, TADATA. The match signal generates a timer A match
interrupt and clears the counter.
If, for example, you write the value 10H to TADATA and 0BH to TACON, the counter increments until it reach 10H.
At this point the TA interrupt request is generated; resets the counter value, and resumes counting.
11.3.3 Pulse Width Modulation Mode
Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode lets you program the width (duration) of the pulse that is output at the
TAOUT pin. As in interval timer mode, a match signal is generated when the counter value is identical to the value
written to the timer A data register. In PWM mode, however, the match signal does not clear the counter. Instead,
it runs continuously, overflowing at 0xFFH, and then continues incrementing from 00H.
Although you can use the match signal to generate a timer A overflow interrupt, interrupts are not typically used in
PWM-type applications. Instead, the pulse at the TAOUT pin is held to Low level as long as the reference data
value is less than or equal to ( d ) the counter value. The pulse is held to High level for as long as the data value
is greater than (>) the counter value. One pulse width is equal to tCLK u 256.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
266
11.3.4 Capture Mode
In capture mode, a signal edge that is detected at the TACAP pin opens a gate and loads the current counter
value into the Timer A data register. You can select rising or falling edges to trigger this operation.
Timer A also gives you capture input source: the signal edge at the TACAP pin. You can select the capture input
by setting the value of the timer A capture input selection bit in P4CONL, (EAH, Set1 Bank1).
When P4CONL.7–.6 is 00, the TACAP input or normal input is selected.
You can use both types of timer A interrupts in capture mode: the timer A overflow interrupt is generated
whenever a counter overflow occurs; the timer A match/capture interrupt is generated when the counter value is
loaded into the Timer A data register.
By reading the captured data value in TADATA, and assuming a specific value for the timer A clock frequency,
you can calculate the pulse width (duration) of the signal that is being input at the TACAP pin.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
267
11.4 Block Diagram
Figure 11-3 illustrates the timer A functional block diagram.
TACON.4
TAPS.3-.0
TAPS.7
Overflow
Data Bus
prescaler
M
U
X
Pending
TACON.0
8
fx
TAOVF
8-bit Up-Counter
(Read Only)
Clear
TACON.5
TACK
8-bit Comparator
TACAP
M
U
X
Match
TACON.3
M
U
X
TAINT
Pending
TACON.1
TAOUT
Timer A Buffer Reg
Overflow
TAOVF
TACON.7.6
Timer A Data Register
(Read/Write)
CTL
In PWM mode
High level when data > counter
Low level when data < counter
TACON.7.6
8
Data Bus
NOTES:
When PWM mode, match signal cannot clear counter.
Figure 11-3
PS031201-0813
Timer A Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
268
12
STOP Wake-Up Timer
12.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller has a 10-bit STOP Wake-up Timer (SWT). The features of SWT are:
x
Use this only in STOP mode
x
Use Ring OSC as clock source
x
Generates interrupt to wake up CPU from STOP mode.
x
Selectable clock divider
12.1.1 Function Description
The SWT works only in stop mode. A 32 kHz internal Ring Oscillator works as its clock source in stop mode. The
SWT can wake up CPU from stop mode when the counter reaches 0x3FF. And then, CPU will continue to execute
the instruction next to STOP instruction after SWT interrupt service routine returns.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
269
12.1.2 STOP Wake-Up Timer Control Register
You can use the STOP Wake-up Timer Control Register (SWTCON) to:
x
Enable/Disable STOP Wake-up Timer
x
Interrupt Enable/Disable.
x
Program the clock pre-scalar for STOP Wake-up Timer.
SWTCON is located at address 10H, Page8, and is Read/Write addressable by using Register addressing mode.
A reset clears SWTCON to "00H". This disables STOP Wake-up Timer and STOP Wake-up interrupt.
You can enable STOP Wake-up Timer by writing a "1" to SWTCON.7. SWTCON.5 controls the STOP Wake-up
Timer interrupt when counter reaches to 0x3FF.
You can use SWTCON.3-0 to set the clock pre-scalar of STOP Wake-up Timer. You should not keep the clock
prescaler value of SWTPS more than 12. Any value more than 12 is invalid.
Figure 12-1 illustrates the STOP wake-up timer control register.
STOP Wake-up Timer Control Register (SWTCON)
10H, Page8, R/W; Reset Value: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
STOP Wake-up Timer enable bit:
0- Disable STOP Wake-up Timer
1- Enable STOP Wake-up Timer
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
STOP Wake-up Timer prescaler bit (SWTPSB)
SWTCLK = FCLK/(2^SWTPSB)
STOP Wake-up Timer Interrupt
Enable bit:
0- Disable Interrupt
1- Enable Interrupt
Note:
1. Prescaler values(SWTPSB) above 12 are not valid.
2. Bit .6 and bit .4 must be kept as default value þ0ÿ.
Figure 12-1
PS031201-0813
STOP Wake-Up Timer Control Register (SWTCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
270
Figure 12-2 illustrates the functional block diagram of STOP wake-up timer.
SWTPS.3-.0
Ring OSC
P
R
E
S
C
A
L
E
R
10-bit Up-Counter
SWTCON.7
= 0x3FF
Interrupt
SWTCON.5
Figure 12-2
STOP Wake-Up Timer Functional Block Diagram
Table 12-1 lists the STOP wake-up timer pre-scalar select.
Table 12-1
STOP Wake-Up Timer Presaler Select
SWTCON.3
SWTCON.2
SWTCON.1
SWTCON.0
Number of 32 kHz Ring
OSC Cycles
Typical Time-Out
0
0
0
0
2048
64 ms
0
0
0
1
4096
128 ms
0
0
1
0
8109
256 ms
0
0
1
1
16384
512 ms
0
1
0
0
32768
1024 ms
0
1
0
1
65536
2048 ms
0
1
1
0
131072
4096 ms
0
1
1
1
262144
8192 ms
1
0
0
0
524288
16384 ms
1
0
0
1
1048576
32768 ms
1
0
1
0
2097152
65536 ms
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
271
12.1.3 Stop Mode Wake Up
Before entering STOP mode, you should follow these steps to set up the STOP mode Wake-up Timer:
1. Enable Ring OSC by setting ROSCCON to 0xc0.
2. Enable STOP mode Wake-up Timer and its interrupt. Set the pre-scalar to determine the wake-up time.
3. Enter the STOP mode immediately after SWT starts.
The CPU then will stop and STOP Wake-up Timer Continues counting until it reaches 0x3FF (10-bit). The SWT
interrupt wakes CPU up and execute its interrupt service routine.
1. Disables STOP Wake-up Timer interrupt.
2. Does not allow other instructions.
3. Interrupt return.
Figure 12-3 illustrates the SWT operation sequence.
Enable Ring OSC
Enable SWT interrupt, set
prescaler and enable SWT
Main
Routin
e
STOP
Disable SWT
...
Interrupt
Service
Routine
Disable SWT interrupt
Return
Figure 12-3
PS031201-0813
SWT Operation Sequence
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Example 12-1
Using STOP Wake-Up Timer
;----------------->
VECTOR CCH, INT_SWT
;----------------->
ORG
DB
DB
DB
003CH
0FFH
0FFH
0FFH
; 003CH, must be initialized to FF
; 003DH, must be initialized to FF
; 003EH, Normal reset vector, ISP disabled
DB
018H
; 003FH, LVR disabled, external OSC
ORG
RESET: DI
LD
0100H
BTCON, #10100011B
; disable interrupt
; Watchdog disable
x
x
x
EI
; Enable interrupt
;----------------->
MAIN: x
x
x
SB1
LD
STPCON, #01011010B
LD
ROSCCON, #11000000B
; Ring OSC enabled
LD
LD
PP, #88H
SWTCON, #10100000B
; SWT enabled, interrupt enabled, SWTPSB=0
STOP
; Immediately after SWT enable
NOP
NOP
AND
SWTCON, #00001111B
LD
PP, #00H
x
x
x
JR
t, MAIN
; Disable SWT
;----------------->
INT_SWT:
LD
PP, #88H
AND
SWTCON, #00001111B
LD
IRET
PP, #00H
PS031201-0813
; Disable SWT interrupt
PRELIMINARY
272
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
273
13
16-Bit Timer 0/1/2/B
13.1 Overview
The 16-bit timer 0 is a 16-bit general-purpose timer/counter.
Timer 0 has two operating modes:
x
Interval timer mode (Toggle output at T0OUT pin): Only match interrupt occurs
x
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) mode (T0OUT/T0PWM pin): Match and overflow interrupt can occur
You can select one of these modes by using the appropriate T0CON setting:
The functional components of Timer 0 are:
x
Clock frequency divider with pre-scalar(T0PS)
x
16-bit counter, 16-bit comparator, and 16-bit reference data register (T0DATAH/L)
x
PWM or match output (T0OUT)
x
Timer 0 overflow interrupt (IRQ2, vector D6H) and match interrupt (IRQ2, vector D4H) generation
x
Timer 0 control register, T0CON (set 1, bank0, ECH, read/write)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
274
13.2 Timer 0 Control Register
You can use the timer 0 control register (T0CON) to:
x
Select the timer 0 operating mode (PWM mode or interval mode)
x
Select the timer 0 4 bits pre-scalar
x
Clear the timer 0 counter, T0CNT
x
Enable the timer 0 match/overflow interrupt
x
Start the timer 0
T0CON is located in set 1, Bank 0 at address ECH, and is read/write addressable that uses the Register
addressing mode.
A reset clears T0CON to "00H". This sets timer 0 to interval mode, selects fxx, stops timer 0, and disables all timer
0 interrupts. You can clear the timer 0 counter at any time during normal operation by writing a "1" to T0CON.3.
To enable the timer 0 match/overflow interrupt (IRQ2, vector D4H), you should write T0CON.7 and T0CON.5 to
"1". To generate the exact time interval, you should write T0CON.5 and 1, which clears counter and interrupt
pending bit. To detect an interrupt pending condition when T0INT is disabled, the application program should poll
the pending bit, T0CON.2. When a "1" is detected, a timer 0 match/overflow interrupt is pending. When the T0INT
sub-routine has been serviced, the pending condition must be cleared by software by writing a "0" to the timer 0
interrupt pending bit, T0CON.1.
Figure 13-1 illustrates the Timer 0 control register.
Timer 0 Control Register (T0CON)
ECH, Set 1, Bank 0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.1
.0
LSB
Timer 0 OVF Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer 0 match Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer 0 Operating Mode Selection Bits
00 = Interval mode (T0OUT mode)
01 = Not used
10 = Not used
11 = PWM mode(OVF interrupt can
occur)
Timer 0 counter clear bit:
0 = No effect
1 = Clear the timer 0 counter
(After clearing, return to zero)
.2
Timer 0 overflow interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable overflow interrupt
1 = Enable overflow interrrupt
Timer 0 match/capture interrupt
enable bit:
0 = Disable interrupt
1 = Enable interrrupt
Timer 0 start/stop bit:
0 = Stop timer 0
1 = Start timer 0
Figure 13-1
PS031201-0813
Timer 0 Control Register (T0CON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
275
Figure 13-2 illustrates the Timer 0 pre-scalar register.
Timer 0 Prescaler Register (T0PS)
EDH, Set1, Bank0, R/W Reset Value: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer 0 prescaler bit (T0PSB)
T0 CLK = fxx/(2^T0PSB)
Not used
Note: Prescaler values(T0PSB) above 12 are not valid.
Figure 13-2
PS031201-0813
Timer 0 Pre-scalar Register (T0PS)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
276
13.3 Block Diagram (Timer 0)
Figure 13-3 illustrates the functional block diagram of Timer 0.
T0CON.4
Overflow
Data Bus
T0PS.3-.0
Pending
T0CON.0
8
16-bit Up-Counter
(Read Only)
fx
T0OVF
Clear
T0CON.5
prescaler
16-bit Comparator
Match
T0CON.3
M
U
X
T0INT
Pending
T0CON.1
T0OUT
Timer 0 Buffer Reg
Overflow
T0OVF
Timer 0 Data Register
(Read/Write)
CTL
In PWM mode
High level when data > counter
Low level when data < counter
T0CON.7.6
8
Data Bus
NOTES:
When PWM mode, match signal cannot clear counter.
Figure 13-3
PS031201-0813
Timer 0 Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
277
13.4 Overview of 16-Bit Timer 1
The 16-bit timer 1 is a 16-bit general-purpose timer.
Timer 1 has three operating modes:
x
Interval timer mode (Toggle output at T1OUT pin)
x
Capture input mode with a rising or falling edge trigger at the T1CAP pin
x
PWM mode. PWM output shares their output port with T1OUT pin
You can select one of these modes can by using the appropriate T1CON setting:
The functional components of Timer 1 are:
x
External clock input pin (T1CLK)
x
Clock frequency divider with pre-scalar (T1PS)
x
A 16-bit counter (T1CNTH/L), a 16-bit comparator, and two 16-bit reference data register (T1DATAH/L)
x
I/O pins for capture input (T1CAP), or match output (T1OUT)
x
Timer 1 overflow interrupt (IRQ3, vector DAH) and match/capture interrupt (IRQ3, vector D8H) generation
x
Timer 1 control register, T1CON (set 1, Bank 0, F2H, read/write)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
278
13.5 Timer 1 Control Register
You use the timer 1 control register, T1CON, to:
x
Select the timer 1 operating mode (interval timer, capture mode, or PWM mode)
x
Select the timer 1 input clock frequency (T1PS)
x
Clear the timer 1 counter, T1CNTH/T 1CNTL
x
Enable the timer 1 overflow interrupt or timer 1 match/capture interrupt
T1CON is located in set 1 and bank 0 at address F2H, and is read/write addressable that uses the Register
addressing mode.
A reset clears T1CON to "00H". This sets timer 1 to normal interval timer mode. It selects an input clock frequency
of fxx, and disables all timer 1 interrupts. To disable the counter operation, set T1CON.4 to "0". You can clear the
timer 1 counter at any time during normal operation by writing a "1" to T1CON.5.
The timer 1 overflow interrupt (T1OVF) is interrupt level IRQ3 and has the vector address 0xDAH. When a timer 1
match/capture interrupt occurs and is serviced interrupt (IRQ3, vector DAH), you should write T1CON.1 to "0".
When a timer 1 overflow interrupt occurs and is serviced by the CPU, the pending condition is cleared
automatically by hardware or must be cleared by software.
To enable the timer 1 match/capture interrupt (IRQ3, vector D8H), you should write T1CON.3 to "1". To detect a
match/capture interrupt pending condition, the application program polls T1CON.1. When a "1" is detected, a timer
1 match or capture interrupt is pending. When the interrupt request has been serviced, the pending condition must
be cleared by software by writing a "0" to the timer 1 match/capture interrupt pending bit, T1CON.1.
Figure 13-4 illustrates the Timer 1 control register.
Timer 1 Control Register (T1CON)
F2H, Set 1, Bank 0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer 1 OVF Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer 1 Operating Mode Selection Bits
00 = Interval mode (T1OUT mode)
Timer 1 match Interrupt pending bit:
01 = Capture mode (capture on
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
rising edge, counter running, OVF
1 = Interrupt pending
can occur)
Timer
1 overflow interrupt enable bit:
10 = Capture mode (capture on
0
=
Disable
overflow interrupt
falling edge, counter running, OVF
1 = Enable overflow interrrupt
can occur)
11 = PWM mode(OVF interrupt can
Timer 1 match/capture interrupt
occur)
enable bit:
Timer 1 counter clear bit:
0 = No effect
0 = Disable interrupt
1 = Clear the timer 1 counter
1 = Enable interrrupt
(After clearing, return to
zero)
Timer 1 start/stop bit:
0 = Stop timer 1
1 = Start timer 1
Figure 13-4
PS031201-0813
Timer 1 Control Register (T1CON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
279
Figure 13-5 illustrates the Timer 1 pre-scalar register.
Timer 1 Prescaler Register (T1PS)
F3H, Set1, Bank0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
Timer 1 clock source selection bit
0 = Internal clock source
1 = External clock source from T1CLK
Not used
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer 1 prescaler bit (T1PSB)
T1 CLK = fxx/(2^T1PSB)
Note: Prescaler values(T1PSB) above 12 are not valid.
Figure 13-5
PS031201-0813
Timer 1 Pre-scalar Register (T1PS)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
280
13.6 Timer 1 Function Description
This section includes:
x
Timer 1 interrupts (IRQ3, Vectors D8H and DAH)
x
Interval timer mode
x
Pulse width modulation mode
x
Capture mode
13.6.1 Timer 1 Interrupts (IRQ3, Vectors D8H and DAH)
Timer 1 generates two interrupts:
x
Timer 1 overflow interrupt (T1OVF)
x
Timer 1 match/capture interrupt (T1INT)
T1OVF belongs to interrupt level IRQ3, vector DAH. T1INT belongs to interrupt level IRQ3, but is assigned the
separate vector address, D8H.
A timer 1 overflow interrupt pending condition is automatically cleared by hardware when it has been serviced or
should be cleared by software in the interrupt service routine by writing a "0" to the T1CON.0. However, the timer
1 match/capture interrupt pending condition must be cleared by the application's interrupt service routine by
writing a "0" to the T1CON.1.
13.6.2 Interval Timer Mode
In interval timer mode, a match signal is generated when the counter value is identical to the value written to the
timer 1 reference data register, T1DATAH/T1DATAL. The match signal generates a timer 1 match interrupt
(T1INT, vector D8H) and clears the counter.
If, for example, you write the value "1087H" to T1DATAH/T1DATAL, the counter will increment until it reaches
"1087H". At this point, the timer 1 interrupt request is generated, resets the counter value, and resumes counting.
With each match, the level of the signal at the timer 1 output pin is inverted.
13.6.3 Pulse Width Modulation Mode
PWM mode enables you to program the width (duration) of the pulse that is output at the T1OUT pin. As in interval
timer mode, a match signal is generated when the counter value is identical to the value written to the timer 1 data
register. However, in PWM mode, the match signal does not clear the counter. Instead, it runs continuously,
overflowing at "FFFFH", and then continues to increment from "0000H".
Although you can use the match signal to generate a timer 1 overflow interrupt, interrupts are not typically used in
PWM-type applications. Instead, the pulse at the T1PWM pin is held to Low level as long as the reference data
value is less than or equal to (d) the counter value. The pulse is held to High level for as long as the data value is
greater than (>) the counter value. One pulse width is equal to tCLK u 65536.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
281
13.6.4 Capture Mode
In capture mode, a signal edge that is detected at the T1CAP pin, opens a gate, and loads the current counter
value into the timer 1 data register. You can select rising or falling edges to trigger this operation.
Timer 1 also provides you with capture input source: The signal edge at the T1CAP pin. You can select the
capture input by setting the values of the timer 1 capture input selection bits in the port 3 control register,
P3CONH.7–.6 (set 1, bank 1, E8H). When P3CONH.7–.6 is "00", the T1CAP input is selected.
Both kinds of timer 1 interrupts can be used in capture mode: the timer 1 overflow interrupt is generated whenever
a counter overflow occurs. The timer 1 match/capture interrupt is generated whenever the counter value is loaded
into the timer 1 data register.
By reading the captured data value in T1DATAH/T1DATAL, and assuming a specific value for the timer 1 clock
frequency, you can calculate the pulse width (duration) of the signal that is being input at the T1CAP pin.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
282
13.7 Block Diagram (Timer 1)
Figure 13-6 illustrates the functional block diagram of Timer 1.
T1CON.4
T1PS.3-.0
T1PS.7
Overflow
Data Bus
prescaler
M
U
X
Pending
T1CON.0
8
fx
T1OVF
16-bit Up-Counter
(Read Only)
Clear
T1CON.5
T1CLK
16-bit Comparator
T1CAP
M
U
X
Match
T1CON.3
M
U
X
T1INT
Pending
T1CON.1
T1OUT
Timer 1 Buffer Reg
Overflow
T1OVF
T1CON.7.6
Timer 1 Data Register
(Read/Write)
CTL
In PWM mode
High level when data > counter
Low level when data < counter
T1CON.7.6
8
Data Bus
NOTES:
When PWM mode, match signal cannot clear counter.
Figure 13-6
PS031201-0813
Timer 1 Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
283
13.8 Overview of 16-Bit Timer 2
The 16-bit timer 2 is a 16-bit general-purpose timer.
Timer 2 has three operating modes:
x
Interval timer mode (Toggle output at T2OUT pin)
x
Capture input mode with a rising or falling edge trigger at the T2CAP pin
x
PWM mode (T2PWM): PWM output shares their output port with T2OUT pin
You can select of these modes by using the appropriate T2CON setting:
The functional components Timer 2 are:
x
Clock frequency divider with pre-scalar(T2PS)
x
External clock input pin (T2CLK)
x
A 16-bit counter (T2CNTH/L), a 16-bit comparator, and two 16-bit reference data register (T2DATAH/L)
x
I/O pins for capture input (T2CAP), or match output (T2OUT)
x
Timer 2 overflow interrupt (IRQ3, vector DEH) and match/capture interrupt (IRQ3, vector DCH) generation
x
Timer 2 control register, T2CON (set 1, Bank 1, F8H, read/write)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
284
13.9 Timer 2 Control Register
You use the timer 2 control register, T2CON, to:
x
Select the timer 2 operating mode (interval timer, capture mode, or PWM mode)
x
Select the timer 2 input clock frequency (T2PS)
x
Clear the timer 2 counter, T2CNTH/T 2CNTL
x
Enable the timer 2 overflow interrupt or timer 2 match/capture interrupt
T2CON is located in set 1 and bank 1 at address F8H, and is read/write addressable that uses Register
addressing mode.
A reset clears T2CON to '00H'. This sets timer 1 to normal interval timer mode, selects an input clock frequency of
fxx, and disables all timer 2 interrupts. To disable the counter operation, set T2CON.4 to "0". You can clear the
timer 2 counter at any time during normal operation by writing a "1" to T2CON.5.
The timer 2 overflow interrupt (T2OVF) is interrupt level IRQ3 and has the vector address 0xDEH. When a timer 2
match/capture interrupt occurs and is serviced interrupt (IRQ3, vector DEH), you should write T2CON.1 to "0".
When a timer 2 overflow interrupt occurs and is serviced by the CPU, the pending condition is cleared
automatically by hardware or must be cleared by software.
To enable the timer 2 match/capture interrupt (IRQ3, vector DCH), you should write T2CON.3 to "1". To detect a
match/capture interrupt pending condition, the application program polls T2CON.1. When a "1" is detected, a timer
2 match/capture interrupt is pending. When the interrupt request has been serviced, the pending condition must
be cleared by software by writing a "0" to the timer 2 match/capture interrupt pending bit, T2CON.1.
Figure 13-7 illustrates the Timer 2 control register.
Timer 2 Control Register (T2CON)
F8H, Set 1, Bank 0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer 2 OVF Interrupt pending bit:
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
1 = Interrupt pending
Timer 2 Operating Mode Selection Bits
00 = Interval mode (T2OUT mode)
Timer 2 match Interrupt pending bit:
01 = Capture mode (capture on
0 = No pending (clear pending bit when write)
rising edge, counter running, OVF
1 = Interrupt pending
can occur)
Timer
2 overflow interrupt enable bit:
10 = Capture mode (capture on
0 = Disable overflow interrupt
falling edge, counter running, OVF
1 = Enable overflow interrrupt
can occur)
11 = PWM mode(OVF interrupt can
Timer 2 match/capture interrupt
occur)
enable bit:
Timer 2 counter clear bit:
0 = No effect
0 = Disable interrupt
1 = Clear the timer 1 counter
1 = Enable interrrupt
(After clearing, return to
zero)
Timer 2 start/stop bit:
0 = Stop timer 2
1 = Start timer 2
Figure 13-7
PS031201-0813
Timer 2 Control Register (T2CON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
285
Figure 13-8 illustrates the Timer 2 pre-scalar register.
Timer 2 Prescaler Register (T2PS)
F9H, Set1, Bank0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
Timer 2 clock source selection bit
0 = Internal clock source
1 = External clock source from T2CLK
Not used
.2
.1
.0
Timer 2 prescaler bit (T2PSB)
T2 CLK = fxx/(2^T2PSB)
Note: Prescaler values(T2PSB) above 12 are not valid.
Figure 13-8
PS031201-0813
Timer 2 Pre-Scalar Register (T2PS)
PRELIMINARY
LSB
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
286
13.10 Timer 2 Function Description
This section includes:
x
Timer 2 interrupts (IRQ3, Vectors DCH and DEH)
x
Interval timer mode
x
Pulse width modulation mode
x
Capture mode
13.10.1 Timer 2 Interrupts (IRQ3, Vectors DCH and DEH)
Timer 2 generates two interrupts:
x
Timer 2 overflow interrupt (T2OVF)
x
Timer 2 match/capture interrupt (T2INT)
T2OVF is belongs to interrupt level IRQ3, vector DEH. T2INT also belongs to interrupt level IRQ3, but is assigned
the separate vector address, DCH.
A timer 2 overflow interrupt pending condition is automatically cleared by hardware when it has been serviced or
should be cleared by software in the interrupt service routine by writing a "0" to the T2CON.0. However, the timer
2 match/capture interrupt pending condition must be cleared by the application's interrupt service routine by
writing a "0" to the T2CON.1.
13.10.2 Interval Timer Mode
In interval timer mode, a match signal is generated when the counter value is identical to the value written to the
timer 2 reference data register, T2DATAH/T2DATAL. The match signal generates a timer 2 match interrupt
(T2INT, vector DCH) and clears the counter.
If, for example, you write the value "1087H" to T2DATAH/T2DATAL, the counter increment until it reaches
"1087H". At this point, the timer 2 interrupt request is generated, resets the counter value, and resumes counting.
With each match, the level of the signal at the timer 2 output pin is inverted.
13.10.3 Pulse Width Modulation Mode
PWM mode enables you to program the width (duration) of the pulse that is output at the T2OUT pin. As in interval
timer mode, a match signal is generated when the counter value is identical to the value written to the timer 2 data
register. However, in PWM mode, the match signal does not clear the counter. Instead, it runs continuously,
overflowing at "FFFFH", and then continues to increment from "0000H".
Although you can use the match signal to generate a timer 2 overflow interrupt, interrupts are not typically used in
PWM-type applications. Instead, the pulse at the T2OUT pin is held to Low level as long as the reference data
value is less than or equal to (d) the counter value. Then the pulse is held to High level for as long as the data
value is greater than (>) the counter value. One pulse width is equal to tCLK u 65536.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
287
13.10.4 Capture Mode
In capture mode, a signal edge that is detected at the T2CAP pin opens a gate and loads the current counter
value into the timer 2 data register. You can select rising or falling edges to trigger this operation.
Timer 2 also provides you with capture input source: The signal edge at the T2CAP pin. You can select the
capture input by setting the values of the timer 2 capture input selection bits in the port 3 control register,
P3CONH.3–.2 (set 1, bank 1, E4H). When P3CONH.3–.2 is "00", the T2CAP input is selected.
Both kinds of timer 2 interrupts can be used in capture mode: the timer 2 overflow interrupt is generated whenever
a counter overflow occurs. The timer 2 match/capture interrupt is generated whenever the counter value is loaded
into the timer 2 data register.
By reading the captured data value in T2DATAH/T2DATAL, and assuming a specific value for the timer 2 clock
frequency, you can calculate the pulse width (duration) of the signal that is being input at the T2CAP pin.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
288
13.11 Block Diagram (Timer 2)
Figure 13-9 illustrates the functional block diagram of Timer 2.
T2CON.4
T2PS.3-.0
T2PS.7
Overflow
Data Bus
prescaler
M
U
X
Pending
T2CON.0
8
fx
T2OVF
16-bit Up-Counter
(Read Only)
Clear
T2CON.5
T2CLK
16-bit Comparator
T2CAP
M
U
X
Match
T2CON.3
M
U
X
T2INT
Pending
T2CON.1
T2OUT
Timer 2 Buffer Reg
Overflow
CTL
In PWM mode
High level when data > counter
Low level when data < counter
T1OVF
T2CON.7.6
Timer 2 Data Register
(Read/Write)
T2CON.7.6
8
Data Bus
NOTES:
When PWM mode, match signal cannot clear counter.
Figure 13-9
PS031201-0813
Timer 2 Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
289
13.12 Overview of 16-Bit Timer B
The S3F8S19/F8S15 micro-controller has a 16-bit counter called timer B, which you can use to generate the
carrier frequency of a remote controller signal.
Timer B has four functions:
x
As a normal interval timer, generating a timer B interrupt at programmed time intervals.
x
To generate a programmable carrier pulse for a remote control signal at TBOUT.
x
To generate one shot pulse triggered by external input signal or software.
x
Emergency detection by external input trigger and stop PWM output automatically.
Figure 13-10 illustrates the Timer B control register.
Timer B Control Register (TBCON)
11H, Page 8, R/W, Reset value:00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Timer B output flip-flop control bit:
0 = TBOUT: low level for TBDATA0,
high level for TBDATA1,
1 = TBOUT high level for TBDATA0,
low level for TBDATA1
Timer B prescaler bit (TBPSB)
TB CLK = fxx/(2^TBPSB)
Timer B mode selection bit:
0 = One-shot mode
1 = Repeating mode
Timer B enable/disable bit:
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Timer B interrupt time selection bits:
00 = Disable interrupt
01 = Enable interrupt; generating after TBDATA0 is borrowed.
10 = Enable interrupt; generating after TBDATA1 is borrowed.
11 = Enable interrupt; generating after TBDATA0 and TBDATA1 is borrowed.
NOTE: Pending condition of timer B is cleared automatically by hardware.
Figure 13-10
PS031201-0813
Timer B Control Register
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
290
Figure 13-11 illustrates the Timer B trigger register.
Timer B Trigger Control Register (TBTRG)
16H, Page 8, R/W, Reset Value: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
Emergency detection pin
selection bit: ( rising edge)
00 = disable
01 = P34
10 = P35
11 = P36
.0
LSB
Timer B trigger control by software: (write
only, automatically cleared after write þ1ÿ
0 = Without one-shot pulse output trigger
1 = one-shot pulse is triggered
Trigger source selection bit:
00 = P00
01 = P01
10 = P02
11 = P03
Timer B trigger control by H/W or S/W:
0 = Hardware control( external input trigger)
1 = Software control (internal trigger)
Trigger pin valid edge selection :
0 0= Falling edge
01 = Rising edge
1X = Both falling and rising edge
Figure 13-11
Timer B Trigger Register (TBTRG)
Figure 13-12 illustrates the Timer B data registers (TBDATA0H/L).
Timer B Data Register, High-Byte (TBDATA0H)
12H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Reset Value: FFH
Timer B Data Register, Low-Byte (TBDATA0L)
13H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Reset Value: FFH
Figure 13-12
PS031201-0813
Timer B Data Registers (TBDATA0H/L)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
291
Figure 13-13 illustrates the Timer B data registers (TBDATA1H/L).
Timer B Data Register, High-Byte (TBDATA1H)
14H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Reset Value: FFH
Timer B Data Register, Low-Byte (TBDATA1L)
15H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Reset Value: FFH
Figure 13-13
PS031201-0813
Timer B Data Registers (TBDATA1H/L)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
292
13.13 Block Diagram (Timer B)
Figure 13-14 illustrates the functional block diagram of Timer B.
PG output signal
TBCON.2
TBCON.0
M
U
X
CLK
16-bit
Down Counter
MUX
To Other Block
(TBOUT)
Prescaler
Repeat Control
fx
MUX
TBCON.7-.5
TBTRG.3-.2
Interrupt Control
INT.GEN
TBTRG.5 -.4
P00
P01
P02
P03
Trig
Edge
select
M
U
X
P34
P35
P36
Emerg
Detect
M
U
X
TBTRG.7 -.6
TBCON.4-.3
16-bit Timer B Data
Register 0
16-bit Timer B Data
Register 1
M
U
X
8
Data Bus
TBTRG.0
TBTRG.1
NOTE:
The value of the TBDATA0H/L register is loaded into the 16-bit counter when the operation of the timer B
enabled. If a borrow occurs in the counter, the value of the TBDATA1 register is loaded into the 16-bit
counter. However, if the next borrow occurs, the value of the TBDATA0 register is loaded into the 16-bit
counter.
Figure 13-14
PS031201-0813
Timer B Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
IRQ1
(TBINT)
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
293
13.13.1 Timer B Pulse Width Calculations
tLOW
tHIGH
tLOW
To generate the above repeated waveform consisted of low period time, tLOW , and high period time, tHIGH:
When TBOF = 0,
tLOW = (TBDATA0 + 2) u 1/fx, 0H < TBDATA0 < 10000H, where fx = the selected clock.
tHIGH = (TBDATA1 + 2) u 1/fx, 0H < TBDATA1< 10000H, where fx = the selected clock.
When TBOF = 1,
tLOW = (TBDATA1 + 2) u 1/fx, 0H < TBDATA1 < 10000H, where fx = the selected clock.
tHIGH = (TBDATA0 + 2) u 1/fx, 0H < TBDATA0 < 10000H, where fx = the selected clock.
To make tLOW = 24 Ps and tHIGH = 15 Ps. fOSC = 4 MHz, fx = 4 MHz/4 = 1 MHz:
When TBOF = 0,
tLOW = 24 Ps = (TBDATA0 + 2)/fx = (TBDATA0 + 2) u 1 Ps, TBDATA0 = 22.
tHIGH = 15 Ps = (TBDATA1 + 2)/fx = (TBDATA1 + 2) u 1 Ps, TBDATA1 = 13.
When TBOF = 1,
tHIGH = 15 Ps = (TBDATA0 + 2)/fx = (TBDATA0 + 2) u 1 Ps, TBDATA0 = 13.
tLOW = 24 Ps = (TBDATA1 + 2)/fx = (TBDATA1 + 2) u 1 Ps, TBDATA1 = 22.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
294
Figure 13-15 illustrates the Timer B output flip-flop waveforms in repeat mode.
0H
Timer B Clock
Low
TBOF = '0'
TBDATA0 = 0000H
Or TBDATA1 = 0000H
High
TBOF = '1'
TBDATA0 = 0000H
Or TBDATA1 = 0000H
0H
100H
200H
Timer B Clock
TBOF = '1'
TBDATA0 = DEH
TBDATA1 = 1EH
E0H
TBOF = '0'
TBDATA0 = DEH
TBDATA1 = 1EH
E0H
TBOF = '1'
TBDATA0 = 7EH
TBDATA1 = 7EH
TBOF = '0'
TBDATA0 = 7EH
TBDATA1 = 7EH
Figure 13-15
PS031201-0813
20H
20H
80H
80H
80H
80H
Timer B Output Flip-Flop Waveforms in Repeat Mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
295
Example 13-1 sets Timer B to the repeat mode. It sets the oscillation frequency as the Timer B clock source, and
TBDATA0 and TBDATA1 to make a 38 kHz, 1/3 Duty carrier frequency.
Example 13-1
8.795 P s
To Generate 38 kHz, 1/3 Duty Signal through P2.1
17.59 P s
37.9 kHz 1/3 Duty
The program parameters are:
x
Timer B is used in repeat mode
x
Oscillation frequency is 4 MHz (0.25 Ps)
x
TBDATA0 = 17.59 Ps/0.25 Ps = 70.36, TBDATA1 = 8.795 Ps/0.25 Ps = 35.18
x
Set P2.1 to TBOUT mode.
ORG
START
0100H
;
Reset address
LD
TBDATA0H, #0
;
Set 17.5 Ps
LD
TBDATA0L, # (70-2)
LD
TBDATA1H, #0
;
Set 8.75 Ps
LD
TBDATA1, # (35-2)
LD
TBCON, #00000111B
;
Clock Source m fxx
LD
TBTRG, #0
;
Disable Timer B interrupt.
;
Select repeat mode for Timer B.
;
Start Timer B operation.
;
Set Timer B Output flip-flop (TBOF) high.
;
Set P4.1 to TBOUT mode.
;
this command generates 38 kHz, 1/3 duty pulse
signal through P4.1.
DI
•
•
•
SB1
OR
SB0
P4CONL, #00000100B
•
•
•
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Example 13-2 sets Timer B to the one shot mode. It sets the oscillation frequency as the Timer B clock source,296
and TBDATA1 and TBDATA0 to make a 40 Ps width pulse.
Example 13-2
To generate a one pulse signal through P2.1
This example sets Timer B to the one shot mode. It sets the oscillation frequency as the Timer B clock source,
and TBDATA1 and TBDATA0 to make a 40 Ps width pulse. The program parameters are:
Trigger
20 Ps
2 Ps
Here are the program parameters:
x
Timer B is used in one shot mode
x
Oscillation frequency is 4 MHz (1 clock = 0.25 Ps)
x
Delay time from trigger detection is 2 Ps
x
TBDATA1 = 20 Ps/0.25 Ps = 80, TBDATA0 = 2 Ps/0.25 = 8
x
Set P2.1 to TBPWM mode
ORG
START
0100H
;
Reset address
LD
TBDATA1H, # 0
;
Set 20 Ps
LD
TBDATA1L, # (80-2)
LD
TBDATA0H, # 0
;
Set 2 Ps
LD
TBDATA0L, # (8-2)
LD
TBCON, #00000101B
;
Clock Source m fOSC
;
Disable Timer B interrupt.
DI
•
•
•
SB1
OR
;
Select one shot mode for Timer B.
;
Enable Timer B operation.
;
Set Timer B output flip-flop (TBOF) high
P4CONL, #00000100B
;
Set P4.1 to TBOUT mode.
TBTRG, #0000010B
;
Set valid trigger source P0.0 falling edge.
;
Trigger by software.
SB0
Pulse_out:
LD
•
•
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
297
14
Watch Timer
14.1 Overview
Watch timer functions include real-time and watch-time measurements and interval timing for the system clock.
To start watch timer operation, set bit 1 of the watch timer control register, WTCON.1 to "1". If you want to service
watch timer overflow interrupt (IRQ4, vector E2H), then set the WTCON.6 to "1".The watch timer overflow interrupt
pending condition (WTCON.0) must be cleared by software in the application's interrupt service routine by writing
a "0" to the WTCON.0 interrupt pending bit. After the watch timer starts and elapses a time, the watch timer
interrupt pending bit (WTCON.0) is automatically set to "1". Interrupt requests commence in 1.995 ms, 0.125, 0.25,
and 0.5-second intervals by setting watch timer speed selection bits (WTCON.3–.2).
The watch timer can generate a steady 0.5 kHz, 1 kHz, 2 kHz, or 4 kHz signal to BUZ output pin for Buzzer. By
setting WTCON.3 and WTCON.2 to "11b", the watch timer functions in high-speed mode by generating an
interrupt every 1.995 ms. High-speed mode is useful for timing events for program debugging sequences.
The watch timer supplies the clock frequency for the LCD controller (f LCD). Therefore, if the watch timer is disabled,
the LCD controller does not operate.
The components of watch timer are:
x
Real Time and Watch-Time Measurement
x
Uses a Main Clock Source or Sub clock
x
Clock Source Generation for LCD Controller (fLCD)
x
I/O pin for Buzzer Output Frequency Generator (BUZ)
x
Timing Tests in High-Speed Mode
x
Watch timer overflow interrupt (IRQ4, vector E2H) generation
x
Watch timer control register, WTCON (set 1, bank 0, FAH, Read/Write)
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
298
14.1.1 Watch Timer Control Register
It uses watch timer control register (WTCON) to:
Select the watch timer interrupt time and Buzzer signal
Enable or disable the watch timer function
WTCON is located in set 1, bank 0 at address FAH, and is Read/Write addressable by using register addressing
mode.
A reset clears WTCON to "00H". This disables the watch timer.
Therefore, if you want to use the watch timer, you should write appropriate value to WTCON.
Figure 14-1 illustrates the watch timer control register.
Watch Timer Control Register (WTCON)
FAH, Set 1, Bank 0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
Watch timer INT Enable/Disable bit:
0 = Disable watch timer INT
1 = Enable watch timer INT
Buzzer signal selection bits:
00 = 0.5 kHz
01 = 1 kHz
10 = 2 kHz
11 = 4 kHz
PS031201-0813
.1
.0
LSB
Watch timer interrupt pending bit:
0 = Interrupt request is not pending
(Clear pending bit when write"0")
1 = Interrupt request is pending
Watch timer clock selection bit:
0 = Select main clock divided by 27 (fx/128)
1 = Select sub clock (fxt)
Figure 14-1
.2
Watch timer Enable/Disable bit:
0 = Disable watch timer
(Clear frequency dividing circuits)
1 = Enable watch timer
Watch timer speed selection bits:
00 = Set watch timer interrupt to 0.5 s
01 = Set watch timer interrupt to 0.25 s
10 = Set watch timer interrupt to 0.125 s
11 = Set watch timer interrupt to 1.995 ms
Watch Timer Control Register (WTCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
299
14.1.2 Watch Timer Circuit Diagram
Figure 14-2 illustrates the circuit diagram of watch timer.
WTCON.7
BUZ
WT INT
Enable/Disable
WTCON.6
WTCON.6
WTCON.5
MUX
WTCON.4
WTINT
fw/64 (0.5 kHz)
fw/32 (1 kHz)
fw/16 (2 kHz)
fw/8 (4 kHz)
8
WTCON.3
WTCON.2
WTCON.1
Enable/Disable
Selector
Circuit
WTCON.0
(Pending Bit)
(IRQ4)
WTCON.0
0.5sec
Clock
Selector
fw
32.768 kHz
Frequency
Dividing
Circuit
0.25sec
0.125sec
1.995msec
fLCD = 1024 Hz
fx = Main clock (where fx = 4.19 MHz)
fxt = Sub clock (32.768 kHz)
fxt
fx/128
fw = Watch timer frequency
Figure 14-2
PS031201-0813
Watch Timer Circuit Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
300
15
LCD Controller/Driver
15.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontroller can directly drive an up-to-128-dot (16 segments u 8 commons) LCD panel.
The components of LCD block are:
x
LCD controller/driver
x
Display Random Access Memory (RAM) (30H–45H) for storing display data in page 8
x
Six common/segment output pins (COM2/SEG0–COM7/SEG5)
x
Sixteen segment output pins (SEG6–SEG21)
x
Two common output pins (COM0–COM1)
x
Four LCD operating power supply pins (VLC0–VLC3)
x
LCD bias by voltage booster
x
LCD bias by voltage dividing resistors
The LCD control register, LCON, is used to turn the LCD display on and off; selects frame frequency, LCD duty
and bias, and LCD bias type. The LCD mode control register, LMOD, is used to select VLCD voltage. Data written
to the LCD display RAM can be automatically transferred to the segment signal pins without any program control.
When a subsystem clock is selected as the LCD clock source, the LCD display is enabled even in the main clock
stop or idle modes.
LCD data stored in the display RAM locations are transferred to the segment signal pins automatically without
program control.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
301
Figure 15-1 illustrates the LCD function diagram.
2
4
CA-CB
Vlc0-Vlc3
8-Bit Data Bus
COM0-COM1
2
LCD
Controller/Driver
8
6
COM2-COM7
/SEG0-SEG5
SEG6-SEG21
16
Figure 15-1
PS031201-0813
LCD Function Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
302
15.2 LCD Circuit Diagram
Figure 15-2 illustrates the LCD circuit diagram.
SEG21/P4.7
Port
Latch
SEG/Port
Driver
SEG17/P4.3
SEG13/P3.7
Data Bus
SEG6/P3.0
LCD
Display RAM
(830H-845H)
COM7/SEG5/P2.7
COM/Port
Driver
COM3/SEG1/P2.3
COM2/SEG0/P2.2
fLCD
COM1/P2.1
COM0/P2.0
Timing
Controller
LCON
LCD Voltage
Control
Figure 15-2
PS031201-0813
LCD Circuit Diagram
PRELIMINARY
VLC0
VLC1
VLC2
VLC3
CA
CB
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
303
15.3 LCD RAM Address Area
RAM addresses of 30H–45H page 8 are used as LCD data memory. These locations can be addressed by 1-bit or
8-bit instructions. When the bit value of a display segment is "1", the LCD display is turned on; when the bit value
is "0", the display is turned off.
Display RAM data are sent out through the segment pins, SEG0–SEG21 by using the direct memory access
(DMA) method that is synchronized with the f LCD signal. RAM addresses in this location that are not used for LCD
display can be allocated to general-purpose use.
Figure 15-3 illustrates the LCD display data Ram organization.
COM
Bit
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
SEG4
------
SEG20
SEG21
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3
COM4
COM5
COM6
COM7
.0
.1
.2
.3
.4
.5
.6
.7
830H
831H
832H
833H
834H
------
844H
845H
Figure 15-3
PS031201-0813
LCD Display Data RAM Organization
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
304
15.4 LCD Control Register (LCON)
A LCON is located in set 1, bank 1 at address FDH, and is read/write addressable by using register addressing
mode. It has the following control functions.
x
LCD duty and bias selection
x
LCD clock selection
x
LCD display control
x
Internal/External LCD dividing resistors or capacitor bias selection
The LCON register is used to turn the LCD display on/off, to select duty and bias, to select LCD clock.
A reset clears the LCON registers to "00H" by:
x
Configuring LCD display off
x
Selecting 1/8 duty and 1/4 bias
x
Selecting 128 Hz for LCD clock
x
Not selecting any LCD bias type
The LCD clock signal determines the frequency of COM signal scanning of each segment output. This is also
referred as the LCD frame frequency. Since the LCD clock is generated by watch timer clock (fw). The watch timer
should be enabled when the LCD display is turned on.
NOTE: The clock and duty for LCD controller/driver is automatically initialized by hardware, whenever LCON register data
value is re-write. Therefore, the LCON register does not re-write frequently.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
305
Figure 15-4 illustrates the LCD control register (LCON).
LCD Control Register (LCON)
FDH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
LCD clock selection bits:
00 = fw/28 (128 Hz)
01 = fw/27 (256 Hz)
10 = fw/26 (512 Hz)
11 = fw/25 (1024 Hz)
.2
.1
.0
LSB
LCD display control bit:
0 = All LCD signals are low
1 = Turn display on
LCD bias type selection bits:
LCD duty and bias selection bits:
000 = 1/8 duty, 1/4 bias
001 = 1/4 duty, 1/3 bias
010 = 1/3 duty, 1/3 bias
011 = 1/3 duty, 1/2 bias
1xx = 1/2 duty, 1/2 bias
00 = LCD invalid.(VLC0-VLC3, CA and CB pins are normal I/O pin)
01 = Cap bias.( VLC0-VLC3, CA and CB pins are bias pin)
10 = Internal resistor bias (The voltage booster is always stopped and
Cut off; VLC0-VLC3, CA and CB pins are normal I/O pin)
11 = External resistor bias (The voltage booster is always stopped and
Cut off, VLC0-VLC3 are bias pin, CA and CB pins are normal I/O pin)
Note:
1. When LCON.2-.1 are selected to ‘01’, P1.0 - .5 are automatically selected to VLCn, CA and CB pin. (n = 0-3)
When LCON.2-.1 are capacitor bias selected, LCON.0 is select to ‘1’ after 1 millisecond delay.
Refer to program tip in next page.
2. When LCON.2-.1 are selected to ‘10’, P1.0 - .5 depend on P1CONH/L register.
3. When LCON.2-.1 are selected to ‘11’, P1.2 - .5 are automatically selected to VLCn. (n = 0-3)
CA and CB pins depend on P1CONL register.
Figure 15-4
PS031201-0813
LCD Control Register (LCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
306
15.5 LCD Mode Control Register (LMOD)
A LMOD is located in set 1, bank 0 at address FCH, and is read/write addressable by using Register addressing
mode. The control function of LMOD is VLCD voltage selection.
The LMOD register is used to select VLCD voltage. A reset clears the LMOD registers to "00H" by configuring
select 3.6 V (when 1/4 bias) for VLCD voltage.
Figure 15-5 illustrates the LCD mode control register.
LCD Mode Control Register (LMOD)
FCH, Set 1, Bank 1, R/W
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
VLCD Voltage Selection Bits:
(Only when the capacitor bias is selected)
Not used but keep always '0'
1/4 bias
000 3.6V
001 3.8V
010 4.0V
011 4.2V
100 4.4V
101 4.6V
110 4.8V
111 5.0V
Figure 15-5
PS031201-0813
LCD Mode Control Register (LMOD)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
307
15.6 Internal Resistor Bias Pin Connection
Figure 15-6 illustrates the internal resistor bias pin connection.
1/4 Bias
1/3 Bias
VDD
VDD
LCON.0
LCON.0
V LC0
V LC0
R
V LC1
V LC1
R
V LC2
R
V LC3
V LC2
V LCD
V LC3
R
CA
NC
CB
R
R
V LCD
R
VSS
NC
R
VSS
NC
CA
NC
CB
LCON.2-.1 = "10": Select internal resistor bias
LCON.2-.1 = "10": Select internal resistor bias
1/2 Bias
VDD
LCON.0
V LC0
V LC1
V LC2
V LC3
R
R
2R
2R
V LCD
VSS
NC
CA
NC
CB
LCON.2-.1 = "10": Select internal resistor bias
NOTES:
1. The VLC0, VLC1, VLC2, VLC3, CA and CB pins are not connected when the
internal resistor bias is selected.
Figure 15-6
PS031201-0813
Internal Resistor Bias Pin Connection
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
308
15.7 External Resistor Bias Pin Connection
Figure 15-7 illustrates the external resistor bias pin connection.
1/4 Bias
1/3 Bias
VDD
VDD
LCON.0
R`
R`
R`
LCON.0
VLC0
VLC0
VLC1
VLC1
R`
VLC2
VLCD
R`
VLC3
R`
VLC2
VLC3
R`
VSS
VSS
NC
CA
NC
CA
NC
LCON.2-.1 = "11": Select external resistor bias
(Disable internal resistors)
CB
NC
CB
LCON.2-.1 = "11": Select external resistor bias
(Disable internal resistors)
1/2 Bias
VDD
LCON.0
VLC0
VLC1
VLC2
R`
VLCD
VLC3
VLCD
R`
VSS
NC
CA
NC
CB
LCON.2-.1 = "11": Select external resistor bias
(Disable internal resistors)
NOTES:
1. The CA and CB pins are not connected when the external resistor bias is selected.
2. VLC0 and VLC1 should be connected at 1/3 bias.
3. VLC0, VLC1, and VLC2 should be connected at 1/2 bias.
Figure 15-7
PS031201-0813
External Resistor Bias Pin Connection
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
309
15.8 Capacitor Bias Pin Connection
Figure 15-8 illustrates the capacitor bias pin connection.
1/3 Bias
1/4 Bias
VLC0
VLC0
0.1uF
VLC1
0.1uF
VLC2
0.1uF
VLC3
0.1uF
VLC1
0.1uF
VLC2
0.1uF
V LC
D
VLC3
0.1uF
VS
S
VS
S
CA
CA
0.1uF
LCON.2-.1 = "0x": Select capacitor bias
0.1uF
LCON.2-.1 = "0x": Select capacitor bias
CB
CB
1/2 Bias
VLC0
VLC1
VLC2
0.1uF
VLC3
0.1uF
V LC
D
V LC
D
VS
S
CA
0.1uF
LCON.2-.1 = "0x": Select capacitor bias
CB
NOTES:
1. VLC0 and VLC1 should be connected at 1/3 bias.
2. VLC0, VLC1, and VLC2 should be connected at 1/2 bias.
Figure 15-8
PS031201-0813
Capacitor Bias Pin Connection
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
310
15.9 Common (COM) Signals
The common signal output pin selection (COM pin selection) varies according to the selected duty cycle.
x
In 1/8 duty mode, COM0-COM7 (SEG6–SEG21) pins are selected.
x
In 1/4 duty mode, COM0-COM3 (SEG2–SEG21) pins are selected.
x
In 1/3 duty mode, COM0-COM2 (SEG1–SEG21) pins are selected.
x
In 1/2 duty mode, COM0-COM1 (SEG0–SEG21) pins are selected.
15.10 Segment (SEG) Signals
The 22 LCD segment signal pins are connected to corresponding display RAM locations at page 8. Bits of the
display RAM are synchronized with the common signal output pins.
When the bit value of a display RAM location is "1", a select signal is sent to the corresponding segment pin.
When the display bit is "0", it sends a 'no-select' signal to the corresponding segment pin.
Figure 15-9 illustrates the select/no-select signal in 1/2 duty, 1/2 bias display mode.
Select
Non-Select
FR
1 Frame
VLC0,1,2
COM
VLC3
V SS
VLC0,1,2
SEG
VLC3
V SS
VLC0,1,2
VLC3
COM-SEG
V SS
-VLC3
-VLC0,1,2
Figure 15-9
PS031201-0813
Select/No-Select Signal in 1/2 Duty, 1/2 Bias Display Mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
311
Figure 15-10 illustrates the select/no-select signal in 1/3 duty, 1/3 bias display mode.
Select
Non-Select
FR
1 Frame
COM
VLC0,1
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
SEG
VLC0,1
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
COM-SEG
VLC0,1
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
-VLC3
-VLC2
-VLC0,1
Figure 15-10
PS031201-0813
Select/No-Select Signal in 1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias Display Mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
312
Figure 15-11 illustrates the LCD signal waveforms (1/2 Duty, 1/2 Bias).
COM0
0
1
0
1
SEG0
VLC0
VSS
1 Frame
VLC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
COM1
COM0
VLC3
VSS
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
VLC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
COM1
VLC3
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
SEG0
VLC3
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
SEG1
VLC3
VSS
+V LC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
+V LC3
SEG0-COM0
0V
-V LC3
-V LC0 (VLC1,VLC2)
NOTE:
Figure 15-11
PS031201-0813
VLC0 = VLC1,VLC2
LCD Signal Waveforms (1/2 Duty, 1/2 Bias)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
313
Figure 15-12 illustrates the LCD signal waveforms (1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias).
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
0
1
2
0
1
2
VLC0
VSS
COM0
1 Frame
VLC0 (VLC1)
VLC2
COM1
COM0
VLC3
COM2
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1)
VLC2
COM1
VLC3
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1)
VLC2
COM2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1)
VLC2
SEG1
VLC3
VSS
VLC0 (VLC1)
VLC2
SEG2
VLC3
VSS
+V LC0(VLC1)
+V LC2
+V LC3
0V
SEG1-COM0
- V LC3
- V LC2
- V LC0(VLC1)
NOTE:
Figure 15-12
PS031201-0813
VLC0 = VLC1
LCD Signal Waveforms (1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
314
Figure 15-13 illustrates the LCD signal waveforms (1/4 Duty, 1/3 Bias).
SEG2
SEG3
0
1
2
3
0
1
2
3
VLC0
VSS
COM0
1 Frame
COM1
VLC0(VLC1)
COM2
VLC2
COM0
VLC3
COM3
VSS
VLC0(VLC1)
VLC2
COM1
VLC3
VSS
VLC0(VLC1)
VLC2
COM2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0(VLC1)
VLC2
VLC3
COM3
VSS
VLC0(VLC1)
VLC2
SEG2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0(VLC1)
VLC2
SEG3
VLC3
VSS
+V LC0(VLC1)
+V LC2
+V LC3
0V
COM0-SEG2
- V LC3
- V LC2
- V LC0(VLC1)
NOTE:
Figure 15-13
PS031201-0813
VLC0 = VLC1
LCD Signal Waveforms (1/4 Duty, 1/3 Bias)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
315
Figure 15-14 illustrates the LCD signal waveforms (1/8 Duty, 1/4 Bias).
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3
COM4
COM5
COM6
COM7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
VLC0
VSS
FR
1 Frame
VLC0
S
E
G
6
S
E
G
7
S
E
G
8
S S
E E
G G
9 10
VLC1
COM0
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0
VLC1
COM1
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0
VLC1
COM2
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
VLC0
VLC1
SEG6
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
+VLC0
+VLC1
+VLC2
+VLC3
SEG6-COM0
0V
-VLC3
-VLC2
-VLC1
-VLC0
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
316
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
VLC0
VSS
FR
1 Frame
VLC0
VLC1
SEG7
VLC2
VLC3
VSS
+VLC0
+VLC1
+VLC2
+VLC3
SEG7-COM0
0V
-VLC3
-VLC2
-VLC1
-VLC0
Figure 15-14
PS031201-0813
LCD Signal Waveforms (1/8 Duty, 1/4 Bias)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Example 15-1 shows how to display LCD ON, after it selects Capacitor Bias.
Example 15-1
LCD Display on, After Capacitor Bias Selected
This example shows how to display on after capacitor bias selected:
x
x
x
LCD_cap_bias
AND
LCON, #0FBH
OR
LCON, #02H
; Capacitor bias select
CALL
Delay1Ms
; Delay 1ms
OR
LCON, #01H
; Turn on LCD display
RET
x
x
x
Delay1mS
LD
R0, #20H
DEL
NOP
DJNZ
R0, DEL
RET
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
317
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
318
16
Analog/Digital Converter
16.1 Overview
A 10-bit A/D converter (ADC) module uses successive approximation logic to convert analog levels by entering at
one of the eight input channels equivalent to 10-bit digital values. The analog input level should lie between the
VDD and VSS values.
x
The components A/D converter contains: Analog comparator with successive approximation logic
x
Digital to analog (D/A) converter logic
x
ADC control register (ADCON)
x
Eight multiplexed analog data input pins (ADC0–ADC9)
x
10-bit A/D conversion data output register (ADDATAH/L)
The procedure to initiate an analog-to-digital conversion is:
x
Write the channel selection data in the ADCON register to select one of the 16 analog input pins
(ADCn, n = 0–15).
x
Set the conversion start or enable bit, ADCON.0. The Read/Write ADCON register is placed in D2H, Set1.
During a normal conversion, ADC logic initially sets the successive approximation register to 200H (the
approximate half-way point of a 10-bit register). This register is then updated automatically during each conversion
step. The successive approximation block performs 10-bit conversions for one input channel at a time. You can
dynamically select different channels by manipulating the channel selection bit value (ADCON.7–4) in the ADCON
register. To start the A/D conversion, you should set the enable bit, ADCON.0.
When a conversion is completed, ACON.3, the end-of-conversion (EOC) bit is automatically set to 1 and the result
is dumped into the ADDATA register where it can be read. The A/D converter then enters an idle state. Ensure to
read the contents of ADDATA before another conversion starts. Otherwise, it will overwrite the previous result by
the next conversion result.
NOTE: As the ADC does not use sample-and-hold circuitry, it is important that any fluctuations in the analog level at the
ADC0 – ADC9 input pins during a conversion procedure be kept to an absolute minimum. Any change in the input
level due to circuit noise invalidates the result.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
319
16.1.1 Using A/D Pins for Standard digital Input
You can alternatively use the inputs pins of ADC module as digital input in port 0.
16.1.2 A/D Converter Control Register (ADCON)
The A/D converter control register, ADCON, is located at address D2H.
ADCON has four functions:
x
Bits 7-4 select an analog input pin (ADC0–ADC9).
x
Bit 3 indicates the status of the A/D conversion.
x
Bits 2-1 select a conversion speed.
x
Bit 0 starts the A/D conversion.
You can select only one analog input channel at a time at a time. You can dynamically select any one of the eight
analog input pins (ADC0–ADC9) by manipulating the 4-bit value for ADCON.7–ADCON.4.
Figure 16-1 illustrates the A/D converter control register (ADCON).
A/D Converter Control Register (ADCON)
D2H, SET 1, BANK 0, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
ADC0 (P0.0)
ADC1 (P0.1)
ADC2 (P0.2)
ADC3 (P0.3)
ADC4 (P0.4)
ADC5 (P0.5)
ADC6 (P0.6)
ADC7 (P0.7)
ADC8 (P1.7)
ADC9 (P1.6)
Invalid
.0
LSB
Conversion start bit:
0 = No effect
1 = A/D conversion start
A/D Conversion input pin selection bits
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
Other value
.1
Conversion speed selection bits: (note)
00 = fOSC/16
01 = fOSC/8
10 = fOSC/4
11 = fOSC/1 (fOSC < 4 MHz)
End-of-conversion (EOC) status bit:
0 = A/D conversion is in progress
1 = A/D conversion complete
NOTE:
1. Maximum ADC clock input = 4 MHz
Figure 16-1
PS031201-0813
A/D Converter Control Register (ADCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
320
16.1.3 Internal Reference Voltage Levels
In the ADC function block, it compares the analog input voltage to the reference voltage. The analog input level
must remain within the range VSS to VDD.
It generates different reference voltage levels internally along with the resistor tree during the analog conversion
process for each conversion step. The reference voltage level for the first bit conversion is always 1/2 VDD.
Figure 16-2 illustrates the circuit diagram of A/D converter.
A/D Converter Control Register
ADCON (D2H)
ADCON.0 (ADEN)
ADCON.7-.4
Control
Circuit
M
U
L
T
I
P
L
E
X
E
R
ADC0/P0.0
ADC1/P0.1
ADC2/P0.2
ADC7/P0.7
ADC8/P1.6
ADC9/P1.7
Clock
Selector
ADCON.3
(EOC Flag)
ADCON.2-.1
Successive
Approximation
Circuit
+
-
VDD
Conversion Result
VSS
ADDATAH
Analog
(D0H)
Comparator
D/A Converter
ADDATAL
(D1H)
To data bus
Figure 16-2
A/D Converter Circuit Diagram
Figure 16-3 illustrates the A/D converter data register.
ADDATAH
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
ADDATAL
MSB
-
-
-
-
-
-
.1
.0
LSB
Figure 16-3
PS031201-0813
A/D Converter Data Register (ADDATAH/L)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
321
Figure 16-4 illustrates the timing diagram of A/D converter.
ADCON.0
1
50 ADC Clock
Conversion
Start
EOC
...
ADDATA
9
Previous
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
ADDATAH (8-Bit) + ADDATAL (2-Bit)
Value
0
Valid
Data
40 Clock
Set up
time
10 clock
Figure 16-4
PS031201-0813
1
A/D Converter Timing Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
322
16.1.4 Conversion timing
The A/D conversion process requires four steps (four clock edges) to convert each bit and 10 clocks to step-up
A/D conversion. Therefore, it requires total 50 clocks to complete a 10-bit conversion: With a 10 MHz CPU clock
frequency, one clock cycle is 400 ns (4/fxx). If each bit conversion requires four clocks, the conversion rate is
calculated as:
x
4 clocks/bit u 10-bits + step-up time (10 clock) = 50 clocks
x
50 clock u 400 ns = 20 Ps at 10 MHz, 1 clock time = 4/fxx (assuming ADCON.2–.1 = 10)
16.1.5 Internal A/D Conversion Procedure
The procedure for internal A/D Conversion is:
1. Analog input must remain between the voltage range of VSS and VDD.
2. Configure the analog input pins to input mode by making the appropriate settings in P0CONH, P0CONL
registers.
3. Before the conversion operation starts, you must first select one of the eight input pins (ADC0–ADC7) by
writing the appropriate value to the ADCON register.
4. It completes the conversion, (50 clocks have elapsed), set the EOC flag to "1", so that a check can be made
to verify that the conversion was successful.
5. Loads the converted digital value to the output register, ADDATAH (8-bit) and ADDATAL (2-bit), and then
the ADC module enters an idle state.
6. You can now read the digital conversion result from the ADDATAH and ADDATAL register.
Figure 16-5 illustrates the recommended A/D converter circuit for highest absolute accuracy.
VDD
XIN
Analog
Input Pin
ADC0-ADC9
XOUT
101
S3F8S19
VSS
Figure 16-5
PS031201-0813
Recommended A/D Converter Circuit for Highest Absolute Accuracy
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
323
Example 16-1 shows configuring A/D converter.
Example 16-1
Configuring A/D Converter
;----------------->
VECTOR
CEH, INT_TIMER A
;-------------->
RESET:
ORG
DB
DB
DB
DB
003CH
0FFH
0FFH
0FFH
0FFH
ORG
DI
LD
0100H
x
x
x
LD
LD
;
;
;
;
003CH, must be initialized to FF
003DH, must be initialized to FF
003EH,
003FH, enable LVR 3.9V, internal RC oscillator 8MHz
BTCON, #10100011B
; disable interrupt
; Watchdog disable
P0CONH, #10101010B
P0CONL, #10101010B
; Configure P0.4–P0.7 AD input
; Configure P0.0–P0.3 AD input
EI
; Enable interrupt
;-------------->
MAIN:
x
x
x
CALL
AD_CONV:
AD_CONV
; Subroutine for AD conversion
x
x
x
JR
t, MAIN
;
LD
ADCON, #00000001B
; Select analog input channel o P0.0
; select conversion speed o fOSC/16
; set conversion start bit
NOP
; If you select conversion speed to fOSC/16
at least one NOP must be included
CONV_LOOP:
TM
JR
LD
ADCON, #00001000B
Z, CONV_LOOP
R0, ADDATAH
; Check EOC flag
; If EOC flag=0, jump to CONV_LOOP until EOC flag=1
; High 8 bits of conversion result are stored
to ADDATAH register
LD
R1, ADDATAL
LD
ADCON, #00010011B
; Low 2 bits of conversion result are stored
to ADDATAL register
; Select analog input channel o P0.1
; Select conversion speed o fOSC/8
; Set conversion start bit
CONV_LOOP2:
TM
JR
LD
LD
ADCON, #00001000B
Z, CONV_LOOP2
R2, ADDATAH
R3, ADDATAL
; Check EOC flag
x
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
INT_TIMERA:
324
x
x
RET
;
x
x
x
IRET
;
;
; Pending bit clear
;
x
x
END
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
325
17
Serial Peripheral Interface
17.1 Overview
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) allows high-speed synchronous data transfer between the Micro controller
(MCU) and peripheral devices or between several Samsung devices.
x
Full-duplex, 4-wire Synchronous Data Transfer
x
Master or Slave Operation
x
Least Significant Bit (LSB) First or Most Significant Bit (MSB) First Data Transfer
x
End of Transmission Interrupt Flag
x
Write Collision Flag Protection
x
Mode Fault Flag bit
x
Wake-up from Idle Mode
x
Double Speed Master SPI Mode
The S3F8S19/F8S15 SPI circuit supports byte serial transfers in either Master or Slave modes. Figure 17-1.
Illustrates the block diagram of the SPI circuit the block contains buffer for receive data for maximum flexibility and
throughput. You can configure S3F8S19/F8S15as either an SPI Master or Slave. The external interface consists
of Master-Out/Slave-In (MOSI), Master-In/Slave-Out (MISO), Serial Clock (SCK), and Slave Select (NSS). You get
the receive buffer contents by reading the SPI Data register (Refer to Figure 17-5 for more information).
You can activate the SPI modes by setting the appropriate bits in the SPI Control Register (Refer to Figure 17-5
for more information).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
326
Figure 17-1 illustrates the block diagram of SPI.
Data Bus
Write
MISO
MOSI
Master/Slave
Control
8-bit shift register
NSS
SCK
RX Buffer
Internal SCK
Data Bus
Read
Figure 17-1
SPI Block Diagram
Figure 17-2 illustrates the data timing of SPI.
SCK(CPOL=0)
SCK(CPOL=1)
NSS
CPHA=1:
MOSI/MISO
MSB
LSB
Data Capture Strobe
Interrupt Issued
CPHA=0:
MOSI/MISO
MSB
LSB
Data Capture Strobe
Interrupt Issued
Figure 17-2
PS031201-0813
SPI Data Timing
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
327
17.2 Operation as an SPI Master
SPI Master can initiate a byte/data transfer and this is done by the Master writing to the SPI Data register. The
Master shifts out 8 bits of data along with the serial clock SCK for the Slave. The Master's outgoing byte is
replaced with an incoming one from a Slave device. When the last bit is received, the shift register contents are
transferred to the Receive Buffer and an interrupt is generated. The receive data must be read form the SPI Data
Register before it transfers the next bye of data to the receive buffer or data is lost.
When operating as a Master, an active LOW Slave Select (NSS) must be generated to enable a Slave for a byte
transfer. This Slave Select is generated under firmware control, and is not part of the SPI internal hardware. any
available General purpose input output pin (GPIO) can be used for the Master's Slave Select Output.
When the Master writes to the SPI Data Register and if the shift register is not busy shifting a previous byte, then it
loads the data into the shift register and begins the shifting. If the shift register is busy, then it generates a write
collision error. The transfer continues undisturbed, and the write data that caused the error is not written to the
shifter.
The byte shifting and SCK generation are handled by the hardware (based on firmware selection of the clock
source). Data is shifted out on the MOSI pin and the serial clock is output on the SCK pin. Data is received from
the slave on the MISO pin.
17.3 Master SCK Selection
The Master SCK is programmable to one of eight clock settings, as described in Table 17-2. The frequency is
selected with the Clock Select Bits of SPI control register and Double SPI Speed Bit of SPI status register. The
hardware provides eight output clocks on the SCK pin for each byte transfer. Clock phase and polarity are
selected by the CPHA and CPOL control bits (Refer to Figure 17-3 for more information).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
328
17.4 Operation as an SPI Slave
In Slave mode, the chip receives SCK from an external master on pin P3.2. Data from the master is shifted in on
the MOSI pin, while data is being shifted out of the slave on the MISO pin. Additionally, it should assert the active
LOW Slave Select to enable the slave for transmit. The Slave Select pin is P3.3. These pins are automatically
configured by enabling SPI Enable bit.
In Slave mode, the data written to the SPI Data Register will be loaded into the shift register, only if the Slave
Select is asserted (NSS LOW) and the shift register is not busy shifting a previous byte. If the register is busy, a
write collision error is generated. The transfer continues undisturbed, and the write data that caused the error is
not written to the shifter. If the Slave Select is not active when the data is loaded, data is not transferred to the
shift register until Slave Select is asserted.
If the Slave Select is de-asserted before a byte transfer is complete, the transfer is aborted and no interrupt is
generated. Whenever Slave Select is asserted, the data is automatically reloaded into the shift register.
You must select the clock phase and polarity to match the SPI master, using the control bits of SPICON
(Refer to Figure 17-3 for more information).
The SPI slave logic continues to operate in suspend, so if it enables the SPI interrupt, the device can go into
suspend during a SPI slave transaction, and it wakes up at the interrupt that signals the end of the byte transfer.
17.5 SPI Status and Control
Figure 17-3 illustrates the SPI control register. Figure 17-2 illustrates the timing diagram that shows the clock and
data states for the various SPI modes.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
329
17.6 SPI Interrupt
For SPI, an interrupt request is generated after a byte is received or transmitted. After the interrupt, the received
data byte can be read from the SPI Data Register and the SPI interrupt flag bit is high.
Table 17-1 describes the SPI pin assignment.
Table 17-1
SPI Function
SPI Pin Assignment
GPIO Pin
Comment
Slave Select (NSS)
P3.3
For Master Mode, Firmware sets NSS, can be used as
GPIO pin. For Slave Mode, NSS is an active LOW input.
Master Out, Slave In (MOSI)
P3.1
Data output for master, data input for slave.
Master In, Slave Out (MISO)
P3.0
Data input for master, data output for slave.
SCK
P3.2
SPI Clock: Output for master, input for slave.
Table 17-2 lists the SCK rate selection.
Table 17-2
SCK Rate Selection
SPICON.1–0
SPISTAT.0
SCK Rate
00
1
Fosc/2
00
0
Fosc/4
01
1
Fosc/8
01
0
Fosc/16
10
1
Fosc/32
10
0
Fosc/64
11
1
Fosc/128
11
0
Fosc/256
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
330
17.7 SPI System Errors
Two system errors can be detected by the SPI system. The first type of error arises in a multiple-master system
when multiple SPI devices simultaneously try to be a master. This error is called a mode fault. The second type of
error, write collision, indicates that an attempt was made to write data to the SPIDATA, while a transfer was in
progress.
When the SPI system is configured as a master and the NSS input line goes to active low, a mode fault error has
occurred-usually because two devices have attempted to act as master at the same time. In cases where more
than one device is concurrently configured as a master, there is a chance of contention between two pin drivers.
For push-pull CMOS drivers, this contention can cause permanent damage. The mode fault mechanism attempts
to protect the device by disabling the drivers. It clears the master/slave selection bit in the SPICON and all four
P3CON control bits that are associated with the SPI. If NSS is an input and is driven low when the SPI is in Master
mode, this will also set the SPI Interrupt Flag. SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding
interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, the SPIF bit is cleared by reading the SPI Status Register with SPIF set,
then accessing the SPI Data Register (SPIDATA).
Other precautions may need to be taken to prevent driver damage. If two devices are made masters
simultaneously, mode fault does not help protect either one unless one of them selects the other as slave. The
amount of damage possible depends on the length of time both devices attempt to act as master.
A write collision error occurs if it writes the SPIDATA when a transfer is in progress. Because it does not double
buffer the SPIDATA in the transmit direction, writes to SPIDATA cause data to be written directly into the SPI shift
register. Because this write corrupts any transfer in progress, it generates a write collision error. The transfer
continues undisturbed, and the write data that caused the error is not written to the shifter.
A write collision is normally a slave error because a slave has no control over when a master initiates a transfer. A
master knows when a transfer is in progress, so there is no reason for a master to generate a write-collision error,
although the SPI logic can detect write collisions in both master and slave devices.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
331
17.8 SPI Control Register
The control register for the SPI is called SPI Control Register (SPICON) at address F4H, Bank1.
It has the following control functions:
x
Operating mode and SCK rate selection
x
Clock Phase and Clock Polarity selection
x
Data order selection
x
SPI Enable/Disable
x
SPI Interrupt Enable/Disable
A reset clears the SPICON value to "00H". So, if you want to use SPI module, you must write appropriate value to
SPICON.
Figure 17-3 illustrates the SPI Control Register (SPICON).
SPI Control Registers (SPICON)
F2H, Set1, Bank1, R/W, Reset: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
SPI interrupt enable bit:
0 = disable
1 = Enable
.1
.0
LSB
SPCK rate selection bit:
00 = fosc/4
01 = fosc/16
10 = fosc/64
11 = fosc/256
SPI enable bit:
0 = disable
1 = enable
Data order selction bit:
0 = LSB first
1 = MSB first
Master/Slave mode selction bit:
0 = Slave mode
1 = Master mode
Clock Phase bit:
0 = Sample on the leading edge of SPCK
1 = Sample on the trailing edge of SPCK
Clock Polarity bit:
0 = clock low when idle
1 = clock high when idle
Figure 17-3
PS031201-0813
SPI Control Register (SPICON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
332
17.9 SPI Status Register
Two system errors can be detected by the SPI system. The first type of error arises in a multiple-master system
when multiple SPI devices simultaneously try to be a master. This error is called a mode fault. The second type of
error, write collision, indicates that an attempt was made to write data to the SPDR, while a transfer was in
progress.
The control register for the SPI is called SPISTAT at address F5H, Bank1.
It has the following control functions:
x
Double SPI speed
x
SPI interrupt flag
x
Write collision flag
x
Mode fault flag
Clearing the Write Collision bit is accomplished by reading the SPISTAT (with Write Collision bit set) followed by
an access of SPIDATA.
To clear the Mode fault bit, read the SPISTAT (with Mode Fault bit set), then write to the SPICON.
SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, it clears
the SPIF bit by first reading the SPI Status Register with SPIF set, then accessing the SPI Data Register
(SPIDATA).
Figure 17-4 illustrates the SPI Status Register (SPISTAT).
SPI Status Registers (SPISTAT)
F3H, Set1, Bank1, R/W, Reset: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
SPI interrupt complete flag(SPIF):
0 = Not pending
1 = interrupt pending
.5
.4
.3
.2
Mode fault bit:
0 = No mode fault
1 = mode fault
.1
.0
LSB
Double SPI speed bit:
0 = single
1 = double when in master mode
Write collision bit:
0 = No write collision
1 = write collision
Not used
Figure 17-4
PS031201-0813
SPI Status Register (SPISTAT)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
333
17.10 SPI Data Register
This register holds the SPI Data. The Firmware writes this register for transmitting data to External SPI Module.
The Firmware reads the register to get data from the external SPI module.
SPIDATA is located at address F6H and is R/W addressable.
Figure 17-5 illustrates the SPI Data Register (SPIDATA).
SPI Data Registers (SPIDATA)
F4H, Set1, Bank1, R/W, Reset: 00H
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
Figure 17-5
PS031201-0813
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
SPI Data Register (SPIDATA)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
334
18
Inter Integrated Circuit -Bus Interface
18.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontrollers support a multi-master Inter Integrated Circuit (IIC)-bus serial interface. A
dedicated serial data line (SDA) and a serial clock line (SCL) transmit information between bus masters and
peripheral devices that connects to the IIC-bus. The SDA and SCL lines are bi-directional.
In multi-master IIC-bus mode, multiple S3F8S19/F8S15 microcontrollers can receive or transmit serial data to or
from slave devices. The master S3F8S19/F8S15, which initiates a data transfer over the IIC-bus, is responsible
for terminating the transfer. S3F8S39/F8S38/F8S35/F8S34 microcontrollers support standard bus arbitration
functions.
To control multi-master IIC-bus operations, you should write the values to these registers:
x
IIC-bus control register (ICCR)
x
IIC-bus control/status register (ICSR)
x
IIC-bus Tx/Rx data shift register (IDSR)
x
IIC-bus address register (IAR)
When the IIC-bus is free, the SDA and SCL lines are both at High level. A High-to-Low transition of SDA initiates a
Start condition. A Low-to-High transition of SDA initiates a Stop condition, while SCL remains steady at High level.
The bus master always generates Start and Stop conditions. A 7-bit address value in the first data byte that is put
onto the bus after the Start condition is initiated determines which slave device the bus master selects. The eighth
bit determines the direction of the transfer (read or write).
Every data byte that is put onto the SDA line must total 8 bits. The number of bytes that can be sent or received
per bus transfer operation is unlimited. Data is always sent most-significant bit (MSB) first and every byte must be
immediately followed by an acknowledge (ACK) bit.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
335
18.1.1 Multi-Master IIC-Bus Control Register
The multi-master IIC-bus control register (ICCR) is located at address Page 8, 0CH. It is Read/Write addressable.
ICCR settings control these IIC-bus functions:
x
Enables or suppresses CPU acknowledge signal (ACK)
x
Selects IIC-bus clock source (fosc/16 or fosc/512)
x
Transmits/receives interrupt enable or disable
x
Transmits/receives interrupt pending control
x
Provide 4-bit pre-scalar for the serial transmit clock (SCL)
In the S3F8S19/F8S15 interrupt structure, the IIC-bus Tx/Rx interrupt is assigned level IRQ4, vector E6H. To
enable this interrupt, you should set ICCR.5 to "1". Program software then polls the IIC-bus Tx/Rx interrupt
pending bit (ICCR.4) to detect IIC-bus receive or transmit requests. When the CPU acknowledges the interrupt
request from the IIC-bus, the interrupt service routine should clear the interrupt pending condition by writing a "0"
to ICCR.4.
The IIC-bus clock source selection (fosc/16 or fosc/512) and the 4-bit pre-scalar value in the ICCR register
determine the SCL frequency (Refer to Figure 18-1 for more information.).
Figure 18-1 illustrates the multi-master IIC-bus control register.
IIC Control Register(ICCR)
0CH, Page 8,R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
Acknowledgement Enable Bit:
0 = Acknowledgement disable mode
1 = Acknowledgement enable mode
Tx Clock Selection Bit:
0 = fosc/16
1 = fosc/512
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
IIC-bus transmit (Tx) clock prescaler:
The IIC-bus transmit clock (SCLK) frequency is
determined by the clock source selection (ICCR.6)
and this 4-bit prescaler value, according to the
following formula:
Tx clock (SCL) = IICLK/(ICCR.3-ICCR.0) + 1
where IICLK = fosc/16 (ICCR.6 = "0") or
IICLK = fosc /512 (ICCR.6 = "1")
IIC-Bus Tx/Rx Interrupt
Enable Bit:
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
IIC Interrupt Pending Bit:
0 = Interrupt request is not pending; (when
read) pending bit clear when write 0
1 = Interrupt request is pending (when
read)
NOTE: A IIC-bus interrupt occurs 1) when a 1-byte transmit or receive operation is terminated,
2) when a general call or a slave address match occurs, or 3) if bus arbitration fails.
Figure 18-1
PS031201-0813
Multi-Master IIC-Bus Control Register (ICCR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
336
Table 18-1 lists the sample timing calculations for the IIC-bus transmit clock.
Table 18-1
Sample Timing Calculations for the IIC-Bus Transmit Clock (SCL)
ICCR.3-ICCR.0
Value
IICLK
(ICCR.3-ICCR.0 Settings + 1)
(fosc = 8 MHz)
ICCR.6 = 0 (fosc/16)
IICLK = 500 kHz
(fosc = 8 MHz)
ICCR.6 = 1 (fosc/512)
IICLK = 15.625 kHz
0000
IICLK/1
400 kHz (NOTE)
15.625 kHz
0001
IICLK/2
250 kHz
7.1825 kHz
0010
IICLK/3
167kHz
5.2038 kHz
0011
IICLK/4
125 kHz
3.9063 kHz
0100
IICLK/5
100 kHz
3.1250 kHz
0101
IICLK/6
83.3 kHz
2.6042 kHz
0110
IICLK/7
71.4 kHz
2.2321 kHz
0111
IICLK/8
62.5 kHz
1.9531 kHz
1000
IICLK/9
55.6 kHz
1.7361 kHz
1001
IICLK/10
50 kHz
1.5625 kHz
1010
IICLK/11
45.5 kHz
1.4205 kHz
1011
IICLK/12
41.7 kHz
1.3021 kHz
1100
IICLK/13
38.5 kHz
1.2019 kHz
1101
IICLK/14
35.7 kHz
1.1160 kHz
1110
IICLK/15
33.3kHz
1.0417 kHz
1111
IICLK/16
31.25 kHz
0.9766 kHz
NOTE: Maximum IICLK = 400 kHz.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
337
18.1.2 Multi-Master IIC-Bus Control/Status Register
The multi-master IIC-bus control/status register (ICSR) is located at address 0DH, Page 8. 4 bits in this register,
ICSR.3-ICSR.0, are read-only status flags.
ICSR register settings are used to control or monitor the IIC-bus functions (Refer to Figure 18-2 for more
information). The IIC-bus functions are:
x
Selects master/slave transmit or receive mode
x
Provides an IIC-bus busy status flag
x
Enables/disables Serial output
x
Provides failed bus arbitration procedure status flag
x
Provides slave address/address register match or general call received status flag
x
Provides slave address 00000000B (general call) received status flag
x
Provides last received bit status flag (not ACK = "1", ACK = "0")
Figure 18-2 illustrates the multi-master IIC-bus control/status register.
MULTI-MASTER IIC-BUS CONTROL/STATUS REGISTERS (ICSR)
0DH, Page 8, R/W (Bit 3-0: read-only)
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
IIC-Bus Master/Slave Tx/Rx Mode
Selection Bits::
00 = Slave receiver mode (Default mode)
01 = Slave transmitter mode
10 = Master receiver mode
11 = Master transmitter mode
.1
.0
LSB
IIC-bus last-received bit status flag:
0 = Last-received bit is "0" (ACK was received)
1 = Last-received bit is "1" (ACK wsa not received)
IIC-bus address zero status flag:
0 = START/STOP condition was generated
1 = Received slave address is
"00000000B" (general call)
IIC-bus address-as-slave status flag:
0 = START/STOP condition was generated
1 = Received slave address matches
the address value in the IAR
IIC-bus arbitration procedure status flag:
0 = Bus arbitration status okay
IIC-bus serial output
1 = Bus arbitration failed during serial I/O
enable/disable bit:
0 = Disable serial Tx/Rx
1 = Enable serial Tx/Rx
IIC-bus busy signal status bit:
0 = IIC-bus not busy (when read),
IIC interface STOP signal
generation (when write)
1 = IIC-bus is busy (when read),
IIC interface START signal
generation (when write)
NOTE: ICSR.3 is automatically set to "1" when a bus arbitration procedure fails over serial I/O
interface, while the IIC-bus is set to "master transmit mode" (ICSR.7 and ICSR.6 = "11B").
If slave transmit or receive mode is selected, ICSR.3 is automatically set to "1" if data is
written to the shift register (IDSR) when the busy signal bit, ICSR.5 is "1".
Figure 18-2
PS031201-0813
Multi-Master IIC-Bus Control/Status Register (ICSR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
338
18.1.3 Multi-Master IIC-Bus Transmit/Receive Data Shift Register
The IIC-bus data shift register (IDSR) is located at address 0EH, Page 8. In a transmit operation, data that is
written to the IDSR is transmitted serially, and MSB first. (For receive operations, the input data is written into the
IDSR register LSB first.)
The ICSR.4 setting enables or disables serial transmit/receive operations. When ICSR.4 = "1", data can be written
to the shift register. However, you can read the IIC-bus shift register at any time, irrespective of the current ICSR.4
setting.
Figure 18-3illustrates the multi-master IIC-bus Tx/Rx data shift register.
MULTI-MASTER IIC-BUS Tx/Rx DATA SHIFT REGISTERS (IDSR)
0EH, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
8-bit data shift register for IIC-bus Tx/Rx operations:
When ICSR.4 = "1", IDSR is write-enabled. You can
read the IDSR value at any time, regardless of the
current ICSR.4 setting.
Figure 18-3
Multi-Master IIC-Bus Tx/Rx Data Shift Register (IDSR)
18.1.4 Multi-Master IIC-Bus Address Register
The address register for the IIC-bus interface (IAR) is located at address 0FH, Page 8. It is used to store a latched
7-bit slave address. This address is mapped to IAR.7-IAR.1; bit 0 is not used (Refer to Figure 18-4 for more
information).
The latched slave address is compared to the next received slave address. If a match condition is detected, and if
the latched value is 00000000B, a general call status is detected.
Figure 18-4 illustrates the multi-master IIC-bus address register.
Address Register
(IAR)
Comparator
IIC-Bus Control Logic
SCL
ICCR
ICSR
Shift Register
(IDSR)
IRQ4
SDA
8
Data Bus
NOTE: The IIC-bus interrupt (IRQ4) is generated when a 1-byte receive or
transmit operation is terminated before the shift operation has
been completed.
Figure 18-4
PS031201-0813
Multi-Master IIC-Bus Address Register (IAR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
339
18.2 Block Diagram
Figure 18-5 illustrates the block diagram of IIC-bus.
Address Register
(IAR)
Comparator
IIC-Bus Control Logic
SCL
ICCR ICSR
Shift Register
(IDSR)
8
Data Bus
NOTE: The IIC-bus interrupt (IRQ4) is generated when a 1-byte receive or
transmit operation is terminated before the shift operation has
been completed.
Figure 18-5
PS031201-0813
IIC-Bus Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
IRQ4
SDA
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
340
18.3 The IIC-Bus Interface
The S3F8S19/F8S15 IIC-bus interface has four operating modes:
x
Master transmitter mode
x
Master receive mode
x
Slave transmitter mode
x
Slave receive mode
Functional relationships between these operating modes are described in these sections.
18.4 Start and Stop Conditions
When the IIC-bus interface is inactive, it is in slave mode. Therefore, the interface is always in slave mode when a
start condition is detected on the SDA line. (A start condition is a High-to-Low transition of the SDA line while the
clock signal, SCL, is High level.) When the interface enters master mode, it initiates a data transfer and generates
the SCL signal.
A start condition initiates a 1 byte serial data transfer over the SDA line and a stop condition ends the transfer. (A
stop condition is a Low-to-High transition of the SDA line while SCL is High level.) Start and stop conditions are
always generated by the master. The IIC-bus is "busy" when a start condition is generated. After a few clocks, a
stop condition is generated; the IIC-bus is again "free".
When a master initiates a start condition, it sends its slave address onto the bus. The address byte consists of a
7-bit address and a 1-bit transfer direction indicator (that is, write or read). If bit 8 is "0", a transmit operation
(write) is indicated; if bit 8 is "1", a request for data (read) is indicated.
The master ends the indicated transfer operation by transmitting a stop condition. If the master wants to continue
sending data over the bus, it can generate another slave address and another start condition. In this way, you can
perform read write operations in various formats.
Figure 18-6 illustrates the start and stop conditions.
SCL
SDA
START
Condition
STOP
Condition
Figure 18-6
PS031201-0813
Start and Stop Conditions
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
341
Figure 18-7 illustrates the input data protocol.
SCL
Data must
remain stable
while clock is
HIGH
Change of
data allowed
Data must
remain stable
while clock is
HIGH
SDA
Start
condition
hold time
Figure 18-7
Stop
condition
setup
Start
condition
hold time
Input Data Protocol
Figure 18-8 illustrates the interrupt pending information.
1
SCL
2
1
9
2
SDA
Acknowledgement low
High or low state is possible
according to data.
If stop signal is not generated in
interval A, next clock is generated.
A
Interrupt
pending bit
set point
Interrupt
pending bit
clear point
NOTE: In IIC operation, interrupt pending information is indispensable, therefore it is
not possible to control IIC operation only in Main routine without interrupt.
Figure 18-8
PS031201-0813
Interrupt Pending Information
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
342
18.5 Data Transfer Formats
Every byte that you put on the SDA line must be 8 bits in length. The number of bytes which you can transmit per
transfer is unlimited. The first byte following a start condition is the address byte. The master transmits this
address byte when the IIC-bus is operating in master mode. Each byte must be followed by an acknowledge
(ACK) bit. Serial data and addresses are always sent MSB first.
Figure 18-9 illustrates the IIC-bus interface data formats.
Single Byte Write Mode Format
S
Slave
Address
W
A
DATA
A
P
Data Transferred (Data + Acknowledge)
"0" (write)
Multigle Byte Write Mode Format
S
Slave
Address
W
A
Sub
Address
A
R
A
P
Auto Increment of Sub Address
Single Byte Read Mode Format
Slave
Address
DATA
Data Transferred (Data n + Acknowledge)
"0" (write)
S
DATA A
A
DATA
A
P
Data Transferred (Data + Acknowledge)
"1" (read)
Multigle Byte Read Mode Format
S
Slave
Address
W
A
Sub
Address
S
Slave
Address R
A DATA
A
DATA
A
P
Data Transferred (Data n + Acknowledge)
"1" (read)
NOTES:
1. S: start, A: acknowledge, P: stop
2. The "Sub Address" indicates the internal address of the slave device.
Figure 18-9
PS031201-0813
IIC-Bus Interface Data Formats
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
343
18.6 ACK Signal Transmission
To complete a 1 byte transfer operation, the receiver should send an ACK bit to the transmitter. The ACK pulse
occurs at the ninth clock of the SCL line (eight clocks are required to complete the one-byte transfer). The clock
pulse required for the transmission of the ACK bit is always generated by the master.
The transmitter releases the SDA line (that is, it sends the SDA line High) when the ACK clock pulse is received.
The receiver should drive the SDA line Low during the ACK clock pulse so that SDA is Low during the High period
of the ninth SCL pulse.
You can enable and disable the ACK bit transmit function by software (ICCR.7). However, the ACK pulse on the
ninth clock of SCL is required to complete a 1 byte data transfer operation.
Figure 18-10 illustrates the acknowledge response from receiver.
1
SCLK
from
Master
8
9
Start Condition
Data Output
from
Transmitter
Clock to output
Data Output
from
Receiver
ACK
Figure 18-10
PS031201-0813
Acknowledge Response from Receiver
PRELIMINARY
Clock to output
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
344
Figure 18-11 illustrates the write operation sequence.
Slave address transmission
with write condition
Main
routine
Start signal generation
No
ACK?
Yes
Sub address of slave
transmission
No
ACK?
Interrupt
routine
Yes
Transmit data
No
ACK?
Stop signal generation
Figure 18-11
PS031201-0813
Write Operation Sequence
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
345
Figure 18-12 illustrates the read operation sequence.
Slave address transmission
with write condition
Main
routine
Start signal generation
No
ACK?
Yes
Sub address of slave
transmission
No
ACK?
Interrupt
routine
Yes
Slave address transmission
with read condition
No
ACK?
Yes
Transmit data
No
ACK?
Stop signal generation
Figure 18-12
PS031201-0813
Read Operation Sequence
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
346
18.7 Read-Write Operations
When operating in transmitter mode, the IIC-bus interface interrupt routine waits for the master (the
S3F8S19/F8S15) to write a data byte into the IIC-bus data shift register (IDSR). To perform this, it holds the SCL
line Low prior to transmission.
In receive mode, the IIC-bus interface waits for the master to read the byte from the IIC-bus data shift register
(IDSR). It performs this by holding the SCL line Low after the complete reception of a data byte.
18.8 Bus Arbitration Procedures
Arbitration takes place on the SDA line to prevent contention on the bus between two masters. If a master with a
SDA High level detects another master with an SDA active Low level, it will not initiate a data transfer because the
current level on the bus does not correspond to its own level. The master that loses the arbitration can generate
SCL pulses only until the end of the last-transmitted data byte. The arbitration procedure can continue while data
continues to be transferred over the bus.
The first stage of arbitration is the comparison of address bits. If a master loses the arbitration during the
addressing stage of a data transfer, it is possible that the master that won the arbitration attempts address the
master that lost. In this case, the losing master should immediately switch to slave receiver mode.
18.9 Abort Conditions
If a slave receiver does not acknowledge the slave address, it should hold the level of the SDA line High. This
signals the master to generate a stop condition and to abort the transfer.
If a master receiver involves in the aborted transfer, it should also signal the end of the slave transmit operation. It
performs this by not generating an ACK after the last data byte received from the slave. The slave transmitter
must then release the SDA to allow a master to generate a stop condition.
18.10 Configuring the IIC-Bus
To control the frequency of the serial clock (SCL), you should program the 4-bit pre-scalar value in the ICCR
register. The IIC-bus interface address is stored in IAR. By default, the IIC-bus interface address is an unknown
value.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
347
19
UART 0
19.1 Overview
The UART 0 block has a full-duplex serial port with programmable operating modes:
There are one synchronous mode and three Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) modes:
x
Serial I/O with baud rate of fU/(16 u (BRDATA0 + 1))
x
8-bit UART mode: variable baud rate
x
9-bit UART mode: fU/16
x
9-bit UART mode: variable baud rate
You can access both UART 0 receive and transmit buffers through the data register, UDATA0 in set 1, bank 0 at
address F0H. Writing to the UART data register loads the transmit buffer; reading the UART 0 data register
accesses a physically separate receive buffer.
When accessing a receive data buffer (shift register), reception of the next byte can begin before CPU reads the
previously received byte from the receive register. However, if the first byte has not been read by the time the next
byte has been completely received, one of the bytes will be lost.
In all operating modes, transmission is started when any instruction (usually a write operation) uses the UDATA0
register as its destination address. In mode 0, serial data reception starts when they receive interrupt pending bit
(UART0CONH.0) is "0" and the receive enable bit (UART0CONH.4) is "1". In modes 1, 2 and 3, reception starts
whenever an incoming start bit ("0") is received and the receive enable bit (UART0CONH.4) is set to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
348
19.2 Programming Procedure
To program the UART 0 modules, the basic steps are:
1. Configure P4.7 and P4.6 to alternative function (RxD0 (P4.7), TxD0 (P4.6)) for UART 0 module by setting the
P4CONH register to appropriately value.
2. Load an 8-bit value to the UART0CONH/L control register to properly configure the UART 0 I/O module.
3. For interrupt generation, set the UART 0 I/O interrupt enable bit (UART0CONH.1 or UART0CONL.1) to "1".
4. When you transmit data to the UART 0 buffer, write data to UDATA0, the shift operation starts.
5. When the shift operation (receive/transmit) completes, CPU sets UART 0 pending bit (UART0CONH.0 or
UART0CONL.0) to "1" and generates an UART 0 interrupt request.
19.2.1 UART 0 High Byte Control Register (UART0CONH)
The control register for the UART 0 is called UART0CONH in page 8 at address 00H.
The control functions of UART0CONH are:
x
Select operating mode and baud rate Supports multiprocessor communication and interrupt control
Enables/disables serial receive control Ninth data bit location for transmit and receive operations (modes 2
and 3 only)
x
UART 0 receive interrupt control
A reset clears the UART0CONH value to "00H". Therefore, if you want to use UART 0 module, you should write
appropriate value to UART0CONH.
19.2.2 UART 0 Low Byte Control Register
The control register for the UART 0 is called UART0CONL located in page 8 at address 01H.
The control functions of UART0CONL are:
x
Selects UART 0 transmit and receive parity-bit
x
Selects UART 0 clock
x
UART 0 transmit interrupt control
A reset clears the UART0CONL value to "00H". Therefore, if you want to use UART 0 module, you should write
appropriate value to UART0CONL.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
349
Figure 19-1 illustrates the UART 0 high byte control register.
UART 0 Control Register, High Byte (UART0CONH)
00H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
MS1
MS0
MCE
RE
TB8
RB8
RIE
RIP
LSB
Uart 0 receive interrupt pending bit:
0 = No interrupt pending(when read),
clear pending bit(when write)
1 = Interrupt is pending(when read)
Operating mode and
baud rate selection bits:
(see table below)
Multiprocessor communication (1)
enable bit (for modes 2 and 3 only):
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Uart 0 receive interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable Rx interrupt
1 = Enable Rx interrupt
Serial data receive enable bit:
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
RB8(3) (Only when UART0CONL.7 = 0):
Location of the 9th data bit that was
received in UART 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
TB8(3) (Only when UART0CONL.7 = 0):
Location of the 9th data bit to be
transmitted in UART 0 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
MS1 MS0 Mode Description (2) Baud Rate
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
3
Shift register
8-bit UART
9-bit UART
9-bit UART
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA0 + 1)))
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA0 + 1)))
(fu /16)
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA0 + 1)))
NOTES:
1. In mode 2 or 3, if the UART0CONH.5 bit is set to "1" then the receive interrupt will not be
activated if the received 9th data bit is "0". In mode 1, if UART0CONH.5 = "1" then the
receive interrut will not be activated if a valid stop bit was not received.
In mode 0, the UART0CONH.5 bit should be "0"
2. The descriptions for 8-bit and 9-bit UART mode do not include start and stop bits
for serial data receive and transmit.
3. If the UART0CONL.7 = 1, This bit is "don't care".
Figure 19-1
PS031201-0813
UART 0 High Byte Control Register (UART0CONH)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
350
Figure 19-2 illustrates the UART 0 low byte control register.
UART 0 Control Register, Low Byte (UART0CONL)
01H, Page 8, R/W
MS
B
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
TIE
TIP
LS
B
Uart 0 transmit interrupt pending bit:
0 = No interrupt pending(when read),
clear pending bit(when write)
1 = Interrupt is pending(when read)
UART 0 transmit parity-bit autogeneration enable bit:
0 = Disable parity-bit auto-generation
1 = Enable parity-bit auto-generation
Uart 0 transmit interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable Tx interrupt
1 = Enable Tx interrupt
UART 0 transmit parity-bit
selection bit(1):
0 = Even parity-bit
1 = Odd parity-bit
UART 0 receive parity-bit
selection bit(1):
0 = Even parity-bit check
1 = Odd parity-bit check
Uart 0 clock selection bits:
00 = fxx/8
01 = fxx/4
10 = fxx/2
11 = fxx/1
UART 0 receive parity-bit
error status bit(1):
0 = No parity-bit error
1 = Parity-bit error
NOTES:
1. If the UART0CONL.7 = 0, This bit is "don't care".
2. The bits UART0CONL.6-.4 are for mode 2 and 3 only.
Figure 19-2
PS031201-0813
UART 0 Low Byte Control Register (UART0CONL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
351
19.2.3 UART 0 Interrupt Pending Bits
In mode 0, the receive interrupt pending bit UART0CONH.0 is set to "1" when the 8th receive data bit has been
shifted. In mode 1, the UART0CONH.0 bit is set to "1" at the halfway point of the shift time of stop bit. In mode 2
or 3, the UART0CONH.0 bit is set to "1" at the halfway point of the shift time of RB8 bit. When the CPU
acknowledges the receive interrupt pending condition, the UART0CONH.0 bit must then be cleared by software in
the interrupt service routine.
th
In mode 0, the transmit interrupt pending bit UART0CONL.0 is set to "1" when the 8 transmit data bit has been
shifted. In mode 1, 2 or 3, the UART0CONL.0 bit is set at the start of the stop bit. When the CPU acknowledges
the transmit interrupt pending condition, the UART0CONL.0 bit must then be cleared by software in the interrupt
service routine.
19.2.4 UART 0 Data Register
Figure 19-3 illustrates the UART 0 data register (UDATA0).
UART 0 Data Register (UDATA0)
02H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Transmit or receive data
Figure 19-3
UART 0 Data Register (UDATA0)
19.2.5 UART 0 Baud Rate Data Register
The value stored in the UART 0 baud rate register, BRDATA0, lets you determine the UART 0 clock rate (baud
rate).
Figure 19-4 illustrates the UART 0 baud rate data register.
UART 0 Baud Rate Data Register (BRDATA0)
03H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Baud rate data
Figure 19-4
PS031201-0813
UART 0 Baud Rate Data Register (BRDATA0)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
352
19.3 Baud Rate Calculations
This section includes:
x
Mode 0 baud rate calculation
x
Mode 2 baud rate calculation
x
Mode 1 and 3 baud rate calculation
19.3.1 Mode 0 Baud Rate Calculation
In mode 0, the baud rate is determined by the UART 0 baud rate data register, BRDATA0 in Page 8 at address
03H: Mode 0 baud rate = fU/(16 u (BRDATA0 + 1)).
19.3.2 Mode 2 Baud Rate Calculation
The baud rate in mode 2 is fixed at the fU clock frequency divided by 16: Mode 2 baud rate = f U/16
19.3.3 Mode 1 and 3 Baud Rate Calculation
In modes 1 and 3, the baud rate is determined by the UART 0 baud rate data register, BRDATA0 in Page 8 at
address 03H: Mode 1 and 3 baud rate = fU/(16 u (BRDATA0 + 1))
Table 19-1 lists the commonly used baud rates generated by BRDATA0.
Table 19-1
Commonly Used Baud Rates Generated by BRDATA0
Mode
Baud Rate
UART Clock (fU)
Mode 2
0.5 MHz
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 3
PS031201-0813
BRDATA0
Decimal
Hexadecimal
8 MHz
x
x
230,400 Hz
11.0592 MHz
02
02H
115,200 Hz
11.0592 MHz
05
05H
57,600 Hz
11.0592 MHz
11
0BH
38,400 Hz
11.0592 MHz
17
11H
19,200 Hz
11.0592 MHz
35
23H
9,600 Hz
11.0592 MHz
71
47H
4,800 Hz
11.0592 MHz
143
8FH
62,500 Hz
10 MHz
09
09H
9,615 Hz
10 MHz
64
40H
38,461 Hz
8 MHz
12
0CH
12,500 Hz
8 MHz
39
27H
19,230 Hz
4 MHz
12
0CH
9,615 Hz
4 MHz
25
19H
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
353
19.4 Block Diagram
Figure 19-5 illustrates the functional block diagram of UART 0.
Data Bus
TB8
MS0
MS1
BRDATA0
S
D
CLK
1/8
1/4
1/2
MUX
fU
Q
UDATA0
CLK
Baud Rate
Generator
MS0
MS1
RxD0
Zero Detector
1/1
UART0CONL.3-.2
Write to
UDATA0
TxD0
Shift
Start
Tx Control
Tx Clock
EN
TIP
Send
TxD0
Shift
Clock
TIE
IRQ5
Interrupt
RIE
RIP
Rx Clock
RE
RIP
Receive
Rx Control
Start
1-to-0
Transition
Detector
Shift
Shift
Value
Bit Detector
Shift
Register
MS0
MS1
UDATA0
RxD0
Data Bus
Figure 19-5
PS031201-0813
UART 0 Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
19.5 UART 0 Mode 0 Function Description
354
In mode 0, UART 0 is input and output through the RxD0 (P4.7) pin and TxD0 (P4.6) pin outputs the shift clock.
Data is transmitted or received in 8-bit units only. The LSB of the 8-bit value is transmitted (or received) first.
19.5.1 Mode 0 Transmit Procedure
The steps of Mode 0 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select mode 0 by setting UART0CONH.7 and .6 to "00B".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register UDATA0 (F0H, set 1, bank 0) to start the transmission operation.
19.5.2 Mode 0 Receive Procedure
The steps of Mode 0 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select mode 0 by setting UART0CONH.7 and .6 to "00B".
4. Clear the receive interrupt pending bit (UART0CONH.0) by writing a "0" to UART0CONH.0.
5. Set the UART 0 receive enable bit (UART0CONH.4) to "1".
6. The shift clock will now be output to the TxD0 (P4.6) pin and will read the data at the RxD0 (P4.7) pin.
A UART 0 receive interrupt occurs when UART0CONH.1 is set to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
355
Figure 19-6 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 0 operation.
Write to Shift Register (UDATA0)
RxD0 (Data Out)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
Transmit
Shift
D7
TxD0 (Shift Clock)
TIP
Clear RIP and set RE
RIP
Receive
RE
Shift
D0
RxD0 (Data In)
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TxD0 (Shift Clock)
1
2
Figure 19-6
PS031201-0813
3
4
5
6
7
8
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 0 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
19.6 Serial Port Mode 1 Function Description
356
In mode 1, 10 bits are transmitted through the TxD0 (P4.6) pin or received through the RxD0 (P4.7) pin.
The three components of each data frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Stop bit ("1")
The baud rate for mode 1 is variable.
19.6.1 Mode 1 Transmit Procedure
The steps of Mode 1 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select the baud rate that BRDATA0 generates.
4. Select mode 1 (8-bit UART) by setting UART0CONH bits 7 and 6 to "01B".
5. Write transmission data to the shift register UDATA0 (F0H, set 1, bank 0). The start and stop bits are
generated automatically by hardware.
19.6.2 Mode 1 Receive Procedure
The steps of Mode 1 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select the baud rate that BRDATA0 generates.
4. Select mode 1 and set the RE (Receive Enable) bit in the UART0CONH register to "1".
5. The start bit low ("0") condition at the RxD0 (P4.7) pin will cause the UART 0 module to start the serial data
receive operation.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
357
Figure 19-7 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 1 operation.
Tx
Clock
Shift
TxD0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
Start Bit
D7
Stop Bit
Transmit
Write to Shift Register (UDATA0)
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD0
D6
D7
Stop Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 19-7
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 1 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
358
19.7 Serial Port Mode 2 Function Description
In mode 2, 11 bits are transmitted through the TxD0 (P4.6) pin or received through the RxD0 (P4.7) pin.
The four components of each data frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Programmable 9 data bit
x
Stop bit ("1")
th
th
The 9 data bit to be transmitted can be assigned a value of "0" or "1" by writing the TB8 bit (UART0CONH.3).
th
When receiving, the 9 data bit that it receives is written to the RB8 bit (UART0CONH.2), while the stop bit is
ignored. The baud rate for mode 2 is f U/16 clock frequency.
19.7.1 Mode 2 Transmit Procedure
The steps for Mode 2 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
th
3. Select mode 2 (9-bit UART) by setting UART0CONH bits 7 and 6 to "10B". Also, select the 9 data bit to be
transmitted by writing TB8 to "0" or "1".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register, UDATA0 (F0H, set 1, bank 0), to start the transmit operation.
19.7.2 Mode 2 Receive Procedure
The steps for Mode 2 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select mode 2 and set the receive enable bit (RE) bit in the UART0CONH register to "1".
4. The receive operation starts when the signal at the RxD0 (P4.7) pin enters to low level.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
359
Figure 19-8 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 2 operation.
Tx
Clock
Write to Shift Register (UDATA0)
TxD0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TB8
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start Bit
Transmit
Shift
Stop Bit
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD0
RB8
Stop
Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 19-8
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 2 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
360
19.8 Serial Port Mode 3 Function Description
In mode 3, 11 bits are transmitted through the TxD0 (P4.6) pin or received through the RxD0 (P4.7) pin. Mode 3 is
identical to mode 2 except for baud rate, which is variable.
The four components of each data frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Programmable 9 data bit
x
Stop bit ("1")
th
19.8.1 Mode 3 Transmit Procedure
The steps for Mode 3 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
th
3. Select mode 3 operation (9-bit UART) by setting UART0CONH bits 7 and 6 to "11B". Also, select the 9 data
bit to be transmitted by writing UART0CONH.3 (TB8) to "0" or "1".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register, UDATA0 (F0H, set 1, bank 0), to start the transmit operation.
19.8.2 Mode 3 Receive Procedure
The steps for Mode 3 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 0 clock, UART0CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 0 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART0CONL.7).
3. Select mode 3 and set the RE (Receive Enable) bit in the UART0CONH register to "1".
4. The receive operation will be started when the signal at the RxD0 (P4.7) pin enters to low level.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
361
Figure 19-9 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 3 operation.
Tx
Clock
Write to Shift Register (UDATA0)
TxD0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TB8
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start Bit
Transmit
Shift
Stop Bit
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD0
RB8
Stop
Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 19-9
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 3 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
19.9 Serial Communication for Multiprocessor Configurations
362
The S3F8-series multiprocessor communication feature enables a "master" S3F8S19/F8S15 to send a multipleframe serial message to a "slave" device in a multi- S3F8S19/F8S15 configuration. It does this without interrupting
other slave devices that may be on the same serial line.
th
This feature can be used only in UART modes 2 or 3. In these modes, 2 and 3, 9 data bits are received. The 9 bit
value is written to RB8 (UART0CONH.2). The data receive operation is concluded with a stop bit. You can
program this function so that when the stop bit is received, the serial interrupt will be generated only if RB8 = "1".
To enable this feature, you should set the MCE bit in the UART0CONH register. When the MCE bit is "1", the
serial data frames that are received with the ninth bit = "0" do not generate an interrupt. In this case, the ninth bit
simply separates the address from the serial data.
19.9.1 Sample Protocol for Master/Slave Interaction
When the master device wants to transmit a block of data to one of several slaves on a serial line, it first sends out
an address byte to identify the target slave. Note that in this case, an address byte differs from a data byte: In an
th
address byte, the 9 bit is "1" and in a data byte, it is "0".
The address byte interrupts all slaves so that each slave can examine the received byte and see if it is being
addressed. The addressed slave then clears its MCE bit and prepares to receive incoming data bytes.
The MCE bits of slaves that were not addressed remain set, and they continue operating normally while ignoring
the incoming data bytes.
While the MCE bit setting has no effect in mode 0, you can use it in mode 1 to check the validity of the stop bit.
For mode 1 reception, if MCE is "1", the receive interrupt will be issue unless a valid stop bit is received.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
363
19.9.2 Setup Procedure for Multiprocessor Communications
The steps to configure multiprocessor communications are:
1. Set all S3F8S19/F8S15 devices (masters and slaves) to UART 0 mode 2 or 3.
2. Write the MCE bit of all the slave devices to "1".
3. The transmission protocol of master device is:
First byte: the address identifying the target slave device (ninth bit = "1")
Next bytes: data (ninth = "0")
4. When the target slave receives the first byte, all of the slaves are interrupted because the ninth data bit is "1".
The targeted slave compares the address byte to its own address and then clears its MCE bit in order to
receive incoming data. The other slaves continue operating normally.
Figure 19-10 illustrates the connection example of multiprocessor serial data communications.
Full-Duplex Multi-S3F8S19 Interconnect
TxD0
RxD0
Master
S3F8S19
Figure 19-10
PS031201-0813
TxD0
RxD0
Slave 1
TxD0
RxD0
Slave 2
S3F8S19
S3F8S19
...
TxD0
RxD0
Slave n
S3F8S19
Connection Example for Multiprocessor Serial Data Communications
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
364
20
UART 1
20.1 Overview
The UART 1 block has a full-duplex serial port with programmable operating modes:
There are one synchronous mode and three Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) modes:
x
Serial I/O with baud rate of fU/(16 u (BRDATA1 + 1))
x
8-bit UART mode: variable baud rate
x
9-bit UART mode: fU/16
x
9-bit UART mode: variable baud rate
You can access UART 1 receive and transmit buffers through the data register, UDATA1 in page 8 at address
06H. Writing to the UART data register loads the transmit buffer; reading the UART 1 data register accesses a
physically separate receive buffer.
When accessing a receive data buffer (shift register), reception of the next byte can begin before CPU reads the
previously received byte from the receive register. However, if the first byte has not been read by the time the next
byte has been completely received, one of the bytes will be lost.
In all operating modes, transmission is started when any instruction (usually a write operation) uses the UDATA1
register as its destination address. In mode 0, serial data reception starts when they receive interrupt pending bit
(UART1CONH.0) is "0" and the receive enable bit (UART1CONH.4) is "1". In mode 1, 2 and 3, reception starts
whenever an incoming start bit ("0") is received and the receive enable bit (UART1CONH.4) is set to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
365
20.2 Programming Procedure
To program the UART 1 modules, the basic steps are:
1. Configure P4.5 and P4.4 to alternative function (RxD1 (P4.5), TxD1 (P4.4)) for UART 1 module by setting the
P4CONH/L register to appropriately value.
2. Load an 8-bit value to the UART1CONH/L control register to properly configure the UART 1 I/O module.
3. For interrupt generation, set the UART 1 I/O interrupt enable bit (UART1CONH.1 or UART1CONL.1) to "1".
4. When you transmit data to the UART 1 buffer, write data to UDATA1, the shift operation starts.
5. When the shift operation (receive/transmit) completes, CPU sets UART 1 pending bit (UART1CONH.0 or
UART1CONL.0) to "1" and generates an UART 1 interrupt request.
20.2.1 UART 1 High Byte Control Register (UART1CONH)
The control register for the UART 1 is called UART1CONH in page 8 at address 04H.
The control functions of UART1CONH are:
x
Select operating mode and baud rate Supports multiprocessor communication and interrupt control
Enables/disables serial receive control Ninth data bit location for transmit and receive operations (modes 2
and 3 only)
x
UART 1 receive interrupt control
A reset clears the UART1CONH value to "00H". Therefore, if you want to use UART 1 module, you should write
appropriate value to UART1CONH.
20.2.2 UART 1 Low Byte Control Register
The control register for the UART 1 is called UART1CONL located in page 8 at address 05H.
The control functions of UART1CONL are:
x
Selects UART 1 transmit and receive parity-bit
x
Selects UART 1 clock
x
UART 1 transmit interrupt control
A reset clears the UART1CONL value to "00H". Therefore, if you want to use UART 1 module, you should write
appropriate value to UART1CONL.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
366
Figure 20-1 illustrates the UART 1 high byte control register.
UART 1 Control Register, High Byte (UART1CONH)
04H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
MS1
MS0
MCE
RE
TB8
RB8
RIE
RIP
LSB
Uart 1 receive interrupt pending bit:
0 = No interrupt pending(when read),
clear pending bit(when write)
1 = Interrupt is pending(when read)
Operating mode and
baud rate selection bits:
(see table below)
Multiprocessor communication (1)
enable bit (for modes 2 and 3 only):
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Uart 1 receive interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable Rx interrupt
1 = Enable Rx interrupt
Serial data receive enable bit:
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
RB8(3) (Only when UART1CONL.7 = 0):
Location of the 9th data bit that was
received in UART 1 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
TB8(3) (Only when UART1CONL.7 = 0):
Location of the 9th data bit to be
transmitted in UART 1 mode 2 or 3 ("0" or "1")
MS1 MS0 Mode Description (2) Baud Rate
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
3
Shift register
8-bit UART
9-bit UART
9-bit UART
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA1 + 1)))
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA1 + 1)))
(fu /16)
(fu/(16 x (BRDATA1 + 1)))
NOTES:
1. In mode 2 or 3, if the UART1CONH.5 bit is set to "1" then the receive interrupt will not be
activated if the received 9th data bit is "0". In mode 1, if UART1CONH.5 = "1" then the
receive interrut will not be activated if a valid stop bit was not received.
In mode 0, the UART1CONH.5 bit should be "0"
2. The descriptions for 8-bit and 9-bit UART mode do not include start and stop bits
for serial data receive and transmit.
3. If the UART1CONL.7 = 1, This bit is "don't care".
Figure 20-1
PS031201-0813
UART 1 High Byte Control Register (UART1CONH)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
367
Figure 20-2 illustrates the UART 1 low byte control register.
UART 1 Control Register, Low Byte (UART1CONL)
05H, Page 8, R/W
MS
B
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
TIE
TIP
LS
B
Uart 1 transmit interrupt pending bit:
0 = No interrupt pending(when read),
clear pending bit(when write)
1 = Interrupt is pending(when read)
UART 1 transmit parity-bit autogeneration enable bit:
0 = Disable parity-bit auto-generation
1 = Enable parity-bit auto-generation
Uart 1 transmit interrupt enable bit:
0 = Disable Tx interrupt
1 = Enable Tx interrupt
UART 1 transmit parity-bit
selection bit(1):
0 = Even parity-bit
1 = Odd parity-bit
UART 1 receive parity-bit
selection bit(1):
0 = Even parity-bit check
1 = Odd parity-bit check
Uart 1 clock selection bits:
00 = fxx/8
01 = fxx/4
10 = fxx/2
11 = fxx/1
UART 1 receive parity-bit
error status bit(1):
0 = No parity-bit error
1 = Parity-bit error
NOTES:
1. If the UART1CONL.7 = 0, This bit is "don't care".
2. The bits UART1CONL.6-.4 are for mode 2 and 3 only.
Figure 20-2
PS031201-0813
UART 1 Low Byte Control Register (UART1CONL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
368
20.2.3 UART 1 Interrupt Pending bits
th
In mode 0, the receive interrupt pending bit UART1CONH.0 is set to "1" when the 8 receive data bit has been
shifted. In mode 1, the UART1CONH.0 bit is set to "1" at the halfway point of the shift time of stop bit. In mode 2
or 3, the UART1CONH.0 bit is set to "1" at the halfway point of the shift time of RB8 bit. When the CPU
acknowledges the receive interrupt pending condition, the UART1CONH.0 bit must then be cleared by software in
the interrupt service routine.
th
In mode 0, the transmit interrupt pending bit UART1CONL.0 is set to "1" when the 8 transmit data bit has been
shifted. In mode 1, 2 or 3, the UART1CONL.0 bit is set at the start of the stop bit. When the CPU acknowledges
the transmit interrupt pending condition, the UART1CONL.0 bit must then be cleared by software in the interrupt
service routine.
20.2.4 UART 1 Data Register
Figure 20-3 illustrates the UART 1 data register.
UART 1 Data Register (UDATA1)
06H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Transmit or receive data
Figure 20-3
UART 1 Data Register (UDATA1)
20.2.5 UART 1 Baud Rate Data Register
The value stored in the UART 1 baud rate register, BRDATA1, lets you determine the UART 1 clock rate (baud
rate).
Figure 20-4 illustrates the UART 1 baud rate data register.
UART 1 Baud Rate Data Register (BRDATA1)
07H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Baud rate data
Figure 20-4
PS031201-0813
UART 1 Baud Rate Data Register (BRDATA1)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
369
20.3 Baud Rate Calculations
This section includes:
x
Mode 0 baud rate calculation
x
Mode 2 baud rate calculation
x
Modes 1 and 3 baud rate calculation
20.3.1 Mode 0 Baud Rate Calculation
In mode 0, the baud rate is determined by the UART 1 baud rate data register, BRDATA1 in set 1, bank 0 at
address F5H: Mode 0 baud rate = fU/(16 u (BRDATA1 + 1)).
20.3.2 Mode 2 Baud Rate Calculation
The baud rate in mode 2 is fixed at the fU clock frequency divided by 16: Mode 2 baud rate = f U/16
20.3.3 Modes 1 and 3 Baud Rate Calculation
In modes 1 and 3, the baud rate is determined by the UART 1 baud rate data register, BRDATA1 in set 1, bank 0
at address F5H: Mode 1 and 3 baud rate = f U/(16 u (BRDATA1 + 1))
Table 20-1 lists the commonly used baud rates generated by BRDATA1.
Table 20-1
Commonly Used Baud Rates Generated by BRDATA1
Mode
Baud Rate
UART Clock (fU)
Mode 2
0.5 MHz
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 3
PS031201-0813
BRDATA1
Decimal
Hexadecimal
8 MHz
x
x
230,400 Hz
11.0592 MHz
02
02H
115,200 Hz
11.0592 MHz
05
05H
57,600 Hz
11.0592 MHz
11
0BH
38,400 Hz
11.0592 MHz
17
11H
19,200 Hz
11.0592 MHz
35
23H
9,600 Hz
11.0592 MHz
71
47H
4,800 Hz
11.0592 MHz
143
8FH
62,500 Hz
10 MHz
09
09H
9,615 Hz
10 MHz
64
40H
38,461 Hz
8 MHz
12
0CH
12,500 Hz
8 MHz
39
27H
19,230 Hz
4 MHz
12
0CH
9,615 Hz
4 MHz
25
19H
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
370
20.4 Block Diagram
Figure 20-5 illustrates the functional block diagram of UART 1.
Data Bus
TB8
MS0
MS1
BRDATA1
S
D
CLK
1/8
1/4
1/2
MUX
fU
Q
UDATA1
CLK
Baud Rate
Generator
MS0
MS1
RxD1
Zero Detector
1/1
UART1CONL.3-.2
Write to
UDATA1
TxD1
Shift
Start
Tx Control
Tx Clock
EN
TIP
Send
TxD1
Shift
Clock
TIE
IRQ5
Interrupt
RIE
RIP
Rx Clock
RE
RIP
Receive
Rx Control
Start
1-to-0
Transition
Detector
Shift
Shift
Value
Bit Detector
Shift
Register
MS0
MS1
UDATA1
RxD1
Data Bus
Figure 20-5
PS031201-0813
UART 1 Functional Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
20.5 UART 1 Mode 0 Function Description
371
In mode 0, UART 1 is input and output through the RxD1 (P4.5) pin and TxD1 (P4.4) pin outputs the shift clock.
Data is transmitted or received in 8-bit units only. The LSB of the 8-bit value is transmitted (or received) first.
20.5.1 Mode 0 Transmit Procedure
The steps of Mode 0 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select mode 0 by setting UART1CONH.7 and .6 to "00B".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register UDATA1 (06H, page 8) to start the transmission operation.
20.5.2 Mode 0 Receive Procedure
The steps of Mode 0 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select mode 0 by setting UART1CONH.7 and .6 to "00B".
4. Clear the receive interrupt pending bit (UART1CONH.0) by writing a "0" to UART1CONH.0.
5. Set the UART 1 receive enable bit (UART1CONH.4) to "1".
6. The shift clock will now be output to the TxD1 (P4.4) pin and will read the data at the RxD1 (P4.5) pin.
A UART 1 receive interrupt occurs when UART1CONH.1 is set to "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
372
Figure 20-6 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 0 operation.
Write to Shift Register (UDATA1)
RxD1 (Data Out)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
Transmit
Shift
D7
TxD1 (Shift Clock)
TIP
Clear RIP and set RE
RIP
Receive
RE
Shift
D0
RxD1 (Data In)
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TxD1 (Shift Clock)
1
2
Figure 20-6
PS031201-0813
3
4
5
6
7
8
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 0 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
20.6 Serial Port Mode 1 Function Description
373
In mode 1, 10 bits are transmitted through the TxD1 (P4.4) pin or received through the RxD1 (P4.5) pin.
The three components of each data frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Stop bit ("1")
The baud rate for mode 1 is variable.
20.6.1 Mode 1 Transmit Procedure
The steps of Mode 1 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select the baud rate that BRDATA1 generates.
4. Select mode 1 (8-bit UART) by setting UART1CONH bits 7 and 6 to "01B".
5. Write transmission data to the shift register UDATA1 (06H, page 8). The start and stop bits are generated
automatically by hardware.
20.6.2 Mode 1 Receive Procedure
The steps of Mode 1 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select the baud rate that BRDATA1 generates.
4. Select mode 1 and set the RE (Receive Enable) bit in the UART1CONH register to "1".
5. The start bit low ("0") condition at the RxD1 (P4.5) pin will cause the UART 1 module to start the serial data
receive operation.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
374
Figure 20-7 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 1 operation.
Tx
Clock
Shift
TxD1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
Start Bit
Stop Bit
Transmit
Write to Shift Register (UDATA1)
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD1
D7
Stop Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 20-7
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 1 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
375
20.7 Serial Port Mode 2 Function Description
In mode 2, 11 bits are transmitted through the TxD1 (P4.4) pin or received through the RxD1 (P4.5) pin.
The four components of each frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Programmable 9 data bit
x
Stop bit ("1")
th
th
The 9 data bit to be transmitted can be assigned a value of "0" or "1" by writing the TB8 bit (UART1CONH.3).
th
When receiving, the 9 data bit that it receives is written to the RB8 bit (UART1CONH.2), while the stop bit is
ignored. The baud rate for mode 2 is f U/16 clock frequency.
20.7.1 Mode 2 Transmit Procedure
The steps for Mode 2 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
th
3. Select mode 2 (9-bit UART) by setting UART1CONH bits 7 and 6 to "10B". Also, select the 9 data bit to be
transmitted by writing TB8 to "0" or "1".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register, UDATA1 (06H, page 8), to start the transmit operation.
20.7.2 Mode 2 Receive Procedure
The steps for Mode 2 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select mode 2 and set the receive enable bit (RE) in the UART1CONH register to "1".
4. The receive operation starts when the signal at the RxD1 (P4.5) pin goes to low level.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
376
Figure 20-8 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 2 operation.
Tx
Clock
Write to Shift Register (UDATA1)
TxD1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TB8
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start Bit
Transmit
Shift
Stop Bit
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD1
RB8
Stop
Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 20-8
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 2 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
377
20.8 Serial Port Mode 3 Function Description
In mode 3, 11 bits are transmitted through the TxD1 (P4.4) pin or received through the RxD1 (P4.5) pin. Mode 3 is
identical to mode 2 except for baud rate, which is variable.
The four components of each data frame are:
x
Start bit ("0")
x
8 data bits (LSB first)
x
Programmable 9 data bit
x
Stop bit ("1")
th
20.8.1 Mode 3 Transmit Procedure
The steps for Mode 3 transmit procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
th
3. Select mode 3 operation (9-bit UART) by setting UART1CONH bits 7 and 6 to "11B". Also, select the 9 data
bit to be transmitted by writing UART1CONH.3 (TB8) to "0" or "1".
4. Write transmission data to the shift register, UDATA1 (06H, page 8), to start the transmit operation.
20.8.2 Mode 3 Receive Procedure
The steps for Mode 3 receive procedure are:
1. Select the UART 1 clock, UART1CONL.3 and .2.
2. Set the UART 1 transmit parity-bit auto generation enable or disable bit (UART1CONL.7).
3. Select mode 3 and set the RE (Receive Enable) bit in the UART1CONH register to "1".
4. The receive operation will be started when the signal at the RxD1 (P4.5) pin goes to low level.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
378
Figure 20-9 illustrates the timing diagram for serial port Mode 3 operation.
Tx
Clock
Write to Shift Register (UDATA1)
TxD1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
TB8
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start Bit
Transmit
Shift
Stop Bit
TIP
Rx
Clock
RxD1
RB8
Stop
Bit
Receive
Bit Detect Sample Time
Shift
RIP
Figure 20-9
PS031201-0813
Timing Diagram for Serial Port Mode 3 Operation
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
20.9 Serial Communication for Multiprocessor Configurations
379
The S3F8-series multiprocessor communication feature enables a "master" S3F8S19/F8S15 to send a multipleframe serial message to a "slave" device in a multi- S3F8S19/F8S15 configuration. It does this without interrupting
other slave devices that may be on the same serial line.
th
This feature can be used only in UART modes 2 or 3. In these modes 2 and 3, 9 data bits are received. The 9 bit
value is written to RB8 (UART1CONH.2). The data receive operation is concluded with a stop bit. You can
program this function so that when the stop bit is received, the serial interrupt will be generated only if RB8 = "1".
To enable this feature, you should set the MCE bit in the UART1CONH register. When the MCE bit is "1", serial
data frames that are received with the ninth bit = "0" do not generate an interrupt. In this case, the ninth bit simply
separates the address from the serial data.
20.9.1 Sample Protocol for Master/Slave Interaction
When the master device wants to transmit a block of data to one of several slaves on a serial line, it first sends out
an address byte to identify the target slave. Note that in this case, an address byte differs from a data byte: In an
th
address byte, the 9 bit is "1" and in a data byte, it is "0".
The address byte interrupts all slaves so that each slave can examine the received byte and see if it is being
addressed. The addressed slave then clears its MCE bit and prepares to receive incoming data bytes.
The MCE bits of slaves that were not addressed remain set, and they continue operating normally while ignoring
the incoming data bytes.
While the MCE bit setting has no effect in mode 0, you can use it in mode 1 to check the validity of the stop bit.
For mode 1 reception, if MCE is "1", the receive interrupt will be issue unless a valid stop bit is received.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
380
20.9.2 Setup Procedure for Multiprocessor Communications
The steps to configure multiprocessor communications are:
1. Set all S3F8S19/F8S15 devices (masters and slaves) to UART 1 mode 2 or 3.
2. Write the MCE bit of all the slave devices to "1".
3. The transmission protocol of master device is:
First byte: the address identifying the target slave device (ninth bit = "1")
Next bytes: data (ninth = "0")
4. When the target slave receives the first byte, all of the slaves are interrupted because the ninth data bit is "1".
The targeted slave compares the address byte to its own address and then clears its MCE bit in order to
receive incoming data. The other slaves continue operating normally.
Figure 20-10 illustrates the connection example of multiprocessor serial data communications
Full-Duplex Multi-S3FS19 Interconnect
TxD1
RxD1
Master
TxD1
RxD1
Slave 1
S3F8S19
S3F8S19
Figure 20-10
PS031201-0813
TxD1
RxD1
Slave 2
S3F8S19
...
TxD1
RxD1
Slave n
S3F8S19
Connection Example for Multiprocessor Serial Data Communications
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
381
21
Embedded Flash Memory Interface
21.1 Overview
S3F8S19/F8S15 has an on-chip flash memory internally instead of masked ROM. The flash memory is accessed
by "LDC" instruction. This is a sector erasable and byte programmable flash. You can program the data in a flash
memory area any time.
The two operating features of 32/16 K byte memory of S3F8S19/F8S15 are:
x
Tool Program Mode (Refer to Chapter 25 "More Information")
x
User Program Mode
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
382
21.2 User Program Mode
This mode supports:
x
Sector erase
x
Byte programming
x
Byte read
x
Protection mode (Hard lock protection)
The read protection mode is available only in Tool Program mode. Therefore, to make a chip into read protection,
you must select a read protection option when you program by using a programming tool.
S3F8S19/F8S15 has the pumping circuit internally. Therefore, 12.5 V into Vpp (Test) pin is not needed. To
program a flash memory in this mode several control registers will be used.
There are four kinds of functions:
x
Programming
x
Reading
x
Sector erase
x
Hard lock protection
NOTE:
1.
The user program mode cannot be used when the CPU operates with the sub-system clock.
2.
Ensure to execute the DI instruction before starting user program mode. The user program mode verifies the interrupt
request register (IRQ). When an interrupt request is generated, user program mode stops.
3.
User program mode also stops by an interrupt request that it masks even in the DI status. To prevent this, disable the
interrupt by using the each peripheral interrupt enable bit.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
383
21.2.1 Flash Memory Control Register
Flash memory control register (FMCON) register is available only in user program mode to:
x
Select the Flash Memory operation mode
x
Select sector erase
x
Select byte programming
x
Make the flash memory into a hard lock protection
Figure 21-1 illustrates the flash memory control register.
Flash Memory Control Register (FMCON)
0BH, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
Flash memory mode selection bits:
0101 = Programming mode
1010 = Sector erase mode
0110 = Hard lock mode
Others = Not available
.3
.2
.0
LSB
Not used
Sector erase status bit:
0 = Success sector erase
1 = Fail sector erase
Figure 21-1
.1
Flash operation start bit:
0 = Operation stop bit
1 = Operation start bit
(This bit will be cleared automatically
just after the corresponding
operation completed.)
Flash Memory Control Register (FMCON)
The bit 0 of FMCON register (FMCON.0) is a start bit for Erase and Hard Lock operation mode. Therefore,
operation of Erase and Hard Lock mode is activated when you set FMCON.0 to "1". Erase (Sector erase) or hard
lock instruction need execution time. Therefore, you should insert wait time before a byte programming or a byte
read of same sector area by using "LDC" instruction. When you read or program a byte data from or into flash
memory, this bit is not needed to manipulate.
The sector erase status bit is read-only. If an interrupt is requested during the operation of "Sector erase", the
operation of "Sector erase" is discontinues, and the interrupt is served by CPU. Therefore, you should verify the
status bit after executing "Sector erase". The "sector erase" operation is successful when the bit is logic "0", and is
failure if the bit is logic "1".
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
384
21.2.2 Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register
The FMUSR register is used for a safety operation of the flash memory. This register protects undesired erase or
program operation from malfunctioning of CPU that is due to electrical noise.
After reset, the user-programming mode is disabled, because the value of FMUSR is "00000000B" by reset
operation. To operate the flash memory, you can use the user programming mode by setting the value of FMUSR
to "10100101B". If FMUSR is set to value other than "10100101b", User Program mode is disabled.
Figure 21-2 illustrates the flash memory user programming enable register.
Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR)
0AH, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Flash memory user programming enable bits:
10100101: Enable user programming mode
Other values: Disable user programming mode
Figure 21-2
PS031201-0813
Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
385
21.2.3 Flash Memory Sector Address Registers
There are two sector address registers for addressing a sector to be erased. The Flash Memory Sector Address
Register Low Byte (FMSECL) indicates the low byte of sector address. The Flash Memory Sector Address
Register High Byte (FMSECH) indicates the high byte of sector address. The FMSECH is needed for
S3F8S19/F8S15 because it has 128 sectors, respectively. One sector consists of 128 bytes. Each address of
sector starts with XX00H or XX80H, that is, a base address of sector is XX00H or XX80H. Therefore, FMSECL
register 6-0 does not indicate whether the value is "1" or "0".
It is recommend to load sector base address into FMSECH and FMSECL register. When programming the flash
memory, you should write data after loading sector base address located in the target address to write data into
FMSECH and FMSECL register.
If the next operation is also to write data, you should verify whether next address is located in the same sector or
not. In case of other sectors, you should load sector address to FMSECH and FMSECL register according to the
sector.
Figure 21-3 illustrates the flash memory sector address register high byte.
Flash Memory Sector Address Register (FMSECH)
08H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Flash Memory Setor Address (High Byte)
NOTE: The high-byte flash memory sector address pointer
value is the higher eight bits of the 16-bit pointer address.
Figure 21-3
Flash Memory Sector Address Register High Byte (FMSECH)
Figure 21-4 illustrates the flash memory sector address register low byte.
Flash Memory Sector Address Register (FMSECL)
09H, Page 8, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
.4
.3
.2
.1
.0
LSB
Don't care
Flash Memory Sector Address (Low Byte)
NOTE:
Figure 21-4
PS031201-0813
The low-byte flash memory sector address pointer
value is the lower eight bits of the 16-bit pointer address.
Flash Memory Sector Address Register Low Byte (FMSECL)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
386
21.3 ISP (On-Board Programming) Sector
ISP™ sectors located in program memory area can store On Board Program software (Boot program code for
upgrading application code by interfacing with I/O port pin). The ISP sectors cannot be erased or programmed by
LDC instruction for the safety of On Board Program software.
The ISP sectors are available only when the ISP enable/disable bit is set 0, that is, enable ISP at the Smart
Option. If you do not want to use ISP sector, you can use this area as a normal program memory (can erase or
program by LDC instruction) by setting ISP disable bit ("1") at the Smart Option. Even if ISP sector is selected,
ISP sector can be erased or programmed in the Tool Program mode by using Serial programming tools.
The size of ISP sector can vary by settings of Smart Option. You can select appropriate ISP sector size according
to the size of On Board Program software.
Figure 21-5 illustrates the program memory address space.
(Hex)
7FFFH
32767
(Decimal)
16383
(Hex)
3FFFH
32K-bytes
Internal
Program
Memory Area
255
16K-bytes
Internal
Program
Memory Area
8FFH
Available
ISP Sector Area
Interrupt Vector Area
Smart Option
FFH
255
Available
ISP Sector Area
Interrupt Vector Area
3FH
Smart Option
3CH
00H
0
PS031201-0813
FFH
3FH
3CH
00H
0
Byte
S3F8S19
Figure 21-5
8FFH
Byte
S3F8S15
Program Memory Address Space
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
387
Table 21-1 lists the ISP sector size.
Table 21-1
ISP Sector Size
Smart Option(003EH) ISP Size Selection Bit
Area of ISP Sector
ISP Sector Size
x
0
0
0
0
100H–1FFH (256 Byte)
256 Bytes
0
0
1
100H–2FFH (512 Byte)
512 Bytes
0
1
0
100H–4FFH (1024 Byte)
1024 Bytes
0
1
1
100H–8FFH (2048 Byte)
2048 Bytes
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
x
0
NOTE: The area of the ISP sector selected by Smart Option bit (003EH.2–003EH.0) cannot be erased and programmed by
LDC instruction in User Program mode.
21.4 ISP Reset Vector and ISP Sector Size
At the Smart Option, when you use ISP sectors by setting the ISP Enable/Disable bit to "0" and the Reset Vector
Selection bit to "0", you can select the reset vector address of CPU as listed in Table 21-2. You can do this by
setting the ISP Reset Vector Address Selection bits.
Table 21-2 lists the reset vector address.
Table 21-2
Smart Option (003EH)
ISP Reset Vector Address Selection Bit
Reset Vector Address
Reset Vector
Address After POR
Usable Area for
ISP Sector
ISP Sector Size
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
1
x
x
0100H
–
–
0
0
0
0200H
100H–1FFH
256 Bytes
0
0
1
0300H
100H–2FFH
512 Bytes
0
1
0
0500H
100H–4FFH
1024 Bytes
0
1
1
0900H
100H–8FFH
2048 Bytes
NOTE: The selection of the ISP reset vector address by Smart Option (003EH.7–003EH.5) does not depend on the selection
of ISP sector size by Smart Option (003EH.2–003EH.0).
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
388
21.5 Sector Erase
You can erase a flash memory partially by using sector erase function only in User Program Mode. The only unit
of flash memory that you can erase or program in User Program Mode is called sector.
The program memory of S3F8S19/F8S15 is divided into 128 sectors for unit of erase and programming,
respectively. Every sector has all 128 byte sizes of program memory areas. Therefore, you should erase each
sector first to program a new data (byte) into a sector. It requires minimum 10ms delay time for erase after setting
sector address and triggering erase start bit (FMCON.0). Tool Program Modes (MDS mode tool or Programming
tool) does not supports sector erase.
Figure 21-6 illustrates the sector configurations in user program mode.
Work in sub
operating mode
Switch to main
operating mode
Flash user
programming
operation
Figure 21-6
Sector Configurations in User Program Mode
Figure 21-7 illustrates the flash operation sequence in sub operating mode.
Work in sub
operating mode
Switch to main
operating mode
Flash user
programming
operation
Figure 21-7
PS031201-0813
Flash Operation Sequence in Sub Operating Mode
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
389
The Sector program procedure in User program Mode
1. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "10100101B".
2. Set Flash Memory Sector Address Register (FMSECH/ FMSECL).
3. Set Flash Memory Control Register (FMCON) to "10100001B".
4. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "00000000B".
5. Verify the "Sector erase status bit" whether "Sector erase" is successful or not.
Example 21-1 shows the sector erase.
Example 21-1
Sector Erase
x
x
AND
reErase:
OSCCON, #0F6H
; If work in sub operating mode, need to switch to main
operating mode
LD
PP, #88H
LD
FMUSR, #0A5H
LD
FMSECH, #10H
LD
FMSECL, #00H
; Set sector address (1000H-107FH)
LD
NOP
FMCON, #10100001B
; Start sector erase
; Dummy Instruction, This instruction must be needed
LD
TM
JR
FMUSR, #0
FMCON, #00001000B
NZ, reErase
; User Program mode disable
; Check "Sector erase status bit"
; Jump to reErase if fail
LD
PP, #00H
NOP
PS031201-0813
; User Program mode enable
; Dummy Instruction, This instruction must be needed
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
390
21.6 Programming
A flash memory is programmed in 1 byte unit after sector erase. And programming for safety sake, you should set
FMSECH and FMSECL to flash memory sector value.
The write operation of programming starts by "LDC" instruction. You can write until 128 byte because the limit of
flash sector is 128 byte. Therefore when you write 128 byte, you should reset FMSECH and FMSECL.
The Program procedure in User program Mode
1. Ensure to erase sector before programming.
2. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "10100101B".
3. Set Flash Memory Control Register (FMCON) to "01010001B".
4. Set Flash Memory Sector Register (FMSECH, FMSECL) to sector value of write address.
5. Load a transmission data into a working register.
6. Load a flash memory upper address into upper register of pair working register.
7. Load a flash memory lower address into lower register of pair working register.
8. Load transmission data to flash memory location area on "LDC" instruction by indirectly addressing mode.
9. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "00000000B".
Example 21-2 shows the program procedure.
Example 21-2
Program
x
x
AND
OSCCON, #0F6H
LD
PP, #88H
; If work in sub operating mode, need to switch to main
operating mode
LD
FMSECH, #17H
LD
FMSECL, #80H
; Set sector address (1780H-17FFH)
; Set a ROM address in the same sector 1780H–17FFH
LD
r2, #17H
LD
r3, #84H
LD
r4, #78H
; Temporary data
; User Program mode enable
LD
FMUSR, #0A5H
LD
FMCON, #01010001B
; Start program
LDC
@rr2, r4
; Write the data to an address of same sector (1784H)
LD
FMUSR, #0
; User Program mode disable
LD
PP, #00H
NOP
PS031201-0813
; Dummy Instruction, This instruction must be needed
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
391
21.7 Reading
The read operation of programming starts by 'LDC' instruction.
The Program procedure in User program Mode
1. Load a flash memory upper address into upper register of pair working register.
2. Load a flash memory lower address into lower register of pair working register.
3. Load receives data from flash memory location area on 'LDC' instruction by indirectly addressing mode.
Example 21-3 shows the read operation.
Example 21-3
Reading
x
x
LOOP:
AND
OSCCON, #0F6H
LD
PP, #88H
LD
R2, #3H
; load flash memory upper address to upper of pair
working register
LD
R3, #0
; load flash memory lower address to lower pair working
register
LDC
R0, @RR2
; read data from flash memory location
(Between 300H and 3FFH)
INC
R3
CP
R3, #0H
JP
NZ, LOOP
LD
PP, #00H
; If work in sub operating mode, need to switch to main
operating mode
x
x
x
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
392
21.8 Hard Lock Protection
You can set Hard Lock Protection by writing "0110" in FMCON7-4. If this function is enabled, then you cannot
write or erase the data in a flash memory area. This protection can be released by the chip erase execution (in the
tool program mode or user program mode). In terms of user program mode, the procedure of setting Hard Lock
Protection is following chip erase execution. Whereas in tool mode, the manufacturer of the serial tool writer
supports hardware Protection. Refer to the manual of serial program writer tool that the manufacturer provides for
more information.
The Program procedure in User program Mode
1. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "10100101B".
2. Set Flash Memory Control Register (FMCON) to "01100001B".
3. Set Flash Memory User Programming Enable Register (FMUSR) to "00000000B".
Example 21-4 shows the hard lock protection.
Example 21-4
Hard Lock Protection
x
x
AND
OSCCON, #0F6H
; If work in sub operating mode, need to switch to main
operating mode
LD
PP, #88H
LD
FMUSR, #0A5H
; User Program mode enable
LD
FMCON, #01100001B
; Hard Lock mode set & start
NOP
; Dummy Instruction, This instruction must be needed
LD
FMUSR, #0
LD
PP, #00H
; User Program mode disable
x
x
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
393
22
Low Voltage Detect and Low Voltage Reset
22.1 Low Voltage Reset
You can select internal RESET (LVR) or external RESET by using smart option (3FH.7 in ROM).
You can reset S3F8S39/38/35/34 in four ways:
x
By external power-on-reset
x
By the external reset input pin pulled low
x
By the digital watchdog timing out
x
By the Low Voltage reset circuit (LVR)
During an external power-on reset, the voltage VDD is High level and the RESETB pin is forced Low level. The
RESETB signal is input through a Schmitt trigger circuit where it is synchronized with the CPU clock. This brings
the S3F8S19/F8S15 into a known operating status. To ensure correct start-up, you should ensure that reset signal
is not released before the VDD level is sufficient to allow MCU operation at the chosen frequency.
You should hold nRESET pin to low level for a minimum time interval after the power supply comes within
tolerance to allow time for internal CPU clock oscillation to stabilize.
When a reset occurs during normal operation (with both VDD and RESETB at High level), it forces the signal at the
nRESET pin to Low and the reset operation starts. All system and peripheral control registers are then set to their
default hardware reset values (see Table 8-1).
The MCU provides a watchdog timer function to ensure graceful recovery from software malfunction. If it does not
refresh watchdog timer before it reaches end-of-counter condition (overflow), then it activates the internal reset.
The S3F8S19/F8S15 has a built-in low voltage reset circuit. It provides detection of power voltage drop of external
VDD input level to prevent MCU from malfunctioning in an unstable MCU power level. This voltage detector works
for the reset operation of MCU. This low voltage reset includes an analog comparator and Vref circuit. Hardware
internally sets the value of a detection voltage. The on-chip Low Voltage Reset, features static reset when supply
voltage is below a reference voltage value (Typical 1.9/2.3/3.0/3.9 V). This feature can remove external reset
circuit while keeping the application safe. As long as the supply voltage is below the reference value, an internal
static RESET will be triggered. The MCU can start only when the supply voltage rises over the reference voltage.
When you calculate power consumption, remember that a static current of LVR circuit should be added a CPU
operating current in any operating modes such as Stop, Idle, and normal RUN mode.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
394
Figure 22-1 illustrates the low voltage reset circuit.
Watchdog nRESET
nRESET
N.F
Internal System
nRESET
Longger than 1us
VDD
VIN
VREF
+
Comparator
-
When the VDD level
is lower than VLVR
N.F
Longger than 1us
VDD
VREF
BGR
NOTES: BGR is Band Gap voltage Reference
Figure 22-1
Low Voltage Reset Circuit
NOTE: To program the duration of the oscillation stabilization interval, make the appropriate settings to the basic timer control
register, BTCON, before entering Stop mode. Also, if you do not want to use the basic timer watchdog function (which
causes a system reset if a basic timer counter overflow occurs); disable it by writing "1010B" to the upper nibble of
BTCON.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
395
22.2 Low Voltage Detect
The S3F8S19/F8S15 micro-controller has a built-in Low Voltage Detector (LVD) circuit, which allows LVD interrupt
and LVD_FLAG detection of power voltage. The S3F8S19/F8S15 has four options in LVD voltage level according
to the LVDCON register (Refer to Figure 22-3 for more information).
x
Low voltage detect level Flag Bit (LVD_FLAG): 2.1 V, 2.5 V, 3.2V, 4.1 V (Typ) r 100 mV
LVD block can be enabled or disabled by LVDCON.7. If you enable the LVD interrupt, when VDD < VLVD, an
LVD interrupt generates.
The LVD block of S3F8S19/F8S15 consists of one comparator and a resistor string. The comparator is for LVD
detection.
The comparator's output makes LVD indicator flag bit "1" or "0". That is used to indicate low voltage level. When
the power voltage is below the LVD level, the bit 5 of LVDCON register is set "1". When the power voltage is
above the LVD level, the bit 5 of LVDCON register is set "0" automatically. You can use LVDCON.5 flag bit to
indicate low battery in applications.
Figure 22-2 illustrates the block diagram of low voltage detect (LVD).
Resistor String
VDIV_Flag1~4
MUX
VIN
Comparator
IPOR/LVD Control Bit
VREF
LVDCON.1-.0
Bias
STOP
BANDGAP
Figure 22-2
PS031201-0813
Low Voltage Detect (LVD) Block Diagram
PRELIMINARY
LVDCON.5
(LVD Flag Bit)
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
396
Figure 22-3 illustrates the flash low voltage detect control register (LVDCON).
LVD Control Register (LVDCON)
FBH, BANK1, R/W
MSB
.7
.6
.5
LVD Enable/Disable Bit :
0 = LVD disable
Not used
1 = LVD enable
.4
.3
.2
PS031201-0813
.0
LSB
Detection Voltage Level Selection Bits:
00
01
10
11
LVD Output Bit (Read Only):
0 = VDD > VLVD
Not used
1 = VDD < VLVD
LVD Interrupt Enable/Disable Bit
0 = Disable LVD interrupt
1 = Enable LVD interrupt
Figure 22-3
.1
VLVD = 4.1V
VLVD = 3.2V
VLVD = 2.5V
VLVD = 2.1V
Flash Low Voltage Detect Control Register (LVDCON)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
397
23
Electrical Data
23.1 Overview
This section includes the electrical characteristics of S3F8S19/F8S15, namely:
x
Absolute maximum ratings
x
Direct Current (D.C.)electrical characteristics
x
Alternate current (A.C.)electrical characteristics
x
Input timing measurement points
x
Oscillator characteristics
x
Oscillation stabilization time
x
Operating voltage range
x
Schmitt trigger input characteristics
x
Data retention supply voltage in stop mode
x
Stop mode release timing when initiated by a RESET
x
Analog-to-digital (A/D) converter electrical characteristics
x
Liquid Cristal Display (LCD) cap bias characteristics
x
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) characteristics
x
Low Voltage Reset (LVR) circuit characteristics
x
LVR reset timing
x
Low Voltage Detect (LVD)circuit characteristics
x
Full-Flash memory characteristics
x
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD)Characteristics
This section presents these characteristics in tables and graphs.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
398
23.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 23-1 lists the absolute maximum ratings.
Table 23-1
Absolute Maximum Ratings
(TA = 25 qC)
Parameter
Supply voltage
Symbol
Conditions
Rating
VDD
–
– 0.3 to + 6.5
Input voltage
VI
All ports
– 0.3 to VDD + 0.3
Output voltage
VO
All output ports
– 0.3 to VDD + 0.3
IOH
One Input/Output (I/O) pin
active
– 25
All I/O pins active
– 80
One I/O pin active
+ 30
All I/O pins active
+ 100
Output current high
Output current low
IOL
Operating temperature
TA
–
– 40 to + 85
TSTG
–
– 65 to +150
Storage temperature
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Unit
V
mA
qC
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
399
23.3 DC Electrical Characteristics
Table 23-2 lists the DC electrical characteristics.
Table 23-2
DC Electrical Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Operating voltage
Vdd
Main crystal or
ceramic frequency
fmain
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC
1.8
–
5.5
V
VDD = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
0.4
–
12
VDD = 1.8 V to 2.7 V
0.4
–
4
–
VDD
–
1.8
VIH1
Ports 0, 3
VIH2
Ports 1, 2, 4
and RESET
VIH3
XIN
VIH4
XTIN
VIL1
Ports 0, 3
VIL2
Ports 1, 2, 4
and RESET
VIL3
XIN and XTIN
Output high
voltage
VOH
IOH = – 1 mA
Ports 0, 1, 2, 3, 4
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
VDD –1.0
–
–
Output low voltage
VOL
IOL = 15 mA
Ports 0, 1, 2, 3, 4
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
–
0.4
2.0
Input high leakage
current
ILIH1
All input except ILIH2
VIN = VDD
ILIH2
XIN, XTIN
VIN = VDD
–
–
Input low leakage
current
ILIL1
All input except ILIL2
VIN = 0 V
ILIL2
XIN, XTIN
VIN = 0 V
–
–
Output high
leakage current
ILOH
All output pins
VOUT = VDD
–
–
2
Output low
leakage current
ILOL
All output pins
VOUT = 0 V
–
–
–2
RP1
VIN = 0 V,
Ports 0,1, 2, 3, 4
VDD = 5 V
TA = 25 qC
25
50
100
RP2
VIN = 0 V
nReset
VDD = 5 V
TA = 25 qC
125
250
500
Run mode
12MHz CPU clock
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
–
2.2
4
Run mode
4 MHz CPU clock
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
–
1.2
2
Run mode
4 MHz CPU clock
VDD = 3.0 V
–
0.8
1.5
Idle mode
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
–
1.3
2
Input high voltage
Input low voltage
Pull-up resistors
Supply current
IDD1
IDD2
PS031201-0813
MHz
0.8 VDD
VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V
0.7 VDD
VDD – 0.1
–
0.2 VDD
V
VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V
–
–
0.3 VDD
0.1
1
20
–1
– 20
PA
k:
mA
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Parameter
Symbol
IDD3
IDD4
Conditions
12 MHz CPU clock
Min.
Max.
0.8
1.5
Idle mode
4 MHz CPU clock
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 V
Idle mode
4 MHz CPU clock
VDD = 3.0V
–
0.4
0.8
VDD = 3.0 V
–
10
16
VDD = 3.0 V
(Cap bias LCD on)
–
15
25
VDD = 3.0 V
–
2.5
8
VDD = 3.0 V
(Cap bias LCD on)
–
6
14
0.6
4.5
1
5
30
60
Sub-Run
Sub-Idle
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
IDD5
Typ.
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
(Ring OSC on,
STOP Wake-up
Timer on)
Stop mode
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
(LVR enable)
–
400
Unit
NOTE:
1.
Supply current does not include current drawn through internal pull-up resistors, LCD voltage dividing resistors, ADC
block, the LVR block, LVD block, and external output current loads.
2.
IDD1 and IDD2 include power consumption for sub clock oscillation.
3.
IDD3 and IDD4 are current when main clock oscillation stops and the sub clock issued.
4.
IDD5 is current when main and sub clock oscillation stops.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
PA
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
401
23.4 AC Electrical Characteristics
Table 23-3 lists the AC electrical characteristics.
Table 23-3
AC Electrical Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
Interrupt input high, low width
tINTH
tINTL
INT0-INT7
VDD = 5 V r 10 %
500
–
–
ns
RESET input low width
tRSL
Input
VDD = 5 V r 10 %
10
–
–
Ps
Figure 23-1 illustrates the input timing measurement points.
tINT L
tINT H
0.8 VDD
XIN
0.2 VDD
Figure 23-1
PS031201-0813
Input Timing Measurement Points
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
402
23.5 Oscillator Characteristics
Table 23-4 lists the oscillator characteristics.
Table 23-4
Oscillator Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Oscillator
Main crystal or ceramic
Clock Circuit
C1
XIN
C2
XOUT
XIN
External clock
(Main System)
XOUT
Tolerance of internal
RC oscillator
(8/4/2/0.5 MHz)
–
Internal Ring oscillator
(OSC)
–
External sub crystal
–
External RC oscillator
–
Test Condition
Min.
Typ.
Max.
VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V
0.4
–
12
VDD 1 = 1.8 to 2.7 V
0.4
–
4
MH
z
VDD = 2.7 to .5 V
0.4
–
12
VDD = 1.8 to 2.7 V
0.4
–
4
TA = 25 qC
VDD= 1.8 to 5.0V
–
r 0.5
r1
TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC
–
–
r 3.5
16.384
32.768
49.152
–
32.768
–
–
4
–
VDD = 5 V, TA = 25 qC
–
VDD = 5 V
NOTE:
1.
Refer to the figure of Operating Voltage Range for more information.
2.
For user calibration of internal RC oscillator, refer to Chapter 7 for more information.
PS031201-0813
Unit
PRELIMINARY
%
KHz
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
403
Table 23-5 lists the oscillation stabilization point.
Table 23-5
Oscillation Stabilization Time
(TA = – 40 °C to + 85 °C, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Oscillator
Main crystal
Main ceramic
External clock
(main system)
Oscillator stabilization
wait time
Test Condition
Min.
Typ.
Max.
fOSC > 1.0 MHz
Oscillation stabilization occurs when VDD is equal
to the minimum oscillator voltage range.
–
–
20
–
–
10
XIN input high and low width (tXH, tXL)
25
–
500
tWAIT when released by a reset (1)
–
2 /fOSC
–
–
–
–
–
–
10
tWAIT when released by an interrupt
Sub oscillator
stabilization time
(2)
–
19
Unit
ms
ns
ms
s
NOTE:
1.
fOSC is the oscillator frequency.
2.
The duration of the oscillator stabilization wait time, tWAIT, when it is released by an interrupt. is determined by the settings
in the basic timer control register, BTCON.
Figure 23-2 illustrates the operating voltage range.
CPU Clock
12 MHz
8 MHz
4 MHz
..
3 MHz
2 MHz
0.4 MHz
1
1.8
2.7
4 4.5 5 5.5 6
Supply Voltage (V)
Figure 23-2
PS031201-0813
Operating Voltage Range
PRELIMINARY
7
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
404
Table 23-6 lists the data retention supply voltage in stop mode.
Table 23-6
Data Retention Supply Voltage in Stop Mode
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Conditions
Data retention supply voltage
VDDDR
Stop mode
Data retention supply current
IDDDR
Stop mode; VDDDR = 2.0 V
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
1.0
–
5.5
V
–
–
1
PA
NOTE: Supply current does not include current drawn through internal pull-up resistors or external output current loads.
Figure 23-3 illustrates the stop mode release timing when reset initiates it.
~~
Stop
Mode
Execution Of
Stop Instruction
RESET
Oscillator
Stabilization
Time
Data Retention
Mode
~~
VDD
RESET
Occurs
Normal
Operating
Mode
VDDDR
t WAIT
NOTE:
t WAIT is the same as 4096 x 128 x 1/fOSC
Figure 23-3
PS031201-0813
Stop Mode Release Timing When Initiated by a RESET
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
405
Table 23-7 lists the A/D converter electrical characteristics.
Table 23-7
A/D Converter Electrical Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Test Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
bit
Resolution
–
–
–
10
–
Total accuracy
–
VDD = 5.12 V
CPU clock = 10 MHz
VSS = 0 V
–
–
r 3 (1)
Integral linearity error
ILE
–
–
–
r2
Differential linearity error
DLE
–
–
–
r1
Offset error of top
EOT
–
–
r1
r3
Offset error of bottom
EOB
–
–
r1
r3
Conversion time (2)
T0ON
–
–
20
–
Ps
Analog input voltage
VIAN
–
VSS
–
VDD
V
Analog input impedance
RAN
–
2
1000
–
M:
Analog input current
IADIN
–
–
10
PA
0.5
1.5
0.15
0.45
100
500
VDD = 5 V
VDD = 5 V
Analog block current
(3)
IADC
VDD = 3 V
VDD = 5 V
power down mode
–
–
NOTE:
1.
The total accuracy is 3LSB (maximum) at VDD = 2.7 V–5.5 V, It is for design guidance only and are not tested in
production.
2.
"Conversion time" is the time required from the moment a conversion operation starts until it ends.
3.
IADC is operating current during A/D conversion.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
LSB
mA
nA
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
406
Table 23-8 lists the capacitor bias electrical characteristics.
Table 23-8
Capacitor Bias Electrical Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC at VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
VLC3
Liquid crystal
drive voltage
Conditions
Connects a 0.1 PF
load capacitor
between VLC3 and VSS
(No panel load)
Min.
Typ.
LMOD.2-.0 = 0
0.90
LMOD.2-.0 = 1
0.95
LMOD.2-.0 = 2
1.00
LMOD.2-.0 = 3
LMOD.2-.0 = 4
Typical u
0.85
1.05
1.10
LMOD.2-.0 = 5
1.15
LMOD.2-.0 = 6
1.20
LMOD.2-.0 = 7
1.25
Max.
Typical u
1.15
V
VLC2
Connects a 0.1 PF load capacitor between
VLC2 and VSS (No panel load)
2 u VLC3
u 0.9
–
2 u VLC3
u 1.1
VLC1
Connects a 0.1 PF load capacitor between
VLC1 and VSS (No panel load)
3 u VLC3
u 0.9
–
3 u VLC3
u 1.1
VLC0
Connects a 0.1 PF load capacitor between
VLC0 and VSS (No panel load)
4 u VLC3
u 0.9
–
4 u VLC3
u 1.1
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Unit
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
407
Table 23-9 lists the UART timing characteristics in mode 0 (10 MHz).
Table 23-9
UART Timing Characteristics in Mode 0 (10 MHz)
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC, 1.8 V to 5.5 V, Load capacitance = 80 pF)
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Serial port clock cycle time
tSCK
500
T0PU u 6
700
Output data setup to clock rising edge
tS1
300
T0PU u 5
–
Clock rising edge to input data valid
tS2
–
–
300
Output data hold after clock rising edge
tH1
T0PU – 50
T0PU
–
Input data hold after clock rising edge
tH2
0
–
–
Serial port clock high, low-level width
tHIGH, tLOW
200
T0PU u 3
400
NOTE:
1.
All timings are in nanoseconds (ns) and assume a 10 MHz CPU clock frequency.
2.
The unit T0PU means one CPU clock period.
Figure 23-4 illustrates the waveform for UART timing characteristics.
tSCK
tHIGH
tLOW
0.8 VDD
0.2 VDD
Figure 23-4
Waveform for UART Timing Characteristics
Figure 23-5 illustrates the LVR reset timing.
VDD
VLVR,MAX
VLVR
VLVR,MIN
Figure 23-5
PS031201-0813
LVR Reset Timing
PRELIMINARY
Unit
ns
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
408
Table 23-10 lists the flash memory AC electrical characteristics.
Table 23-10
Flash Memory AC Electrical Characteristics
(TA = – 40 qC to + 85 qC at VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Flash Erase/Write/Read Voltage
Fewrv
Programming time (1)
Chip Erasing time
Conditions
VDD
Ftp
(2)
Ftp1
Sector Erasing time (3)
Ftp2
Data Access Time
FtRS
Number of writing/erasing
Data Retention
–
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
1.8
5.0
5.5
V
20
–
30
Ps
32
–
70
4
–
12
–
250
–
ns
VDD = 2.0V
FNwe
–
10,000
–
–
Times
Ftdr
–
10
–
–
Years
NOTE:
1.
The programming time is the time during which one byte (8-bit) is programmed.
2.
The Chip erasing time is the time during which entire program memory is erased.
3.
The Sector erasing time is the time during which all 128 byte block is erased.
4.
The chip erasing is available in Tool Program Mode only.
Figure 23-6 illustrates the circuit diagram to improve EFT characteristics.
104
VSS
VDD
S3F8S19
Figure 23-6
The Circuit Diagram to Improve EFT Characteristics
NOTE: To improve EFT characteristics, use power capacitor near S3F8S19/F8S15 as illustrated in Figure 23-6.
PS031201-0813
ms
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
409
Table 23-11 lists the ESD characteristics.
Table 23-11
Parameter
Electrostatic discharge
Symbol
VESD
ESD Characteristics
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
HBM
2000
–
–
MM
200
–
–
CDM
500
–
–
Min.
Typ.
Max.
4.0
4.1
4.2
3.1
3.2
3.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.0
2.1
2.2
Min.
Typ.
Max.
3.8
3.9
4.0
2.9
3.0
3.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
1.8
1.9
2.0
Unit
V
Table 23-12 lists the LVD circuit characteristics.
Table 23-12
LVD Circuit Characteristics
(TA = – 40 to 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Conditions
VLVD0
LVD Detect Voltage
VLVD1
–
VLVD2
VLVD3
Unit
V
Table 23-13 lists the LVR circuit characteristics.
Table 23-13
LVR Circuit Characteristics
(TA = – 40 to 85 qC, VDD = 1.8 V to 5.5 V)
Parameter
Symbol
Conditions
VLVR0
LVR Detect Voltage
VLVR1
VLVR2
–
VLVR3
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Unit
V
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
410
24
Mechanical Data
24.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 is available in these packages:
x
48-pin Quad Flat Package (QFP) (Samsung: 48-QFP-1010E)
Package dimensions are illustrated in Figure 24-1.
Figure 24-1 illustrates the package dimensions of 48-pin Quad Flat Package (QFP) (Samsung: 48-QFP-1010E).
13.20 r0.30
0-8
10.00
10.00
48-QFP-1010E
+ 0.10
- 0.05
0.10 MAX
0.80-0.20
13.20 r0.30
0.15
#48
#1
+ 0.07
0.33 - 0.03
0.75
0.15 MAX
0.05 MIN
(0.88)
2.05
r0.10
2.30 MAX
NOTE: Dimensions are in millimeters.
Figure 24-1
PS031201-0813
48-QFP-1010E Package Dimensions
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
411
25
S3F8S19/F8S15 Flash MCU
25.1 Overview
The S3F8S19/F8S15 single-chip CMOS microcontroller is the Flash MCU. It has an on-chip Flash MCU Read
Only Memory (ROM). The Flash ROM is accessed by serial data format.
NOTE: This chapter is about the Tool Program Mode of Flash MCU. Refer to Chapter 21 Embedded Flash Memory Interface,
to know more information about the User Program Mode.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
412
25.2 Pin Assignments
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
P4.6/TXD0/SEG20
P4.5/RXD1/SEG19
P4.4/SEG18/TXD1
P4.3/SEG17/TAOUT/TACAP
P4.2/SEG16/TACLK
P4.1/SEG15/TBOUT
P4.0/SEG14/T0OUT
P3.7/SEG13/INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP
P3.6/SEG12/INT6/T1CLK/SCL
P3.5/SEG11/INT5/T2CLK/SDA
P3.4/SEG10/INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP
P3.3/SEG9/NSS
Figure 25-1 illustrates the S3F8S19/F8S15 pin assignments.
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
S3F8S19/F8S15
(48-QFP)
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
P3.2/SEG8/SCK
P3.1/SEG7/MOSI
P3.0/SEG6/MISO
P2.7/COM7/SEG5
P2.6/COM6/SEG4
P2.5/COM5/SEG3
P2.4/COM4/SEG2
P2.3/COM3/SEG1
P2.2/COM2/SEG0
P2.1/COM1
P2.0/COM0
nRESET
ADC4/P0.4
INT3/ADC3/P0.3
INT2/ADC2/P0.2
INT1/ADC1/((SDAT)/P0.1
INT0/BUZ/ADC0/((SCLK)/P0.0
VDD
VSS
XOUT
XIN
(V
VPP)TEST
XTIN
XTOUT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
RXD0/SEG21/P4.7
CA/P1.0
CB/P1.1
VLC0/P1.2
VLC1/P1.3
VLC2/P1.4
VLC3/P1.5
ADC8/P1.6
ADC9/P1.7
ADC7/P0.7
ADC6/P0.6
ADC5/P0.5
Figure 25-1
PS031201-0813
S3F8S19/F8S15 Pin Assignments (48-QFP-1010E)
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Table 25-1 describes the pins used to read/write the flash in tool program mode.
Table 25-1
413
Descriptions of Pins Used to Read/Write the Flash in Tool Program mode
Normal Chip
During Programming
Pin Name
Pin Name
Pin No.
I/O
Function
P0.1
SDAT
4
I/O
Serial data pin.
Output port when reading and input port when writing. Can be
assigned as an input or push-pull output port.
P0.0
SCLK
5
I
Serial clock pin. Input only pin.
TEST
Vpp
10
I
Tool mode selection when TEST/Vpp pin sets Logic value "1".
When you use the flash writer tool mode (ex.spw2+ etc}), you
should connect TEST/VPP pin to VDD. (S3F8S19/F8S15
supplies high voltage 11 V by internal high voltage generation
circuit.)
nRESET
nRESET
13
I
Chip Initialization
VDD, VSS
VDD, VSS
6
7
–
Power supply pin for logic circuit.
You should tie VDD to 5.0 V during programming.
Test Pin Voltage
The TEST pin on socket board for MTP writer must be connected to VDD (5.0 V) with RC delay as illustrated in
Figure 25-2 (only when SPW 2+ and GW-pro2 are used). The TEST pin on socket board must not be connected
Vpp (5.0 V) which is generated from MTP Writer. Therefore, when you write or erase using MTP writer, you should
use the specific socket board for S3F8S39/38/35/34.
Figure 25-2 illustrates the RC delay circuit.
VDD
R (330ȳ)
}ww
C (0.1uF)
Figure 25-2
PS031201-0813
RC Delay Circuit
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
414
25.3 On Board Writing
The S3F8S19/F8S15 needs only 6 signal lines that include VDD and VSS pins for writing internal flash memory with
serial protocol. Therefore, the on-board writing is possible if the writing signal lines are considered when the PCB
of application board is designed.
25.3.1 Circuit Design Guide
At the flash writing, the writing tool needs 6 signal lines that are VSS, VDD, nRESET, TEST, SDAT and SCLK.
When you design the PCB circuits, you should consider the usage of these signal lines for the on-board writing.
In case of TEST pin, normally test pin is connected to VSS, but in writing mode, a resistor should be inserted
between the TEST pin and VSS. You should treat nRESET, SDAT, and SCLK under the same consideration.
You should be careful to design the circuit that these signal pins relate because rising/falling timing of VPP, SCLK,
and SDAT is very important for proper programming.
Figure 25-3 illustrates the PCB design guide for on board programming.
G
R
SCLK
R
SDAT
R
nRESET
R
VPP
To Application circuit
SCLK(I/O)
SDAT(I/O)
To Application circuit
nRESET
To Application circuit
VPP(TEST)
C VPP
C nRESET
VDD
VPP
SDAT
VSS
VDD
nRESET
SCLK
C nRESET and C VPP are used to
improve the noise effect.
GND
IVCREF
0.1uF
C
SPW-uni , GW-uni , AS-pro, US-pro
Figure 25-3
PS031201-0813
PCB Design Guide for on Board Programming
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
415
25.3.2 Reference Table for Connection
Table 25-2 describes the reference table for connection.
Table 25-2
Reference Table for Connection
Pin Name
I/O Mode in Applications
Resistor (Need)
VPP (TEST)
Input
Yes
RVpp is 10 k: to 50 k:.
CVpp is 0.01 PF to 0.02 PF.
nRESET
Input
Yes
RnRESET is 2 k: to 5 k:.
CnRESET is 0.01 PF to 0.02 PF.
Input
Yes
RSDAT is 2 k: to 5 k:.
Output
No (NOTE)
Input
Yes
Output
No (NOTE)
SDAT (I/O)
SCLK (I/O)
Required Value
–
RSCLK is 2 k: to 5 k:.
–
NOTE: In the on-board writing mode, very high-speed signal will be provided to pin SCLK and SDAT. It also causes some
damages to the application circuits connected to SCLK or SDAT port if the application circuit is designed as highspeed response such as relay control circuit. If possible, set the Input/Output (I/O) configuration of SDAT, SCLK pins
to input mode.
The value of R, C in this table is a recommended value. It varies with circuit of system.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
416
26
Development Tools
26.1 Overview
Samsung provides a powerful and easy-to-use development support system on a turnkey basis. The development
support system consists of a host system, debugging tools, and supporting software. For a host system, you can
use any standard computer that employs Win95/98/2000/XP as its operating system. Samsung provides
sophisticated debugging tool both in hardware and software: the powerful in-circuit emulator, OPENice-i500/i2000
and SK-1200, for the S3F7-, S3F9-and S3F8- microcontroller families. Samsung also offers supporting software
that includes debugger, an assembler, and a program for setting options.
26.1.1 Target Boards
Target boards are available for all the S3C8/S3F8-series microcontrollers. All the target system cables and
adapters that user requires, it includes on the device-specific target board. TB8S19/8S28/8S39 is a specific target
board for the development of application systems using S3F8S19/F8S15.
26.1.2 Programming Socket Adapter
When you program S3F8S19/F8S15's flash memory by using an emulator or OTP/MTP writer, you require a
specific programming socket adapter for S3F8S19/F8S15.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
417
[Development System Configuration]
Figure 26-1 illustrates the development system configuration.
IBM-PC AT or Compatible
RS-232C / USB
Emulator [ SK-1200(RS-232,USB) or OPENIce I-500(RS-232) or
OPENIce I-2000(RS-232,USB)]
Target
Application
System
OTP/MTP Writer Block
RAM Break/Display Block
Bus
Probe
Adapter
Trace/Timer Block
SAM8 Base Block
POD
TB8S19/8S28/8S39
Target
Board
Power Supply Block
Figure 26-1
PS031201-0813
Development System Configuration
PRELIMINARY
EVA
Chip
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
418
26.1.2.1 TB8S19/8S28/8S39 Target Board
The TB8S19/8S28/8S39 target board is used for the S3F8S19/F8S15/8S28/8S24/8S39 microcontrollers. The
TB8S19/8S28/8S39 target board is operated as target CPU with Emulator (OPENIce I-500/2000, SK-1200).
Figure 26-2 illustrates the TB8S19/8S28/8S39 target board configuration.
TB8S19/8S28/8S39
Idle
Stop
+
+
VDD
On
U2
Off
CON3
To User_VDD
JP5
0
S3F8S19/39 S3F8S28 S3F8S19
S3F8S39
JP4
JP2
Chip Select Jumper
25
32 1
1
100-Pin Connector
EVA Mode
8S19 Sub.CLK
38
1
Y2
1
S1
50-Pin Connector
208 QFP
S3E8S30
EVA Chip
U1
Emulator
Interfalce
16
Y1
Main Mode
48
24 1
24-Pin Connector
PWM
14
50-Pin Connector
Enable Diasble
JP13
3F.7
3F.6
3F.5
3F.4
3F.3
3F.2
3F.1
3F.0
3E.7
3E.6
3E.5
3E.4
3E.3
3E.2
3E.1
3E.0
RESET
0
SW2
SW3
ON
GND
ON
SW1
15
S3F8S28 Target
System Interface
S3
17
S3F8S28
EX.CLK Jumper
Board Clock
JP10
JP5
SMDS2
JP10
JP9
S3F8S39
EX.CLK Jumper
SMDS2+
JP1
Figure 26-2
PS031201-0813
JP8
JP6
JP7
S3F8S19
EX.CLK Jumper
24
S3F8S39 Target
System Interface
S4
25
S3F8S19 Target
System Interface
S2
TB8S19/8S28/8S39 Target Board Configuration
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
419
Table 26-1 describes the UART 1 low byte control register.
Table 26-1
Symbols
UART 1 Low Byte Control Register (UART1CONL)
Usage
Description
JP3, JP4
Device Selection
Selection of device: S3F8S19/F8S15, S3F8S28, S3F8S39
JP6, JP7
Ex.CLK selection
Set external clock connect to S3F8S19/F8S15 EVA-chip.
JP12
User's Power selection
Selection of Power to User.
JP2
MODE Selection
Selection of Eva/Main-chip mode of S3F8S19/F8S15 EVA-chip
JP1
Emulator selection
Selection of SMDS2/SMDS2+
JP5
Clock Source Selection
Selection of debug with internal/external clock
8-pin switch
Smart Option setting for S3F8S19/F8S15 EVA-chip
S1
100-pin connector
Connection between emulator and TB8S8S19 target board.
S2
24-pin connector
Connection between target board and user application system
Push button
Generation low active reset signal to S3F8S19/F8S15 EVAchip
VCC, GND
POWER connector
External power connector for TB8S19/8S28/8S39
IDLE, STOP LED
STOP/IDLE Display
Indicate the status of STOP or IDLE of S3F8S19/F8S15 EVAchip on TB8S19/8S28/8S39 target board
PWM selection
Selection of PWM enable/disable
SW2, SW3
RESET
JP3
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
420
Table 26-2 describes the device selection settings for TB8S19/8S28/8S39.
Table 26-2
Device Selection Settings for TB8S19/8S28/8S39
"Device Selection" Settings
Operating Mode
Device Selection:JP4
8S19/39
8S28
Device Selection
JP4
8S19/8S39
8S28
TB8S28
Target
System
Operates with TB8S28
TB8S39
Target
System
Operates with TB8S39
TB8S19
Target
System
Operates with TB8S19
JP3
8S19
Comments
8S39
Device Selection
JP4
8S19/39
8S28
JP3
8S19
8S39
NOTE: The symbols in the "8S19" Setting column indicates the electrical short (off) configuration:
Table 26-3 describes the power selection settings for TB8S19/8S28/8S39.
Table 26-3
"To User_Vcc" Settings
Power Selection Settings for TB8S19/8S28/8S39
Operating Mode
TB8S19
External
VCC
To user_VDD
Comments
Target
System
VSS
off
on
VCC
The SMDS2/SMDS2+ main
board supplies VDD to the
target board (evaluation
chip) and the target system.
SMDS2/SMDS2+
TB8S19
External
VCC
To user_VDD
VSS
off
on
VCC
SMDS2/SMDS2+
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
Target
System
The SMDS2/SMDS2+ main
board supplies VDD only to
the target board (evaluation
chip). The target system
must have its own power
supply.
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
421
26.1.2.2 SMDS2+ Selection (SAM8)
To write data into program memory that is available in SMDS2+, you should select the target board for SMDS2+
through a switch. Otherwise, the program memory writing function is not available.
Table 26-4 describes the SMDS2+ tool selection setting.
Table 26-4
The SMDS2+ Tool Selection Setting
"JP4" Setting
Operating Mode
R/W*
SMDS2
SMDS2+
R/W*
SMDS2+
Target
System
Table 26-5 describes using single header pins to select clock source/PWM/operation mode.
Table 26-5
Using Single Header Pins to Select Clock Source/PWM/Operation Mode
Target Board Part
Comments
Board CLK
JP5
Clock Source
Uses SMDS2/SMDS2+ internal clock source as the system clock.
Default Setting
Inner CLK
Board CLK
JP5
Clock Source
Uses external crystal or ceramic oscillator as the system clock.
Inner CLK
JP6
Connects Clock to S3F8S19/F8S15. (JP10-11, JP8-9 off)
JP7
Main Mode
JP2
The S3E8S30 runs in main mode, just same as S3F8S28/F8S24. The
debug interface is not available.
EVA Mode
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
Target Board Part
422
Comments
Main Mode
The S3E8S30 runs in EVA mode, available. When debug program, set
the jumper in this mode.
Default Setting
JP2
EVA Mode
Table 26-6 describes using single header pins as the input path for external trigger sources.
Table 26-6
Using Single Header Pins as the Input Path for External Trigger Sources
Target Board Part
Comments
Connector f rom
External Trigger
Sources of the
Application Sy stem
External
Triggers
Ch1(TP3)
Ch2(TP4)
You can connect an external trigger source to one of the two external
trigger channels (CH1 or CH2) for the SK-1000/SMDS2+ breakpoint
and trace functions.
Figure 26-3 illustrates the DIP switch for smart option.
SW2
Low
OFF
High (Default)
3F.0
3F.1
3F.2
3F.7
ON
3F.3
OFF
3F.4
OFF
3F.5
ON
3F.6
ON
3E.0
3E.1
0
3E.2
3E.3
3E.5
3E.6
3E.7
3E.4
SW3
0
NOTE:
1. For EVA chip, smart option is determined by DIP switch not software.
2. Please keep the reserved bits as default value (high).
Figure 26-3
x
DIP Switch for Smart Option
IDLE LED
This LED is ON when the evaluation chip (S3E8S30) is in idle mode.
x
STOP LED
This LED is ON when the evaluation chip (S3E8S30) is in stop mode.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
423
Figure 26-4 illustrates the 48-pin connector for TB8S19/8S28/8S39.
S2
1
50
P0.5/ADC5
INT3/ADC3/P0.3
2
49
P0.6/ADC6
INT2/ADC2/P0.2
3
48
P0.7/ADC7
INT1/ADC1/P0.1
4
47
P1.7/ADC9
INT0/ADC0/P0.0
5
46
P1.6/ADC8
VDD
6
45
P1.5/VLC3
VSS
7
44
P1.4/VLC2
XOUT
8
43
P1.3/VLC1
XIN
9
42
P1.2/VL0
(VPP)TEST
10
41
P1.1/CB
XTIN
11
40
P1.0/CA
XTOUT
12
39
P4.7/SEG21/RXD0
Nreset
13
38
P4.6/SEG20/TXD0
COM0/P2.0
14
37
P4.5/SEG19/RX1
COM1/P2.1
15
36
P4.4/SEG18/TXD1
SEG0/COM2/P2.2
16
35
P4.3/SEG17/TAOUT/TACAP
SEG1/COM3/P2.3
17
34
P4.2/SEG16/TACLK
SEG2/COM4/P2.4
18
33
P4.1/SEG15/TBOUT
SEG3/COM5/P2.5
19
32
P4.0/SEG14/T0OUT
SEG4/COM6/P2.6
20
31
P3.7/SEG13/INT7/T1OUT/T1CAP
SEG5/COM7/P2.7
21
30
P3.6/SEG12/INT6/T1CLK/SCL
SEG6/MISO/P3.0
22
29
P3.5/SEG11/INT5/T2CLK/SDA
SEG7/MOSI/P3.1
23
28
P3.4/SEG10/INT4/T2OUT/T2CAP
SEG8/SCK/P3.2
24
27
P3.3/SEG9/NSS
VSS
25
26
VSS
Figure 26-4
PS031201-0813
50-PIN SOCKET
ADC4/P0.4
48-Pin Connector for TB8S19/8S28/8S39
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
424
Figure 26-5 illustrates the S3F8S19/F8S15 probe adapter for 48 pin package.
Target Board
Target System
S2
50
50
25
26
Target Cable for 50-Pin Connector
25
26
Figure 26-5
PS031201-0813
1
50-Pin Connector
50-Pin Connector
1
S3F8S19/F8S15 Probe Adapter for 48 Pin Package
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
26.2 Third Parties for Development Tools
425
SAMSUNG provides a complete line of development tools for microcontroller of SAMSUNG. With long experience
in developing MCU systems, our third parties are leading companies in the technology of tools. SAMSUNG Incircuit emulator solution covers a wide range of capabilities and prices, from a low cost ICE to a complete system
with an OTP/MTP programmer.
26.2.1 In-Circuit Emulator for SAM8 family
x
OPENice-i500/2000
x
SmartKit SK-1200
26.2.2 OTP/MTP Programmer
x
SPW-uni
x
GW-uni (8-gang programmer)
x
AS-pro
26.2.3 Development Tools Suppliers
rd
You can contact our local sales offices or the 3 party tool suppliers directly for getting development tools as
described in sub section 1.2.4.8.
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
426
26.2.4 8-Bit In-Circuit Emulator
OPENice - i500
AIJI System
x TEL: 82-31-223-6611
x FAX: 82-331-223-6613
x E-mail: openice@aijisystem.com
stroh@yicsystem.com
x URL: http://www.aijisystem.com
OPENice - i2000
AIJI System
x TEL: 82-31-223-6611
x FAX: 82-331-223-6613
x E-mail: openice@aijisystem.com
stroh@yicsystem.com
x URL: http://www.aijisystem.com
SK-1200
Seminix
x TEL: 82-2-539-7891
x FAX: 82-2-539-7819
x E-mail: sales@seminix.com
x URL: http://www.seminix.com
PS031201-0813
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
427
26.2.5 OTP/MTP Programmer (Writer)
PS031201-0813
SPW-uni
Single OTP/MTP/FLASH Programmer
x Download/Upload and data edit function
x PC-based operation with USB port
x Full function regarding OTP/MTP/FLASH MCU
programmer
(Read, Program, Verify, Blank, Protection })
x Fast programming speed (4 Kbyte/sec)
x Support all of SAMSUNG OTP/MTP/FLASH
MCU devices
x Low-cost
x NOR Flash memory (SST, Samsung and so on)
x NAND Flash memory (SLC)
x Supports new devices by adding device files or
by upgrading the software.
SEMINIX
x TEL: 82-2-539-7891
x FAX: 82-2-539-7819.
x E-mail:
sales@seminix.com
x URL:
http://www.seminix.com
GW-uni
Gang Programmer for OTP/MTP/FLASH MCU
x 8 devices programming at one time
x Fast programming speed :OTP (2 Kbps)/MTP
(10 Kbps)
x Maximum buffer memory:100Mbyte
x Operation mode: PC base/Stand-alone(no PC)
x Supports full functions of OTP/MTP
(Read, Program, Checksum, Verify, Erase, Read
protection, Smart option)
x Simple GUI(Graphical User Interface)
x Device information setting by a device part no.
x LCD display and touch key (Stand-alone mode
operation)
x System upgradable (Simple firmware upgrade
by user)
SEMINIX
x TEL: 82-2-539-7891
x FAX: 82-2-539-7819.
x E-mail:
sales@seminix.com
x URL:
http://www.seminix.com
PRELIMINARY
S3F8S19/S3F8S15
Product Specification
PS031201-0813
428
AS-pro
On-board programmer for Samsung Flash MCU
x Portable and stand alone Samsung
OTP/MTP/FLASH Programmer for After Service
x Small size and light weight for the portable use
x Supports all of SAMSUNG OTP/MTP/FLASH
devices
x HEX file download through USB port from PC
x Very fast program and verify time
(OTP: 2 Kbytes per second, MTP:10Kbytes per
second)
x Internal large buffer memory (118M Bytes)
x Driver software run under various Operating
Systems (O/S)
(Windows 95/98/2000/XP)
x Full function regarding OTP/MTP programmer
(Read, Program, Verify, Blank, Protection and so
on)
x Two types of power supplies
(User system power or USB power adapter)
x Supports firmware upgrade
SEMINIX
x TEL: 82-2-539-7891
x FAX: 82-2-539-7819.
x E-mail:
sales@seminix.com
x URL:
http://www.seminix.com
Flash writing adapter board
x Special flash writing socket for S3F8S28/F8S24
– 24SOP, 24TSSOP, 20DIP, 20SOP, 20SSOP
C&A technology
x TEL: 82-2-2612-9027
x FAX: 82-2-2612-9044
x E-mail:
wisdom@cnatech.com
x URL:
http://www.cnatech.com
PRELIMINARY